1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.93"
49 .include ./local_params
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
54 .set drivernamemax "64"
60 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
61 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
62 . provided in the xfpt library.
63 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
65 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
67 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
69 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
70 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
72 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
73 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
75 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
76 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
77 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
87 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
88 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
92 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
93 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
94 . --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
96 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
97 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
100 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
101 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
102 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
106 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
110 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
118 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
119 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
120 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
121 . --- ID that ties them together.
124 &<indexterm role="concept">&
125 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
127 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
133 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
134 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
136 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
142 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
146 &<indexterm role="option">&
147 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
149 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
155 &<indexterm role="variable">&
156 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
158 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
164 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
166 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
169 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
170 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
172 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
176 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
177 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
181 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
182 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
183 <revhistory><revision>
185 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
186 </revision></revhistory>
189 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
194 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
195 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
196 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
197 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
198 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
200 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
203 <indexterm role="variable">
204 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
205 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
207 <indexterm role="concept">
208 <primary>address</primary>
209 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
210 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
212 <indexterm role="concept">
213 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
214 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
216 <indexterm role="concept">
217 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
218 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
220 <indexterm role="concept">
221 <primary>CR character</primary>
222 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
224 <indexterm role="concept">
225 <primary>CRL</primary>
226 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
228 <indexterm role="concept">
229 <primary>delivery</primary>
230 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
231 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
233 <indexterm role="concept">
234 <primary>dialup</primary>
235 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
237 <indexterm role="concept">
238 <primary>exiscan</primary>
239 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
241 <indexterm role="concept">
242 <primary>failover</primary>
243 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
245 <indexterm role="concept">
246 <primary>fallover</primary>
247 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
249 <indexterm role="concept">
250 <primary>filter</primary>
251 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
252 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
254 <indexterm role="concept">
255 <primary>ident</primary>
256 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
258 <indexterm role="concept">
259 <primary>LF character</primary>
260 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
262 <indexterm role="concept">
263 <primary>maximum</primary>
264 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
266 <indexterm role="concept">
267 <primary>monitor</primary>
268 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
270 <indexterm role="concept">
271 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
272 <see>entry for xxx</see>
274 <indexterm role="concept">
275 <primary>NUL</primary>
276 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
278 <indexterm role="concept">
279 <primary>passwd file</primary>
280 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
282 <indexterm role="concept">
283 <primary>process id</primary>
284 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
286 <indexterm role="concept">
287 <primary>RBL</primary>
288 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
290 <indexterm role="concept">
291 <primary>redirection</primary>
292 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
294 <indexterm role="concept">
295 <primary>return path</primary>
296 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
298 <indexterm role="concept">
299 <primary>scanning</primary>
300 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
302 <indexterm role="concept">
303 <primary>SSL</primary>
304 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
306 <indexterm role="concept">
307 <primary>string</primary>
308 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
309 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
311 <indexterm role="concept">
312 <primary>top bit</primary>
313 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
315 <indexterm role="concept">
316 <primary>variables</primary>
317 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
319 <indexterm role="concept">
320 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
321 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
327 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
328 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
329 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
330 . chapter "Introduction"
331 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
333 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
334 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
335 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
336 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
338 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
339 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
340 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
341 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
342 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
343 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
344 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
346 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
347 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
348 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
350 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
351 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
352 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
354 The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
355 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
356 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
357 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
358 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
360 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
361 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
362 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
363 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
364 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
366 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
367 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
368 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
369 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
373 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
374 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
377 .cindex "documentation"
378 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
379 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
380 renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
381 capable of showing a change indicator.
384 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
385 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
386 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
387 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
388 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
389 Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
390 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
393 .cindex "books about Exim"
394 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
395 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
396 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
397 (&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
399 The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
400 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
401 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
402 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
404 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
405 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
406 Debian-specific features in the file
407 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
408 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
411 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
412 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
414 As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
415 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
416 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
417 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
418 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
420 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
421 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
422 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
423 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
425 All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
426 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
428 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
429 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
430 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
434 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
435 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
436 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
437 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
438 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
439 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
440 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
441 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
444 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
445 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
446 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
450 .section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
453 The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
454 available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
455 website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
459 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
460 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
461 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(https://wiki.exim.org)),
462 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
463 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
464 The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
465 provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
468 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
469 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
470 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
471 Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
474 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
475 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
476 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
479 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
480 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
481 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
482 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
485 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
486 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
487 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
488 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
489 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
492 &url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
494 Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
497 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
498 .cindex "bug reports"
499 .cindex "reporting bugs"
500 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
501 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
502 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
503 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
507 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
509 .cindex "HTTPS download site"
510 .cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
511 .cindex "distribution" "https site"
512 The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
514 &url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
516 The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
517 We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
519 The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
520 content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
521 &url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
523 If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
524 follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
525 If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
526 here are top-level directories.
528 There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
529 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
531 Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
532 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
533 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
534 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
538 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
540 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
541 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
542 The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
543 most portable to old systems.
545 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
546 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
547 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
548 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
549 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
550 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
551 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
552 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
553 PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
554 &_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
555 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
557 At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
558 with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
559 of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
560 and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
562 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
564 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
565 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
566 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
568 For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
569 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
570 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
572 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
573 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
574 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
575 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
577 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
579 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
580 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
582 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
583 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
586 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
588 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
589 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
590 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
591 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
592 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
593 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
594 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
596 .cindex "domainless addresses"
597 .cindex "address" "without domain"
598 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
599 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
600 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
601 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
604 .cindex "transport" "external"
605 .cindex "external transports"
606 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
607 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
608 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
609 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
610 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
611 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
613 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
614 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
615 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
618 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
619 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
620 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
621 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
622 a number of common scanners are provided.
626 .section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
627 Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
628 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
629 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
630 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
631 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
634 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
635 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
636 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
637 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
638 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
639 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
640 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
641 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
642 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
643 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
644 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
645 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
647 Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
648 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
649 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
650 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
654 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
655 .cindex "terminology definitions"
656 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
657 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
658 It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
659 below) by a blank line.
661 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
662 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
663 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
664 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
665 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
666 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
667 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
668 rise to further bounce messages.
670 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
671 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
672 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
675 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
676 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
677 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
680 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
681 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
682 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
684 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
685 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
686 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
687 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
688 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
689 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
690 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
691 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
693 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
694 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
695 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
696 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
697 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
698 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
701 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
702 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
703 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to the
704 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
705 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
707 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
708 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
709 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
710 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
711 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
712 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
714 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
715 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
718 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
719 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
720 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
721 Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
722 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
724 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
725 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
726 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
727 is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
728 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
730 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
731 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
732 messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
733 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
734 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
735 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
742 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
743 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
745 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
746 .cindex "incorporated code"
747 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
750 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
753 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
754 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
755 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
756 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
757 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
758 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
760 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
761 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
762 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
763 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
764 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
765 following statements:
768 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
770 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
771 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
772 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
774 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
775 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
776 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
777 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
778 restrictions applied to it).
781 .cindex "SPA authentication"
782 .cindex "Samba project"
783 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
784 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
785 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
786 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
790 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
791 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
792 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
793 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
794 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
795 conditions expressed therein.
798 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
800 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
801 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
805 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
806 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
808 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
809 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
810 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
813 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
814 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
815 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
816 details, please contact
818 Office of Technology Transfer
819 Carnegie Mellon University
821 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
822 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
823 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
826 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
829 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
830 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
832 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
833 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
834 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
835 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
836 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
837 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
838 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
843 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
846 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
847 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
848 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
849 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
852 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
853 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
857 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
858 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
859 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
860 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
861 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
862 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
863 software without specific, written prior permission.
865 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
866 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
867 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
868 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
869 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
870 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
875 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
876 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
877 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
878 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
879 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
883 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
884 not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
885 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
892 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
893 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
895 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
896 "Receiving and delivering mail"
899 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
900 .cindex "design philosophy"
901 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
902 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
903 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
904 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
905 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
906 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
909 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
910 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
911 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
912 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
913 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
914 unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
915 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
918 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
919 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
920 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
921 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
922 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
923 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
924 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
925 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
926 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
929 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
930 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
932 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
933 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
934 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
935 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
937 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
938 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
939 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
940 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
941 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
943 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
944 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
945 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
947 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
948 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
949 runs at the start of every delivery process.
954 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
955 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
956 .cindex "Sieve filter"
957 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
958 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
959 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
960 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
961 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
962 of filtering are available:
965 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
968 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
969 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
972 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
976 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
977 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
978 .cindex "format" "of message id"
979 .cindex "id of message"
984 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
985 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
986 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
987 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
988 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
989 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
990 id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
991 not always case-sensitive.
993 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
994 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
995 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
996 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
997 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
998 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
1002 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1003 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1004 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1005 way of representing the date and time of day).
1007 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1008 received the message.
1010 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1012 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1013 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1014 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1015 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1016 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1018 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1019 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1020 (1/100) of a second.
1024 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1025 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1026 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1027 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1028 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1031 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1032 .cindex "receiving mail"
1033 .cindex "message" "reception"
1034 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1035 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1036 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1037 there are several possibilities:
1040 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1041 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1042 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1044 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1045 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1046 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1047 command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1048 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1049 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1051 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1052 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1053 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1054 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1055 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1057 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1058 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1059 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1060 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1064 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1065 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1066 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1067 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1068 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1069 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1070 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1071 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1072 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1073 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1074 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1075 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1076 users to change sender addresses.
1078 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1079 checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1080 (either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1081 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1082 individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1083 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1084 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1086 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1087 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1088 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1089 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1090 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1091 message is received.
1097 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1098 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1099 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1100 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1101 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1102 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1103 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1104 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1106 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1107 By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1108 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1109 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1110 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1111 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1112 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1113 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1114 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1115 affect file system performance.
1117 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1118 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1119 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1120 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1121 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1123 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1124 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1125 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1126 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1127 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1128 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1129 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1130 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1131 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1132 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1133 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1134 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1138 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1139 .cindex "message" "life of"
1140 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1141 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1142 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1143 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1144 cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1145 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1146 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1148 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1149 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1150 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1151 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1152 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1155 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1156 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1157 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1158 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1159 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1161 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1162 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1163 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1164 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1165 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1166 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1167 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1168 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1169 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1170 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1173 .cindex "journal file"
1174 .cindex "file" "journal"
1175 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1176 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1177 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1178 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1179 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1180 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1181 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1182 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1184 Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1185 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1186 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1187 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1188 deliveries caused by crashes.
1192 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1193 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1194 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1195 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1196 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1197 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1198 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1199 specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1200 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1202 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1203 Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1204 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1205 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1206 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1207 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1208 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1209 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1210 the driver's features in general.
1212 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1213 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1214 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1215 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1218 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1219 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1220 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1221 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1222 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1223 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1225 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1226 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1227 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1228 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1229 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1230 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1232 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1233 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1234 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1237 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1238 addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1239 Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1240 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1241 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1242 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1243 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1244 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1245 configured to fail the address.
1247 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1248 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1249 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1250 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1251 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1252 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1254 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1255 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1256 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1257 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1258 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1259 the address is bounced.
1263 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1264 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1265 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1266 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1267 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1268 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1269 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1270 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1272 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1273 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1274 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1275 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1276 sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1277 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1278 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1279 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1284 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1285 .cindex "router" "running details"
1286 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1287 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1288 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1289 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1290 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1291 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1295 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1296 transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1297 original address ceases
1298 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1299 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1300 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1301 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1302 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1305 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1306 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1307 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1308 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1309 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1311 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1312 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1313 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1314 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1315 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1317 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1318 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1319 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1320 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1321 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1323 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1324 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1325 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1327 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1328 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1329 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1330 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1332 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1333 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1336 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1337 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1338 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1339 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1340 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1342 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1343 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1344 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1345 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1346 facility for this purpose.
1349 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1350 .cindex "case of local parts"
1351 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1352 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1353 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1354 and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1355 check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1356 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1357 routed addresses are shown.
1361 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1362 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1363 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1364 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1365 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1366 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1369 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1370 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1371 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1372 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1373 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1374 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1375 of any other conditions.
1377 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1378 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1379 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1381 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1382 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1383 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1384 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1385 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1387 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1388 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1389 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1390 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1391 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1393 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1394 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1395 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1397 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1398 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1400 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1401 of domains that it defines.
1403 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1404 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix_v$&"
1405 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1406 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1407 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix_v$&"
1408 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1409 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1410 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1411 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1412 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1413 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1415 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&,
1416 &$local_part_prefix_v$&, &$local_part_suffix$&
1417 and &$local_part_suffix_v$& as necessary.
1420 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1421 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1423 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1424 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1425 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1426 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1427 remaining preconditions.
1429 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1430 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1431 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1432 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1433 could lead to confusion.
1435 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1436 set of addresses that it defines.
1438 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1439 specified files is tested.
1441 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1442 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1443 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1444 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1448 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1449 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1450 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1451 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1452 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1453 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1454 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1458 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1459 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1460 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1463 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1464 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1465 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1466 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1467 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1469 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1470 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1472 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1473 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1474 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1475 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1476 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1477 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1480 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1481 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1482 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1483 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1484 processed entirely independently of each other.
1486 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1487 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1488 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1489 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1490 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1491 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1492 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1493 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1494 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1496 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1497 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1498 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1499 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1500 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1501 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1502 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1503 addresses to the same domain.
1505 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1506 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1507 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1508 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1509 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1510 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1511 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1512 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1514 .cindex "queue runner"
1515 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1516 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1517 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1518 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1519 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1520 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1521 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1522 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1523 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1525 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1526 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1527 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1528 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1529 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1530 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1532 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1533 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1534 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1535 messages to other addresses.
1537 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1538 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1539 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1542 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1543 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1544 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1550 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1551 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1552 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1553 .cindex "queue runner"
1554 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1555 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1556 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1557 intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1558 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1559 first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1560 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1561 passed its retry time.
1562 You can run several queue runners at once.
1564 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1565 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1566 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1567 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1568 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1573 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1574 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1575 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1576 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1577 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1578 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1579 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1580 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1581 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1584 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1585 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1586 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1588 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1589 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1590 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1591 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1592 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1597 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1598 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1599 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1600 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1601 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1602 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1603 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1604 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1605 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1606 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1607 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1609 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1610 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1611 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1614 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1615 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1616 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1617 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1618 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1619 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1620 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1625 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1626 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1627 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1628 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1629 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1630 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1631 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1632 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1638 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1639 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1641 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1642 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1644 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1645 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1646 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1647 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1650 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1651 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1653 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1654 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1655 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1656 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1660 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1661 following subdirectories are created:
1664 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1665 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1666 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1667 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1668 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1669 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1670 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1673 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1674 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1675 that may be useful to some sites.
1678 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1679 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1680 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1681 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1682 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1683 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1685 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1686 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1687 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1688 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1689 overridden if necessary.
1690 .cindex compiler requirements
1691 .cindex compiler version
1692 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1695 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1696 .cindex "PCRE library"
1697 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1698 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need to
1699 install the PCRE package or the PCRE development package for your operating
1700 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1701 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1702 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1703 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1704 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1705 If your operating system has no
1706 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1707 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1708 More information on PCRE is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1710 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1711 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1712 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1713 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1714 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1715 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1716 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1718 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1719 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1720 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1721 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1722 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1723 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1724 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1725 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1727 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1728 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1729 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1730 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1731 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1732 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1733 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1734 Berkeley DB library.
1736 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1737 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1741 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1742 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1744 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1745 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1746 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1747 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1748 filename is used unmodified.
1750 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1751 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1752 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1753 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1755 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1756 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1757 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1759 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1760 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1761 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 4.&'x'&.
1762 Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All versions of
1763 Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1764 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1765 page with far newer versions listed.
1766 It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1767 Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1768 suited to Exim's usage model.
1770 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1771 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1772 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1773 operates on a single file.
1777 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1778 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1779 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1780 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1781 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1785 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1786 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1788 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1789 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1790 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1791 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1792 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1793 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1795 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1796 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1797 in one of these lines:
1802 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1803 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1804 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1805 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1808 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1809 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1811 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1812 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1816 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1817 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1818 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1819 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1820 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1821 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1822 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1823 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1824 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1825 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1826 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1827 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1829 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1830 without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1831 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1832 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1833 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1834 a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1836 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1837 at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1838 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1839 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1840 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1841 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1844 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1845 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1846 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1847 facilities, you need to set
1849 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1851 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1852 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1855 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1856 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1857 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1858 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1859 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1860 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1861 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1863 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1864 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1865 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1866 configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1867 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1872 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1873 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1875 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1876 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1877 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1878 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1879 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1880 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1881 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1883 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1884 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1885 &url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1886 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1887 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1891 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1895 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1896 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1897 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1898 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1899 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1900 Exim is usually built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1901 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support clients that expect to
1902 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1903 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1906 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1907 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1910 If you do not want TLS support you should set
1914 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
1916 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1919 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1921 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1922 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1925 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1926 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1928 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1929 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1932 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1934 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1935 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1938 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1940 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1941 library and include files. For example:
1944 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1945 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1947 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1948 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1951 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1954 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1955 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1956 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1961 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1963 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1964 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1965 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1966 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1967 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1968 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1969 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1970 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1971 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1972 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1973 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1974 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1977 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1978 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1979 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1981 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1982 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1984 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1986 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1987 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1988 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1989 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1990 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1991 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1995 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1996 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1997 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1998 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1999 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
2000 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
2003 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
2004 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
2005 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
2006 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
2007 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
2009 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
2014 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2015 .cindex "lookup modules"
2016 .cindex "dynamic modules"
2017 .cindex ".so building"
2018 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2019 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2021 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2022 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2024 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2026 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2027 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2028 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2029 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2030 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2031 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2033 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2034 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2035 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2044 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2045 .cindex "build directory"
2046 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2047 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2048 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2049 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2050 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2051 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2052 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2054 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2055 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2056 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2057 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2058 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2059 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2060 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2061 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2063 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2064 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2065 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2069 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2070 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2071 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2072 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2073 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2074 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2075 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2079 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2080 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2081 given in addition to the short output.
2085 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2086 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2087 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2088 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2089 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2090 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2091 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2094 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2095 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2097 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2098 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2099 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2100 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2102 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2103 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2104 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2105 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2106 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2107 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2108 and are often not needed.
2110 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2111 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2112 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2113 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2114 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2115 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2116 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2117 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2118 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2121 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2122 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2123 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2124 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2128 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2129 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2130 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2131 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2132 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2133 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2134 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2135 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2136 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2137 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2138 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2139 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2140 containing the lines
2145 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2146 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2148 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2149 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2150 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2153 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2154 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2155 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2156 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2157 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2158 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2159 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2160 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2161 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2162 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2168 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2169 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2170 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2171 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2172 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2173 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2174 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2175 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2178 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2179 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2180 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2181 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2182 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2183 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2184 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2185 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2186 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2187 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2188 syntax. For instance:
2191 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2193 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2194 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2195 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2198 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2199 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2200 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2204 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2205 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2207 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2208 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2209 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2210 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2211 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2212 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2215 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2216 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2218 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2219 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2222 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2223 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2225 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2226 definition of all three of these variables into your
2227 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2230 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2231 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2232 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2233 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2235 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2236 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2237 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2238 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2239 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2242 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2243 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2244 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2245 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2246 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2249 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2251 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2252 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2253 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2254 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2255 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2256 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2260 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2261 .cindex "building Eximon"
2262 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2263 where the files that are involved are
2265 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2266 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2267 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2268 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2269 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2270 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2272 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2273 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2274 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2275 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2276 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2277 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2278 LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2282 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2283 .cindex "installing Exim"
2284 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2285 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2286 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2287 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2288 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2289 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2290 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2291 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2292 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2293 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2294 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2295 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2297 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2298 Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2299 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2300 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2301 by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2302 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2303 alternative files, no default is installed.
2305 .cindex "system aliases file"
2306 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2307 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2308 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2309 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2310 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2311 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2312 and outputs a comment to the user.
2314 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2315 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2316 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2317 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2318 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2320 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2321 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2322 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2323 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2324 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2327 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2328 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2331 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2333 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2334 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2335 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2336 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2337 but this usage is deprecated.
2339 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2340 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2341 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2342 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2343 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2344 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2346 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2347 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2348 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2349 for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2350 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2351 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2352 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2354 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2355 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2356 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2359 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2361 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2362 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2363 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2364 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2367 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2369 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2370 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2373 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2374 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2376 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2380 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2382 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2384 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2385 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2386 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2388 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2393 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2394 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2395 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2396 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2397 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2400 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2401 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2402 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2406 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2407 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2408 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2409 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2410 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2416 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2417 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2418 Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2419 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2420 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2424 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2425 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2426 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2427 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2428 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2431 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2433 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2435 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2437 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2438 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2439 user agent. For example:
2441 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2442 From: user@your.domain.example
2443 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2444 Subject: Testing Exim
2446 This is a test message.
2449 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2450 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2451 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2453 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2454 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2455 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2456 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2457 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2458 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2460 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2462 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2463 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2464 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2465 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2466 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2468 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2469 .cindex "lock files"
2470 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2471 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2472 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2473 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2474 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2475 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2476 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2477 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2478 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2479 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2480 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2481 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2483 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2484 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2485 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2486 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2487 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2490 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2491 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2492 within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2493 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2497 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2498 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2499 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2500 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2501 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2502 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2503 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2504 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2505 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2506 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2507 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2508 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2509 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2511 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2512 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2513 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2514 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2515 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2516 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2519 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2520 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2521 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2522 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2524 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2525 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2526 favourite user agent.
2528 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2529 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2530 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2531 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2532 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2533 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2537 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2538 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2539 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2540 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2541 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2542 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2543 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2544 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2545 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2546 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2552 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2553 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2554 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2556 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2558 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2559 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2560 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2561 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2562 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2564 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2566 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2568 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2569 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2570 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2575 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2576 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2578 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2579 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2580 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2581 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2582 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2583 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2584 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2585 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2586 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2589 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2591 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2592 were present before any other options.
2593 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2595 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2596 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2597 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2600 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2601 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2602 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2606 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2607 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2608 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2611 .cindex "queue runner"
2612 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2613 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2614 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2616 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2617 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2618 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2619 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2620 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2621 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2622 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2623 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2626 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2627 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2628 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2629 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2630 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2631 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2634 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2635 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2636 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2637 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2638 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2639 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2641 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2642 .cindex "envelope from"
2643 .cindex "envelope sender"
2644 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2645 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2646 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2647 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2648 users to set envelope senders.
2650 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2651 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2652 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
2653 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2654 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2655 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2656 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2658 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2659 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2660 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2661 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2662 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2663 that are available to trusted users.
2665 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2666 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2667 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2668 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2669 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2671 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2672 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2673 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2674 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2676 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2677 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2678 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2679 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2681 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2682 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2687 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2688 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2689 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2695 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2696 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2697 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2698 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2699 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2700 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2701 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2702 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2704 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2705 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2706 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2707 . creates a man page for the options.
2708 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2711 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2718 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2719 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2720 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2721 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2724 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2725 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2726 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2729 .vitem &%--version%&
2730 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2731 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2738 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2741 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2743 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2744 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2745 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2746 clean; it ignores this option.
2751 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2752 .cindex "queue runner"
2753 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2754 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2755 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2757 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2758 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2759 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2760 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2762 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2763 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2764 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2765 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2767 When a listening daemon
2768 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2769 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2770 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2771 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2772 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2773 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2776 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2777 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2778 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2782 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2783 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2784 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2785 .cindex signal "to reload configuration"
2786 .cindex daemon "reload configuration"
2787 .cindex reload configuration
2788 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2789 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2790 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2791 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2792 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2793 because these are reread each time they are used.
2797 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2798 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2802 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2803 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2804 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2805 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2806 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2807 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2809 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2810 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2811 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2812 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2813 test data. A line history is supported.
2815 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2816 continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2817 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2818 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2819 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2820 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2821 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2823 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2824 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2825 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2826 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2828 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2829 defined and macros will be expanded.
2830 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2831 available to admin users.
2833 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2835 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2836 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2837 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2838 of a file. For example:
2840 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2842 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2843 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2844 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2845 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2846 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2847 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2848 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2851 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2853 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2854 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2855 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2856 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2857 system filters are recognized.
2859 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2861 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2862 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2863 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2864 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2865 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2866 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2867 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2868 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2871 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2872 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2873 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2875 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2877 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2878 variables that are used by the user filter.
2880 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2885 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2886 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2887 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2890 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2891 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2892 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2893 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2895 When testing a filter file,
2896 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2897 .cindex "envelope from"
2898 .cindex "envelope sender"
2899 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2900 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2901 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2902 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2903 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2906 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2908 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2909 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2910 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2913 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2915 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2916 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2917 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2918 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2919 actually being delivered.
2921 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2923 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2924 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2925 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2928 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2930 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2931 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2932 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2935 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2937 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2938 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2939 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2940 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2941 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2942 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2943 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2944 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2945 after a full stop. For example:
2947 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2948 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2950 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2951 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2952 conversion to the canonical form is
2953 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2955 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2956 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2957 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2958 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2959 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2963 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2964 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2965 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2968 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2969 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2970 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2972 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2973 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2974 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2975 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2976 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2977 session were authenticated.
2979 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2980 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2981 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2983 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2984 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2985 specialized SMTP test program such as
2986 &url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks).
2988 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2990 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2991 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2992 updating the callout cache database.
2996 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2997 .cindex "building alias file"
2998 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2999 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
3000 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
3001 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
3002 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
3005 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
3006 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
3007 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
3008 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
3009 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
3010 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
3013 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
3015 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
3016 .cindex "querying exim information"
3017 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
3018 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
3019 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3020 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3021 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3024 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
3025 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
3026 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3027 recognised DSCP names.
3029 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
3030 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
3031 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3032 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3033 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3034 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3035 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3036 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3037 way to guarantee a correct response.
3041 .cindex "local message reception"
3042 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3043 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3044 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3045 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3046 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3047 if no other conflicting option is present.
3049 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3050 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3051 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3052 suppressing this for special cases.
3054 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3055 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3057 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3058 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3059 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3062 .cindex "message" "format"
3063 .cindex "format" "message"
3064 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3065 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3066 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3067 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3068 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3070 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3071 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3073 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3074 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3075 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3076 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3077 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3079 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3080 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3081 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3082 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3083 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3085 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3086 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3087 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3088 .cindex "malware scan test"
3089 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3090 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3091 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3092 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3093 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3094 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3095 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3097 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3098 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3099 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3100 This option requires admin privileges.
3102 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3103 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3104 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3108 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3109 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3110 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3111 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3112 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3113 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3114 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3116 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3117 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3118 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3119 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3120 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3122 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3123 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3124 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3125 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3130 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3131 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3132 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3133 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3134 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3135 arguments, for example:
3137 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3139 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3140 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3141 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3142 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3143 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3144 users, the output is as in this example:
3146 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3148 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3149 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3151 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3152 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3153 backward compatibility.)
3154 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3155 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3157 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3158 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3159 name will not be output.
3161 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3162 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3163 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3164 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3165 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3166 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3167 written directly into the spool directory.
3169 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3171 exim -bP +local_domains
3173 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3174 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3176 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3177 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3178 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3179 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3180 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3181 that driver are output. For example:
3183 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3185 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3186 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3187 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3188 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3189 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3192 .cindex "environment"
3193 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3194 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3197 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3198 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3199 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3200 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3201 The output format is one item per line.
3202 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3203 the exit status will be nonzero.
3207 .cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3208 .cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3209 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3210 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3211 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3212 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3213 to allow any user to see the queue.
3215 Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3217 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3218 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3221 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3222 .cindex "size" "of message"
3223 The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3224 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3225 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3226 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3227 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3228 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3229 before the sender address.
3231 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3232 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3233 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3235 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3236 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3237 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3238 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3239 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3245 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3246 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3247 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3253 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3254 This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3255 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3256 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3261 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3262 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3263 lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3264 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3268 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3272 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3277 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3278 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3279 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3280 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3285 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3286 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3287 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3288 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3289 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3291 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3292 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3294 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3295 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3296 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3297 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3298 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3299 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3300 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3301 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3302 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3304 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3305 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3310 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3311 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3312 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3313 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3314 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3315 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3316 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3320 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3321 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3322 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3323 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3324 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3325 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3326 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3327 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3328 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3330 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3331 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3332 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3334 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3335 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3336 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3337 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3339 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3340 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3341 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3343 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3344 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3345 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3346 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3347 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3349 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3350 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3354 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3355 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3356 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3357 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3358 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3359 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3360 messages to the MTA.
3363 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3364 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3365 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3366 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3367 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3368 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3369 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3373 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3374 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3375 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3376 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3377 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3378 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3379 the listening daemon.
3383 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3384 .cindex "address" "testing"
3385 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3386 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3387 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3388 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3389 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3391 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3392 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3394 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3395 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3398 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3399 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3400 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3401 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3402 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3405 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3406 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3407 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3408 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3410 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3411 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3412 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3413 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3416 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3417 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3419 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3420 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3421 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3422 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3423 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3424 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3429 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3430 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3431 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3432 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3433 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3434 name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3436 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3437 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3438 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3439 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3440 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3441 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3442 dynamic testing facilities.
3446 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3447 .cindex "address" "verification"
3448 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3449 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3450 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3451 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3452 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3453 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3455 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3456 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3457 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3459 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3460 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3462 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3463 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3466 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3467 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3468 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3469 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3470 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3472 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3473 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3474 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3475 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3476 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3477 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3480 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3481 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3482 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3485 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3486 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3487 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3488 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3490 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3491 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3492 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3493 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3497 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3498 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3505 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3506 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3507 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3508 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3510 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3511 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3512 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3513 each port only when the first connection is received.
3515 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3516 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3518 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3520 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3521 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3522 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3523 This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3524 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3525 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3526 but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3527 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3528 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3530 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3531 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3532 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3533 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3534 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3535 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3536 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3537 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3538 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3540 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3541 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3542 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3543 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3544 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3545 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3546 in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3548 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3549 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3550 must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3551 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3552 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3553 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3554 unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3556 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3557 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3558 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3561 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3562 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3563 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3564 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3565 specified by this option.
3568 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3570 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3571 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3572 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3573 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3574 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3575 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3577 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3578 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3579 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3580 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3581 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3582 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3583 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3585 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3586 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3587 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3593 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3594 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3597 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3599 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3600 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3603 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3605 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3606 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3607 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3608 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3609 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3610 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3611 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3614 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3615 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3616 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3617 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3618 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3619 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3620 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3623 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3624 &`auth `& authenticators
3625 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3626 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3627 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3628 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3629 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3630 &`filter `& filter handling
3631 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3632 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3633 &`ident `& ident lookup
3634 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3635 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3636 &`load `& system load checks
3637 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3638 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3639 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3640 &`memory `& memory handling
3641 &`noutf8 `& modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing
3642 &`pid `& modifier: add pid to debug output lines
3643 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3644 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3645 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3646 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3647 &`retry `& retry handling
3648 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3649 &`route `& address routing
3650 &`timestamp `& modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines
3652 &`transport `& transports
3653 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3654 &`verify `& address verification logic
3655 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3657 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3658 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3659 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3660 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3661 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3662 turn everything off.
3664 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3665 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3666 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3667 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3668 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3671 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3672 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3673 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3674 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3675 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3678 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3679 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3682 .cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3683 .cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3684 The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3685 UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3686 When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3687 Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3689 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3690 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3692 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3694 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3695 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3696 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3697 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3700 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3701 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3702 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3703 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3707 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3708 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3709 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3710 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3711 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3712 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3713 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3714 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3717 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3718 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3719 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3720 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3721 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3723 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3725 .cindex "sender" "name"
3726 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3727 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3728 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3729 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3730 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3731 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3733 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3735 .cindex "sender" "address"
3736 .cindex "address" "sender"
3737 .cindex "trusted users"
3738 .cindex "envelope from"
3739 .cindex "envelope sender"
3740 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3741 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3742 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3743 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3746 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3747 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3748 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3749 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3752 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3753 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3754 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3755 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3756 examples of shell commands:
3758 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3759 exim -f "" user@domain
3761 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3762 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3765 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3766 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3767 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3768 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3771 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3772 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3773 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3774 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3775 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3776 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3780 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3781 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3783 control = suppress_local_fixups
3785 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3786 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3789 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3792 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3794 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3795 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3796 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3801 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3802 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3803 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3804 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3805 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3806 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3808 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3810 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3811 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3812 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3813 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3814 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3815 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3817 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3819 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3821 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3822 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3823 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3824 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3825 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3826 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3827 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3830 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3831 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3832 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3833 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3834 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3835 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3837 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3838 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3839 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3840 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3842 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3844 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3845 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3846 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3847 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3848 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3849 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3850 can be used only by an admin user.
3852 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&&&
3854 &~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3855 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3857 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3858 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3859 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3860 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3861 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3862 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3863 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3864 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3868 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3869 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3870 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3874 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3875 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3876 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3881 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3882 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-d%& option
3883 to pass on an information string on the purpose of the process.
3886 .vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3888 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3889 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3890 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3894 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3895 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3896 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3900 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3901 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3902 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3904 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3906 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3907 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3908 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3909 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3910 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3911 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3915 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3916 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3917 ESMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3922 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3923 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3924 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3927 .vitem &%-MCr%&&~<&'SNI'&> &&&
3931 These options are not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3932 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MCt%& option, and passes on the fact that
3933 a TLS Server Name Indication was sent as part of the channel establishment.
3934 The argument gives the SNI string.
3935 The "r" variant indicates a DANE-verified connection.
3938 .vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3940 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3941 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3942 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3943 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3945 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3947 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3948 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3949 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
3950 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3951 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3952 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3953 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3954 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3955 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3956 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3957 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3958 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3959 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3961 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3963 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3964 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3965 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3966 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3967 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3968 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3969 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3970 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3972 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3974 .cindex "freezing messages"
3975 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3976 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3977 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3978 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3979 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3980 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3983 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3985 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3986 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3987 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3988 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3989 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3990 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3991 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3992 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3995 .vitem &%-MG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3998 .cindex "named queues" "moving messages"
3999 .cindex "queue" "moving messages"
4000 This option requests that each listed message be moved from its current
4001 queue to the given named queue.
4002 The destination queue name argument is required, but can be an empty
4003 string to define the default queue.
4004 If the messages are not currently located in the default queue,
4005 a &%-qG<name>%& option will be required to define the source queue.
4007 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4009 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
4010 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
4011 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
4012 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
4013 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4015 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
4017 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
4018 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
4019 .cindex "removing recipients"
4020 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
4021 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
4022 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
4023 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
4024 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
4025 can be used only by an admin user.
4027 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4029 .cindex "removing messages"
4030 .cindex "abandoning mail"
4031 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
4032 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
4033 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
4034 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
4035 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
4036 placed in the queue.
4041 . .cindex REQUIRETLS
4042 . This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
4043 . It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
4047 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4049 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
4050 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
4051 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
4052 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
4053 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
4054 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4055 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4056 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4057 user. See also &%-bem%&.
4059 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4061 .cindex "thawing messages"
4062 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
4063 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4064 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4065 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4066 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4067 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4070 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4072 .cindex "listing" "message body"
4073 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
4074 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4075 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4077 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4079 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4080 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4081 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4082 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4083 only by an admin user.
4085 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4087 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4088 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4089 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4090 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4091 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4093 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4095 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4096 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4097 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4098 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4102 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4103 treats it that way too.
4107 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4108 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4109 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4110 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4111 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4112 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4113 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4116 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4117 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4118 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4119 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4120 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4121 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4122 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4127 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4128 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4129 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4130 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4132 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4134 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4137 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4139 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4140 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4141 alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4144 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4146 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4147 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4148 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4149 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4150 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4151 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4155 .cindex "background delivery"
4156 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4157 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4158 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4159 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4160 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4161 processes to finish.
4163 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4164 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4165 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4166 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4168 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4169 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4170 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4171 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4175 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4176 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4177 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4178 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4179 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4180 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4182 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4183 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4186 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4187 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4189 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4190 message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4191 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4192 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4197 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4202 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4203 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4204 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4205 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4206 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4207 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4208 are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4209 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4210 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4211 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4216 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4217 .cindex "first pass routing"
4218 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4219 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4220 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4221 configuration file is in effect.
4223 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4224 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4225 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4226 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4227 done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4228 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4229 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4230 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4231 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4236 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4237 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4238 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4241 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4243 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4244 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4245 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4246 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4250 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4251 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4252 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4253 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4254 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4258 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4259 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4260 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4261 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4262 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4266 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4267 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4272 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4273 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4278 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4279 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4280 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4281 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4282 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4283 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4286 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4287 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4289 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4291 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4292 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4293 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4294 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4295 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4296 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4298 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4299 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4301 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4303 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4304 followed by a colon and the port number:
4306 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4308 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4309 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4310 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4311 whichever one is last.
4313 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4315 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4316 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4317 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4318 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4319 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4320 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4322 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4324 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4325 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4326 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4327 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4328 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4329 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4331 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4333 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4334 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4335 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4336 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4337 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4338 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4339 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4340 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4342 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4344 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4345 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4346 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4347 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4348 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4350 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4352 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4353 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4354 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4355 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4356 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4357 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4358 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4360 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4361 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4362 is sending the bounce.
4364 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4366 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4367 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4368 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4369 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4370 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4371 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4372 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4373 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4374 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4375 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4377 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4379 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4380 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4381 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4382 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4383 uses the name it is given.
4385 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4387 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4388 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4389 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4390 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4391 used, when there is no default.
4395 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4396 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4397 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4398 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4402 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4403 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4404 whatever that means.
4406 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4408 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4409 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4410 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4411 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4412 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4413 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4414 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4419 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4420 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4421 This option is not intended for general use.
4422 The daemon uses it when terminating due to a SIGTEM, possibly in
4423 combination with &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>.
4424 It causes the pid file to be removed.
4427 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4429 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4430 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4431 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4432 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4433 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4435 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4437 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4438 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4439 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4440 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4441 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4442 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4446 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4448 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4450 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4451 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4452 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4453 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4454 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4455 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4456 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4457 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4461 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4462 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4463 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4464 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4469 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4470 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4471 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4472 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4475 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4477 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4479 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4481 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4482 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4483 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4484 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4485 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4486 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4490 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4491 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4492 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4493 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4494 and &%-S%& options).
4496 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4497 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4498 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4499 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4500 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4501 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4502 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4505 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4506 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4507 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4508 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4509 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4512 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4513 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4514 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4515 this to be repeated periodically.
4517 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4518 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4519 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4520 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4522 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4523 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4524 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4526 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4527 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4528 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4529 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4533 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4534 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4535 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4536 .cindex "first pass routing"
4537 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4538 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4539 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4543 Performance will be best if the &%queue_run_in_order%& option is false.
4546 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4547 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4548 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4549 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4550 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4551 delivered down a single SMTP
4552 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4553 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4554 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4555 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4556 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4559 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4561 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4562 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4563 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4564 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4565 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4567 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4569 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4570 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4571 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4572 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4573 their retry times are tried.
4575 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4577 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4578 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4581 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4583 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4584 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4585 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4588 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4591 .cindex "named queues" "deliver from"
4592 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4593 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4594 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4595 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4596 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4597 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4599 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4600 will specify a queue to operate on.
4603 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4605 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4608 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4609 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4610 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4611 starting message id. For example:
4613 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4615 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4616 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4617 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4619 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4621 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4622 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4623 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4624 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4625 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4626 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4628 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4629 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4630 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4631 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4632 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4633 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4634 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4635 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4636 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4638 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4640 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4641 process every 30 minutes.
4643 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4644 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4646 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4648 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4651 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4653 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4655 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4657 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4658 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4659 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4660 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4661 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4662 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4663 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4665 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4666 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4667 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4668 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4669 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4670 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4672 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4673 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4675 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4677 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4678 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4679 applied to each queue run.
4681 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4682 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4683 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4684 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4685 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4686 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4687 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4688 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4689 address will be skipped.
4691 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4692 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4693 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4696 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4697 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4698 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4699 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4700 an arbitrary command instead.
4704 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4706 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4708 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4709 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4710 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4711 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4712 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4713 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4715 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4717 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4718 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4719 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4723 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4724 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4725 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4726 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4727 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4728 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4729 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4730 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4731 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4733 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4734 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4735 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4736 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4737 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4738 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4739 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4740 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4741 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4742 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4743 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4745 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4746 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4747 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4748 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4749 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4750 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4752 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4753 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4754 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4755 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4756 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4757 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4758 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4759 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4760 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4764 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4765 compatibility with Sendmail.
4767 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4768 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4769 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4770 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4771 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4772 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4773 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4774 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4779 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4780 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4781 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4782 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4783 set. Exim ignores this option.
4787 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4788 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4789 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4790 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4791 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4792 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4797 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4798 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4799 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4802 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4804 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4805 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4807 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4809 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4810 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4811 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4819 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4820 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4821 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4822 . creates a man page for the options.
4823 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4826 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4833 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4834 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4837 .chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4838 "The runtime configuration file"
4840 .cindex "runtime configuration"
4841 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4842 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4843 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4844 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4845 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4846 Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4847 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4848 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4851 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4852 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4853 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4854 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4855 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4856 actually alter the string.
4858 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4859 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4860 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4861 give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4862 existing file in the list.
4865 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4866 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4867 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4868 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4869 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4870 The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4871 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4872 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4873 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4874 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4876 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4877 to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4878 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4879 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4880 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4882 Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4883 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4884 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4885 compromise the Exim user account.
4887 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4888 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4889 defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4890 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4891 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4892 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4897 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4898 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4899 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4900 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4901 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4902 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4903 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4904 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4905 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4906 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4907 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4909 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4910 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4911 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4912 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4913 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4914 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4915 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4916 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4917 message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4920 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4921 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4922 start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4923 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
4924 filename can be used with &%-C%&.
4926 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4927 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4928 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4929 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4930 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4931 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4933 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4934 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4935 necessarily be discarded.
4936 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4937 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4938 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4939 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4940 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4941 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4943 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4944 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4945 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4946 looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
4947 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4948 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4949 each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4951 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4952 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4953 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4957 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4958 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4959 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4960 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4961 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4962 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4963 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4964 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4967 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4970 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4971 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4972 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4974 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4975 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4976 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4978 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4979 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4980 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4982 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4983 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4984 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4985 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4988 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4989 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4990 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4992 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4993 want to use this feature, you must set
4995 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4997 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4998 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
5001 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
5002 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
5003 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
5004 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
5006 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
5007 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
5008 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
5009 and does not introduce a comment.
5011 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
5012 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
5013 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
5014 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
5015 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
5017 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
5018 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
5019 change settings as required.
5021 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
5022 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
5023 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
5024 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
5025 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
5030 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
5031 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
5032 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
5033 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
5034 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
5035 You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
5038 &`.include`& <&'filename'&>
5039 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
5041 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
5042 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
5043 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
5044 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
5045 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
5048 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
5049 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
5050 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
5051 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
5053 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
5054 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
5057 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
5060 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
5061 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
5066 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
5067 .cindex "macro" "description of"
5068 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
5069 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
5070 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
5071 definition, and must be of the form
5073 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5075 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5076 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5077 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5078 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5079 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5081 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5082 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5083 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5085 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5086 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5087 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5088 scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5089 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5090 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5091 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5094 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5095 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5097 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5098 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5099 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5100 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5101 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5102 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5105 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5106 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5107 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5112 MAC == updated value
5114 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5115 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5116 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5117 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5121 MAC == MAC and something added
5123 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5124 from a number of other files.
5126 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5127 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5128 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5129 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5130 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5135 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5136 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5137 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5138 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5140 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5141 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5143 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5145 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5147 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5148 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5149 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5152 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5153 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5154 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5155 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5156 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5159 The following classes of macros are defined:
5161 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5162 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5163 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5164 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5165 &` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5166 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5167 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5168 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5169 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5170 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5171 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5172 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5175 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5178 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5179 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5180 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5181 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5182 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5183 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5184 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5186 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5187 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5188 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5192 message_size_limit = 50M
5194 message_size_limit = 100M
5197 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5198 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5199 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5200 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5201 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5203 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5204 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5205 in this line"& will always be true.
5207 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5208 to clarify complicated nestings.
5212 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5213 .cindex "common option syntax"
5214 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5215 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5216 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5217 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5218 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5219 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5220 space) and then the value. For example:
5222 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5224 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5225 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5226 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5227 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5228 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5229 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5230 word &"hide"&. For example:
5232 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5234 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5236 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5238 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5239 all instances of the same driver.
5241 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5242 that are found in option settings.
5245 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5246 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5247 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5248 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5249 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5250 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5251 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5252 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5253 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5254 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5255 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5256 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5261 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5266 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5271 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5272 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5273 .cindex "format" "integer"
5274 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5275 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5276 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5277 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5280 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5281 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5282 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5284 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5285 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5286 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5290 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5291 .cindex "integer format"
5292 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5293 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5294 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5295 Such options are always output in octal.
5298 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5299 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5300 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5301 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5302 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5306 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5307 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5308 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5309 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5310 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5320 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5321 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5322 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5326 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5327 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5328 .cindex "format" "string"
5329 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5330 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5331 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5332 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5333 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5334 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5335 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5336 therefore equivalent:
5338 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5339 trusted_users = uucp:\
5340 # This comment line is ignored
5343 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5344 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5345 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5346 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5347 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5350 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5351 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5352 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5354 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5355 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5359 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5360 character, that character replaces the pair.
5362 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5363 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5364 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5365 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5366 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5367 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5370 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5371 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5372 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5373 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5374 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5375 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5376 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5377 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5378 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5379 within a quoted configuration string.
5382 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5383 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5384 .cindex "format" "user name"
5385 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5386 .cindex "format" "group name"
5387 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5388 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5389 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5390 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5393 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5394 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5395 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5396 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5397 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5398 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5399 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5400 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5401 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5402 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5403 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5405 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5406 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5407 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5408 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5409 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5410 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5413 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5415 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5417 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5418 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5419 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5420 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5422 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5423 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5424 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5425 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5426 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5427 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5428 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5429 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5431 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5433 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5434 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5435 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5437 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5438 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5439 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5440 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5441 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5442 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5443 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5444 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5445 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5447 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5449 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5450 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5451 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5452 the value in quotes. For example:
5454 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5456 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5457 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5458 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5459 enclosing an empty list item.
5463 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5464 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5465 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5466 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5468 senders = user@domain :
5470 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5471 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5472 items, the second of which is empty:
5474 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5476 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5477 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5478 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5479 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5483 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5484 is at the end of the list.
5489 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5490 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5491 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5492 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5493 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5494 a sequence of lines like this:
5496 <&'instance name'&>:
5501 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5502 followed by three options settings:
5507 transport = local_delivery
5509 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5510 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5511 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5512 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5513 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5514 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5516 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5517 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5519 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5520 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5521 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5522 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5523 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5526 .cindex "generic options"
5527 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5528 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5529 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5530 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5531 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5532 .cindex "private options"
5533 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5534 they all have default values.
5536 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5537 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5538 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5540 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5541 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5542 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5543 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5544 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5545 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5546 configuration lines:
5551 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5552 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5553 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5554 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5560 command_timeout = 10s
5562 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5563 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5566 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5567 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5568 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5576 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5577 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5579 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5580 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5581 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5582 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5583 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5584 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5585 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5586 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5587 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5588 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5589 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5593 .section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5594 All macros should be defined before any options.
5596 One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5598 # ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5600 If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5601 hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5602 later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5603 deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5605 In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5606 to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5607 given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5610 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5611 The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5612 in the file, after the macros.
5613 The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5615 # primary_hostname =
5617 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5618 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5619 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5620 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5622 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5624 domainlist local_domains = @
5625 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5626 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5628 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5629 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5630 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5631 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5633 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5634 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5637 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5638 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5639 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5640 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5641 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5642 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5644 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5645 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5646 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5647 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5648 domain is permitted.
5650 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5651 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5652 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5653 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5654 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5655 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5657 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5658 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5659 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5661 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5663 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5664 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5666 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5667 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5668 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5669 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5670 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5671 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5672 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5673 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5674 contents of a message to be checked.
5676 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5678 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5679 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5681 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5682 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5683 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5684 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5686 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5688 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5689 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5690 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5692 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5693 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5694 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5695 connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5696 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5697 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5698 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5700 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5702 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5703 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5705 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5706 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5707 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5708 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5709 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5710 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5711 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5712 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5713 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5714 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5715 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5716 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5717 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5718 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5719 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5720 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5722 RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5723 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5724 RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5725 which should be used in preference to 587.
5726 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5728 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5730 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5733 # qualify_recipient =
5735 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5736 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5737 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5738 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5739 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5740 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5742 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5743 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5744 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5745 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5747 # allow_domain_literals
5749 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5750 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5751 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5752 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5753 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5754 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5756 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5760 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5761 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5762 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5763 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5764 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5765 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5766 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5767 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5769 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5770 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5775 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5776 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5777 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5778 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5779 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5780 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5783 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5784 1413 (hence their names):
5787 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5789 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5790 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5791 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5792 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5793 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5794 information, you can change this.
5796 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5797 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5802 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5803 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5804 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5805 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5807 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5808 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5810 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5811 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5813 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5816 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5817 +tls_certificate_verified
5820 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5822 # percent_hack_domains =
5824 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5825 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5826 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5828 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5829 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5830 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5831 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5832 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5833 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5834 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5835 always bounce messages.
5837 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5838 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5840 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5841 discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5842 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5843 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5844 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5846 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5847 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5848 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5849 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5850 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5853 # split_spool_directory = true
5856 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5857 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5858 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5859 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5860 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5861 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5862 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5864 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5867 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5868 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5869 that are not 8-bit clean.
5871 # accept_8bitmime = false
5874 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5875 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5876 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5877 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5878 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5879 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5881 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5882 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5886 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5887 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5888 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5889 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5890 It starts with the line
5894 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5895 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5896 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5898 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5899 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5900 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5901 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5902 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5903 result of the ACL processing.
5907 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5912 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5913 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5914 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5915 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5916 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5917 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5919 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5920 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5921 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5924 deny domains = +local_domains
5925 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5926 message = Restricted characters in address
5928 deny domains = !+local_domains
5929 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5930 message = Restricted characters in address
5932 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5933 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5934 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5935 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5936 in Internet mail addresses.
5938 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5939 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5940 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5941 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5942 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5943 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5944 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5945 policy of being as safe as possible.
5947 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5948 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5949 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5950 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5951 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5952 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5954 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5955 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5956 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5957 have to modify this rule.
5959 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5960 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5961 common convention of local parts constructed as
5962 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5963 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5964 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5965 filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5966 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5967 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5969 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5970 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5971 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5972 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5973 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5974 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5975 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5977 accept local_parts = postmaster
5978 domains = +local_domains
5980 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5981 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5982 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5983 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5984 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5986 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5987 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5988 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5990 require verify = sender
5992 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5993 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5994 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5995 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5996 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5997 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5998 discusses the details of address verification.
6000 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
6001 control = submission
6003 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
6004 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
6005 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
6006 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
6007 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
6008 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
6009 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
6010 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
6011 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
6013 accept authenticated = *
6014 control = submission
6016 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
6017 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
6018 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
6019 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
6020 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
6021 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
6023 require message = relay not permitted
6024 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
6026 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
6027 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
6029 require verify = recipient
6031 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
6032 fails, the address is rejected.
6034 # deny dnslists = black.list.example
6035 # message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
6036 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
6039 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
6040 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
6041 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
6042 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
6044 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
6045 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
6046 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
6049 # require verify = csa
6051 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
6052 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
6057 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
6058 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
6062 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
6063 of this ACL are commented out:
6066 # message = This message contains a virus \
6069 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
6070 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
6071 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6072 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6074 # warn spam = nobody
6075 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6076 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6077 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6078 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6080 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6081 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6082 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6083 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6084 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6085 whatever the spam score.
6089 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6092 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6093 .cindex "default" "routers"
6094 .cindex "routers" "default"
6095 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6100 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6101 messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6102 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6103 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6104 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6107 # driver = ipliteral
6108 # domains = !+local_domains
6109 # transport = remote_smtp
6111 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6112 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6113 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6114 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6115 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6117 Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6118 macro has been defined, per
6120 .ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6129 If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6130 command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6131 perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6132 skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6136 driver = manualroute
6137 domains = ! +local_domains
6138 transport = smarthost_smtp
6139 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6140 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6143 This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6144 specified by the line
6146 domains = ! +local_domains
6148 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6149 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6150 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6151 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6152 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6153 passed on to the following routers.
6155 The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6156 specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6157 While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6158 be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6160 With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6161 will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6162 other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6163 &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6164 are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6165 and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6166 &(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6171 domains = ! +local_domains
6172 transport = remote_smtp
6173 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6176 The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6178 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6179 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6180 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6181 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6182 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6184 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6185 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6186 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6187 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6188 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6189 the address fails and is bounced.
6191 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6192 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6193 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6194 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6195 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6196 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6197 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6204 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6206 file_transport = address_file
6207 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6209 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6210 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6211 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6212 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6213 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6216 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6217 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6218 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6219 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6224 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6225 # local_part_suffix_optional
6226 file = $home/.forward
6231 file_transport = address_file
6232 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6233 reply_transport = address_reply
6235 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6236 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6237 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6238 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6239 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6242 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6243 # local_part_suffix_optional
6245 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6246 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6247 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6248 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6249 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6250 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6251 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6253 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6254 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6255 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6256 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6258 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6259 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6260 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6261 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6262 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6263 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6264 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6266 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6267 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6268 There are two reasons for doing this:
6271 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6272 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6275 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6276 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6277 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6278 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6282 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6283 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6284 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6285 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6287 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6288 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6289 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6291 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6293 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6299 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6300 # local_part_suffix_optional
6301 transport = local_delivery
6303 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6304 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6305 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6306 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6307 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6310 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6311 .cindex "default" "transports"
6312 .cindex "transports" "default"
6313 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6314 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6315 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6319 Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6323 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6328 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6329 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6330 The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6331 with over-long lines.
6333 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6334 negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6335 but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6336 use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6338 The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6339 with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6340 usual federated system.
6345 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6349 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6350 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6351 hosts_require_tls = *
6352 tls_verify_hosts = *
6353 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this won't matter, but if you
6354 # have to comment it out then this will at least log whether you succeed
6356 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6358 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6359 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6360 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6361 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6362 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6363 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6365 .ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6366 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6369 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6376 After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6377 can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6378 that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6379 happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6380 All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6381 then no other options are defined.
6382 If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6383 and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6384 used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6385 Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6386 from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6387 mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6388 the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6389 to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6390 ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6391 You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6392 should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6394 For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6396 All other options are defaulted.
6400 file = /var/mail/$local_part_data
6407 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6408 traditional BSD mailbox format.
6411 We prefer to avoid using &$local_part$& directly to define the mailbox filename,
6412 as it is provided by a potential bad actor.
6413 Instead we use &$local_part_data$&,
6414 the result of looking up &$local_part$& in the user database
6415 (done by using &%check_local_user%& in the the router).
6418 By default &(appendfile)& runs under the uid and gid of the
6419 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6420 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6421 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6422 show how this can be done.
6424 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6425 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6426 similarly-named options above.
6432 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6433 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6434 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6435 be returned to the sender.
6443 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6444 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6445 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6450 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6455 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6456 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6457 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6458 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6459 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6460 introduced by the line
6464 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6467 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6469 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6470 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6471 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6472 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6473 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6475 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6476 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6477 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6480 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6481 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6485 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6486 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6490 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6491 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6492 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6494 begin authenticators
6496 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6497 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6498 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6499 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6500 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6501 to support most MUA software.
6503 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6506 # driver = plaintext
6507 # server_set_id = $auth2
6508 # server_prompts = :
6509 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6510 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6512 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6515 # driver = plaintext
6516 # server_set_id = $auth1
6517 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6518 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6519 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6522 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6523 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6524 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6525 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6526 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6527 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6528 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6529 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6531 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6532 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6533 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6534 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6536 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6537 usercode and password are in different positions.
6538 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6540 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6544 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6545 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6547 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6549 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6551 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6552 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6553 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6554 regular expressions is discussed in
6555 online Perl manpages, in
6556 many Perl reference books, and also in
6557 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6558 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6559 . --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6560 . --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6561 . --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6563 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6564 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6565 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6566 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6567 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6570 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6571 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6572 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6573 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6575 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6577 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6578 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6579 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6580 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6581 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6582 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6585 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6586 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6587 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6588 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6589 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6590 match anywhere in the subject string.
6592 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6593 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6595 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6597 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6600 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6602 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6603 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6607 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6608 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6610 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6611 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6612 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6613 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6614 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6615 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6618 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6619 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6620 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6621 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6622 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6623 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6625 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6626 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6627 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6628 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6629 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6630 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6633 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6634 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6635 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6636 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6637 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6638 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6640 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6641 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6642 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6643 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6644 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6646 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6647 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6649 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6650 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6651 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6652 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6653 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6655 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6656 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6658 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6659 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6660 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
6661 The result of the expansion is not tainted.
6663 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6664 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6665 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6670 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6671 matches the list item.
6673 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6674 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6676 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6678 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6679 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6680 causes a second lookup to occur.
6683 The lookup type may optionally be followed by a comma
6684 and a comma-separated list of options.
6685 Each option is a &"name=value"& pair.
6686 Whether an option is meaningful depands on the lookup type.
6689 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6690 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6691 lookup is permitted.
6694 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6695 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6696 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6697 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6700 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6701 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6702 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6704 .cindex "tainted data" "single-key lookups"
6705 The file string may not be tainted
6707 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
6708 All single-key lookups support the option &"ret=key"&.
6709 If this is given and the lookup
6710 (either underlying implementation or cached value)
6711 returns data, the result is replaced with a non-tainted
6712 version of the lookup key.
6715 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6716 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6717 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6718 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6721 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6722 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6723 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6728 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6729 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6730 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6735 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6736 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6737 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6738 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6741 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6742 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6743 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6744 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6745 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6746 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6747 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6748 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6749 tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6751 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6752 &url(https://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6753 &url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6754 &url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6756 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6757 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6758 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6759 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6761 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6762 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6763 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6764 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6765 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6766 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6767 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6769 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6770 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6771 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6772 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6773 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6774 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6775 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6777 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6778 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6780 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6781 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6782 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6783 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6784 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6785 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6786 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6788 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6789 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6790 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6792 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6793 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6794 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6795 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6796 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6797 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6798 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6799 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6800 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6801 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6803 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6804 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6805 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be an
6809 directory path; this is searched for an entry
6810 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function.
6812 contain any forward slash characters.
6813 If &[lstat()]& succeeds then so does the lookup.
6815 .cindex "tainted data" "dsearch result"
6816 The result is regarded as untainted.
6818 Options for the lookup can be given by appending them after the word "dsearch",
6819 separated by a comma. Options, if present, are a comma-separated list having
6820 each element starting with a tag name and an equals.
6822 Two options are supported, for the return value and for filtering match
6824 The "ret" option requests an alternate result value of
6825 the entire path for the entry. Example:
6827 ${lookup {passwd} dsearch,ret=full {/etc}}
6829 The default result is just the requested entry.
6830 The "filter" option requests that only directory entries of a given type
6831 are matched. The match value is one of "file", "dir" or "subdir" (the latter
6832 not matching "." or ".."). Example:
6834 ${lookup {passwd} dsearch,filter=file {/etc}}
6836 The default matching is for any entry type, including directories
6840 An example of how this
6841 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6842 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6844 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6845 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6846 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6847 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6848 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6849 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6850 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6852 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6853 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6854 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6855 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6857 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6858 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6859 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6860 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6861 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6863 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6864 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6865 lookup types support only literal keys.
6867 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6868 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6869 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6871 &*Warning 3*&: Do not use an IPv4-mapped IPv6 address for a key; use the
6872 IPv4, in dotted-quad form. (Exim converts IPv4-mapped IPv6 addresses to this
6873 notation before executing the lookup.)
6876 .cindex json "lookup type"
6877 .cindex JSON expansions
6878 &(json)&: The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
6879 An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
6880 The key is a list of subelement selectors
6881 (colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
6882 which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
6883 of the JSON structure.
6884 If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
6885 nunbered array element is selected.
6886 Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
6887 The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
6888 or array; for the latter two a string-representation of the JSON
6890 For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
6892 .cindex "linear search"
6893 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6894 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6895 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6896 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6897 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6898 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6899 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6900 in the file is used.
6902 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6903 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6904 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6905 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6906 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6911 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6912 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6913 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6914 wildcarding of any kind.
6916 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6917 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6918 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6919 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6920 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6921 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6922 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6923 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6924 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6927 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6928 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6929 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6930 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6931 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6932 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6933 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6934 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6937 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6938 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6939 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6940 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6941 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6942 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6943 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6944 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6945 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6947 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6948 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6949 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6950 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6952 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6953 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6956 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6958 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6959 *fish data for anythingfish
6962 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6963 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6965 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6967 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6968 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6969 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6971 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6973 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6974 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6975 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6977 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6980 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6981 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6982 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6983 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6984 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6986 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6987 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6988 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6989 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6990 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6993 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6994 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6995 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6998 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
7000 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
7003 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
7004 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
7005 be followed by optional colons.
7007 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
7008 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
7009 lookup types support only literal keys.
7012 .cindex "spf lookup type"
7013 .cindex "lookup" "spf"
7014 &(spf)&: If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
7015 (as opposed to the standard ACL condition method).
7016 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
7020 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
7021 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
7022 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
7023 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
7024 many of them are given in later sections.
7027 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7028 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
7029 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
7030 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
7031 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
7033 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7034 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7035 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
7037 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
7038 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7039 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
7040 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
7041 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
7042 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
7043 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
7045 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7046 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7047 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
7048 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7050 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7051 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7052 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
7053 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
7055 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7056 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7057 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
7058 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7060 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
7061 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
7062 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
7063 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
7064 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
7065 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
7066 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
7067 password value. For example:
7069 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
7072 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7073 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7074 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
7075 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7078 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7079 .cindex lookup Redis
7080 &(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
7081 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7084 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7085 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
7086 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is
7088 an optional filename
7090 followed by an SQL statement
7091 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
7094 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
7095 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
7097 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
7098 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
7099 . --- still http:-only, 2018-09-07
7100 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
7101 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
7102 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
7103 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
7104 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
7105 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
7106 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
7108 require condition = \
7109 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
7111 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
7112 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
7113 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
7114 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
7119 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
7120 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
7121 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
7122 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
7123 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
7124 options such as a list of local domains.
7126 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
7127 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
7128 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
7129 or may give up altogether.
7133 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7134 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7135 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
7136 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7137 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7138 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7139 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7140 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7142 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7143 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7144 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7146 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7147 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7148 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7150 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7151 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7152 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7153 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7154 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7155 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7156 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7157 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7158 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7159 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7161 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7163 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7164 looks up these keys, in this order:
7170 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7171 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7172 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7173 Exim move on to try the next key.
7177 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7178 .cindex "partial matching"
7179 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7180 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7181 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7182 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7183 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7184 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7185 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7186 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7187 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7188 a key in a DBM file is
7190 *.dates.fict.example
7192 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7193 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7194 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7197 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7198 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7199 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7201 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7202 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7203 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7204 partial matching keys
7205 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7206 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7207 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7209 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7210 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7211 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7212 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7213 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7214 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7217 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7218 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7219 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7220 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7221 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7222 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7224 2250.dates.fict.example
7225 *.2250.dates.fict.example
7226 *.dates.fict.example
7229 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7232 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7233 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7234 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7235 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7236 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7237 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7239 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7241 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7242 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7243 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7244 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7246 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7248 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7249 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7251 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7252 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7253 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7256 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7258 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7259 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7261 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7262 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7263 for &"*"& on its own.
7265 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7269 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7270 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7271 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7272 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7273 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7274 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7275 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7277 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7278 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7279 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7280 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7281 subject key is always followed by a dot.
7286 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7287 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
7288 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7289 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7290 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7291 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7292 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7294 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7295 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7296 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7297 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7298 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7299 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7301 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7302 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7308 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7309 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7310 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7311 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7312 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7313 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7317 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7318 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7320 [name="$local_part"]
7322 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7323 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7324 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7325 of the following form is provided:
7327 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7329 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7331 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7333 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7334 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7335 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7340 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7341 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7342 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7343 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7344 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7345 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7346 an expansion string could contain:
7348 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7350 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7351 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7352 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7353 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7355 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7356 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7357 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7359 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7360 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7361 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7362 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7363 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7365 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7367 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7368 white space is ignored.
7369 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7370 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7371 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7373 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7374 When the type is PTR,
7375 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7376 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7378 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7380 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7381 altered and nothing is added.
7383 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7384 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7385 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7386 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7387 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7388 The field separator can be modified as above.
7390 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7391 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7392 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7393 unless a field separator is specified.
7394 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7396 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7398 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7399 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7400 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7402 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7403 white space is ignored.
7405 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7406 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7407 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7408 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7411 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7414 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7415 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7416 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7417 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7418 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7419 each followed by a comma,
7420 that may appear before the record type.
7422 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7423 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7424 a defer-option modifier.
7425 The possible keywords are
7426 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7427 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7428 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7429 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7430 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7431 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7432 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7434 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7435 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7437 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7438 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7440 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7441 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7442 The possible keywords are
7443 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7444 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7446 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7447 is not labelled as authenticated data
7448 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7449 The default is &"lax"&.
7451 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7453 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7454 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7455 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7456 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7458 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7460 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7461 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7462 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7464 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7465 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7467 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7468 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7469 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7472 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7473 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7474 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7475 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7476 the pseudo-type MXH:
7478 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7480 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7483 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7484 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7485 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7486 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7487 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7488 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7489 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7490 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7492 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7493 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7495 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7496 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7497 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7499 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7500 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7501 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7502 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7503 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7506 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7507 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7508 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7509 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7510 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7511 result of a successful lookup such as:
7513 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7515 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7516 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7517 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7519 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7520 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7521 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7522 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7524 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7528 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7529 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7530 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7531 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7532 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7534 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7535 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7536 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7538 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7539 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7540 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7541 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7543 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7544 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7545 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7550 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7551 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7552 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7553 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7554 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7555 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7556 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7557 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7558 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7559 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7560 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7561 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7563 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7564 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7565 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7566 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7567 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7569 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7570 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7572 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7573 the way they handle the results of a query:
7576 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7579 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7580 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7582 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7583 from all of them are returned.
7587 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7588 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7589 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7590 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7593 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7594 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7595 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7596 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7598 data = ${lookup ldap \
7599 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7600 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7602 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7603 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7604 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7605 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7607 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7608 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7609 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7611 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7612 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7613 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7614 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7615 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7616 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7617 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7618 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7622 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7623 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7624 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7625 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7626 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7627 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7629 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7630 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7638 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7639 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7643 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7645 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7649 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7651 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7653 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7655 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7656 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7657 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7661 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7662 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7663 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7665 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7669 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7671 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7673 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7675 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7676 authentication below.
7679 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7680 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7681 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7682 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7683 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7686 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7688 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7689 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7690 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7691 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7692 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7693 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7694 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7695 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7696 failures, and timeouts.
7698 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7699 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7700 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7701 doubled. For example
7703 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7705 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7706 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7707 the local host) is used.
7709 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7710 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7711 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7712 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7715 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7716 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7717 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7718 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7720 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7722 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7723 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7725 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7727 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7728 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7729 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7730 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7731 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7732 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7733 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7736 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7737 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7738 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7741 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7744 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7748 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7749 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7753 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7754 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7755 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7756 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7757 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7758 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7759 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7760 them. The following names are recognized:
7762 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7763 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7764 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7765 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7766 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7767 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7768 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7769 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7771 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7772 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7773 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7774 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7776 .cindex LDAP timeout
7777 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7778 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7779 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7780 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7781 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7782 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7783 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7784 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7785 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7786 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7788 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7789 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7791 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7792 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7793 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7794 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7795 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7796 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7797 alternate list (colon-separated).
7799 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7800 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7803 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7804 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7807 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7808 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7809 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7810 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7812 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7813 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7814 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7816 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7817 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7818 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7819 quoting has two advantages:
7822 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7823 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7825 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7828 For example, a setting such as
7830 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7832 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7834 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7835 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7836 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7837 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7841 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7842 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7847 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7848 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7849 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7850 as a sequence of values, for example
7852 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7854 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7855 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7856 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7857 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7858 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7861 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7862 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7863 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7864 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7866 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7867 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7868 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7869 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7870 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7871 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7872 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7873 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7874 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7876 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7877 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7878 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7879 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7880 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7883 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7886 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7889 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7890 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7892 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7893 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7895 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7896 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7899 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7900 results of LDAP lookups.
7901 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7902 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7903 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7904 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7905 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7906 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7911 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7912 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7913 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7914 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7915 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7916 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7917 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7918 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7920 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7922 might return the string
7924 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7925 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7927 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7929 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7935 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7936 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7937 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7941 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7942 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7943 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7944 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7945 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7946 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7947 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7948 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7949 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7950 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7951 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7952 .cindex lookup Redis
7953 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7955 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7958 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7961 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7962 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7964 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7969 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7971 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7972 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7973 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7977 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7978 with a newline between the data for each row.
7981 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7982 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7983 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7984 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7985 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7986 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7987 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7988 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7989 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7990 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7991 .cindex lookup Redis
7992 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7993 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7994 or &%redis_servers%&
7995 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7997 .oindex &%mysql_servers%&
7998 .oindex &%pgsql_servers%&
7999 .oindex &%oracle_servers%&
8000 .oindex &%ibase_servers%&
8001 .oindex &%redis_servers%&
8002 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
8003 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
8004 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
8006 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
8007 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
8008 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
8009 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
8011 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
8013 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
8014 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
8015 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
8017 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
8018 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
8020 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
8021 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
8022 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
8023 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
8024 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
8025 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
8027 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
8028 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
8029 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
8031 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
8032 host, database number, and password.
8034 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
8035 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
8036 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
8038 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
8040 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
8043 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
8044 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
8045 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
8046 itself are escaped with backslashes.
8048 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
8049 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
8051 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
8053 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
8054 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
8055 done by appending a comma-separated option to the query type:
8057 &`,servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&
8060 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
8062 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
8063 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
8064 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
8067 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
8069 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
8070 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
8071 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
8073 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
8074 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
8075 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
8078 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
8082 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
8084 ${lookup mysql,servers=master {UPDATE ...} }
8086 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
8087 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
8088 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
8090 ${lookup pgsql,servers=master/db/name/pw {UPDATE ...} }
8094 An older syntax places the servers speciification before the qury,
8095 semicolon separated:
8097 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
8099 The new version avoids potential issues with tainted
8100 arguments in the query, for explicit expansion.
8101 &*Note*&: server specifications in list-style lookups are still problematic.
8105 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
8106 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
8107 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
8108 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
8109 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
8110 the default value is &"exim"&.
8111 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
8113 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
8114 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
8116 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
8117 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
8119 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
8122 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
8123 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
8125 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
8126 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
8127 is zero because no rows are affected.
8130 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
8131 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
8132 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
8133 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
8134 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
8137 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
8139 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
8140 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
8141 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
8143 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
8144 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
8147 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
8148 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
8149 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
8150 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8151 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8152 daemon as in the other SQL databases.
8155 .oindex &%sqlite_dbfile%&
8156 The preferred way of specifying the file is by using the
8157 &%sqlite_dbfile%& option, set to
8160 A deprecated method is available, prefixing the query with the filename
8161 separated by white space.
8162 This means that the path name cannot contain white space.
8163 .cindex "tainted data" "sqlite file"
8164 It also means that the query cannot use any tainted values, as that taints
8165 the entire query including the filename - resulting in a refusal to open
8169 Here is a lookup expansion example:
8171 sqlite_dbfile = /some/thing/sqlitedb
8173 ${lookup sqlite {select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8175 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8177 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;\
8178 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8181 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8182 quote, which it doubles.
8184 .cindex timeout SQLite
8185 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8186 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8187 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8188 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8189 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8190 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8191 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8194 .section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
8195 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8196 .cindex "redis lookup type"
8197 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8200 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8201 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8204 As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8205 Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8206 of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8207 master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8210 When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8211 immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8212 to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8219 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8220 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8222 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8223 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8224 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8225 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8226 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8227 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8228 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8229 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8230 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8232 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8233 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8234 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8235 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8237 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8238 support all the complexity available in
8239 domain, host, address and local part lists.
8243 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8244 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8245 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
8247 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8248 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8251 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8252 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8253 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8254 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8255 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8258 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8259 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8260 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8262 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8263 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8264 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8265 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8266 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8268 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8269 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8271 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8272 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8273 senders based on the receiving domain.
8278 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
8279 .cindex "list" "negation"
8280 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
8281 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8282 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8283 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8284 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8285 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8287 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8288 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8289 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8290 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8291 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8293 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8295 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8296 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8297 list is positive. However, if the setting were
8299 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8301 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8302 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8303 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8305 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8306 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8311 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
8312 .cindex "list" "filename in"
8313 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8314 filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8315 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8316 filenames are not allowed,
8317 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8318 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8322 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8323 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8325 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8326 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8327 white space or the start of the line. For example:
8329 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8333 Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8334 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8335 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8336 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8338 If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8339 within the file is inverted. For example, if
8341 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8343 and the file contains the lines
8348 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8349 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8353 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
8354 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8355 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8356 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8357 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8358 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8359 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8360 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8362 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8363 list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8364 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8365 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8371 .section "Results of list checking" SECTlistresults
8372 The primary result of doing a list check is a truth value.
8373 In some contexts additional information is stored
8374 about the list element that matched:
8377 A &%hosts%& ACL condition
8378 will store a result in the &$host_data$& variable.
8380 A &%local_parts%& router option or &%local_parts%& ACL condition
8381 will store a result in the &$local_part_data$& variable.
8383 A &%domains%& router option or &%domains%& ACL condition
8385 A &%senders%& router option or &%senders%& ACL condition
8386 will store a result in the &$sender_data$& variable.
8388 A &%recipients%& ACL condition
8389 will store a result in the &$recipient_data$& variable.
8392 The detail of the additional information depends on the
8393 type of match and is given below as the &*value*& information.
8399 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8400 .cindex "named lists"
8401 .cindex "list" "named"
8402 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8403 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8404 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8405 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8406 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8407 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8408 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8410 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8412 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8413 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8414 configured with the line
8416 domains = +local_domains
8418 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8419 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8423 domains = ! +local_domains
8424 transport = remote_smtp
8427 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8428 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8429 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8430 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8432 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8433 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8435 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8437 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8438 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8439 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8441 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8442 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8443 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8445 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8446 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8448 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8449 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8450 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8452 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8454 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8455 referenced lists if you can.
8458 .cindex "hiding named list values"
8459 .cindex "named lists" "hiding value of"
8460 Some named list definitions may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
8461 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
8462 line option to read these values, you can precede the definition with the
8463 word &"hide"&. For example:
8465 hide domainlist filter_for_domains = ldap;PASS=secret ldap::/// ...
8470 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8471 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8472 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8474 domains = +local_domains
8476 on several of your routers
8477 or in several ACL statements,
8478 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8479 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8480 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8481 the same each time they are referenced.
8483 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8484 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8485 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8486 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8490 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8491 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8492 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8493 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8494 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8497 ALIST = host1 : host2
8498 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8500 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8502 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8504 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8507 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8508 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8510 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8512 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8516 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8517 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8518 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8519 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8520 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8521 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8522 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8523 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8524 message. For example:
8526 domainlist special_domains = \
8527 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8529 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8530 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8531 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8532 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8533 same list each time.
8535 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8536 cache the result anyway. For example:
8538 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8540 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8541 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8545 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8546 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8547 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8548 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8549 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8552 .cindex "primary host name"
8553 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8554 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8555 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8556 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8557 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8558 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8559 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8560 differ only in their names.
8563 The value for a match will be the primary host name.
8568 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8569 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8570 .cindex "domain literal"
8571 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8572 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8573 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8574 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8575 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8576 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial;
8577 see the &%allow_domain_literals%& main option.
8580 The value for a match will be the string &`@[]`&.
8586 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8587 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8588 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8589 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8590 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8591 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8592 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8593 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8594 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8595 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8596 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8598 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8599 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8600 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8601 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8602 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8604 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8605 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8606 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8607 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8608 on a router). For example:
8610 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8612 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8613 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8615 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8616 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8617 contain negative items.
8619 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8620 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8621 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8623 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8624 an.other.domain : ...
8626 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8627 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8629 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8630 an.other.domain ? ...
8633 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting &`@mx_`&).
8638 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8639 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8640 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8641 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8642 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8643 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8644 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8645 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8646 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8650 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting with the asterisk).
8651 Additionally, &$0$& will be set to the matched string
8652 and &$1$& to the variable portion which the asterisk matched.
8656 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8657 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8658 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8659 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8660 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8661 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8662 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8663 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8664 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8666 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8667 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8668 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8669 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8670 expression by expansion, of course).
8673 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting with the circumflex).
8674 Additionally, &$0$& will be set to the string matching the regular expression,
8675 and &$1$& (onwards) to any submatches identified by parentheses.
8681 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8682 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8683 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8684 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8685 must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8686 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8688 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8690 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8691 key. In most cases, the value resulting from the lookup is not used; Exim is interested
8692 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8693 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8694 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the value is preserved in the
8695 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8696 other statements in the same ACL.
8697 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8698 The value will be untainted.
8702 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8703 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8705 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8707 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8708 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8711 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8712 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8713 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8714 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8715 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8716 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8720 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8721 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8722 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8723 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8725 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8726 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8728 In most cases, the value resulting from the lookup is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8729 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8730 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8731 &%domains%& option on a router, the value is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8732 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8733 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8734 The value will be untainted.
8738 If the pattern starts with the name of a lookup type
8739 of either kind (single-key or query-style) it may be
8740 followed by a comma and options,
8741 The options are lookup-type specific and consist of a comma-separated list.
8742 Each item starts with a tag and and equals "=".
8746 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8747 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8748 between the pattern and the domain.
8750 The value for a match will be the list element string.
8751 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8752 Note that this is commonly untainted
8753 (depending on the way the list was created).
8754 Specifically, explicit text in the configuration file in not tainted.
8755 This is a useful way of obtaining an untainted equivalent to
8756 the domain, for later operations.
8758 However if the list (including one-element lists)
8759 is created by expanding a variable containing tainted data,
8760 it is tainted and so will the match value be.
8764 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8766 domainlist funny_domains = \
8769 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8770 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8771 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8772 nis;domains.byname : \
8773 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8775 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8776 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8777 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8778 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8779 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8784 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8785 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8786 .cindex "list" "host list"
8787 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8788 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8789 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8790 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8791 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8792 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8793 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8796 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8797 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8798 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8799 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8800 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8801 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8804 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8805 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8806 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8810 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8811 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8812 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8813 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8814 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8815 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8816 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8819 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8820 inspecting its IP address:
8823 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8824 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8825 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8826 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8827 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8828 with the IP address of the subject host.
8830 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8831 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8832 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8833 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8834 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8837 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8838 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8839 domain name, as just described.
8842 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8843 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8844 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8845 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8846 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8847 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8848 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8849 that can never match a client host.
8852 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8853 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8854 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8855 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8857 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8861 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8862 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8863 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8864 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8865 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8866 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8867 significant end of the address.
8869 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8870 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8871 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8872 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8876 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8877 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8880 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8882 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8883 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8885 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8886 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8889 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8891 could make use of a file containing
8896 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8897 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8898 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8900 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8903 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8909 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8910 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8911 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8912 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8913 address, the pattern takes this form:
8915 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8919 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8921 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8922 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8923 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8924 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8925 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8926 returned by the lookup is not used.
8928 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8929 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8930 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8931 patterns of this form:
8933 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8937 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8939 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8940 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8941 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8942 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8943 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8945 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8946 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8947 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8948 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8949 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8950 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8951 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8952 converted using colons and not dots.
8953 In all cases except IPv4-mapped IPv6, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8954 addresses are always used.
8955 The latter are converted to IPv4 addresses, in dotted-quad form.
8957 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8958 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8959 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8962 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8963 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8964 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8965 case the IP address is used on its own.
8969 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8970 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8971 .cindex "unknown host name"
8972 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8973 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8974 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8975 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8976 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8979 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8980 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8981 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8982 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8983 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8984 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8985 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8987 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8988 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8990 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8991 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8992 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8993 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8994 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8995 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8996 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8997 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8998 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
9000 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
9001 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
9003 .cindex "host" "alias for"
9004 .cindex "alias for host"
9005 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
9006 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
9009 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
9010 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
9011 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
9012 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
9013 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
9016 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
9017 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
9018 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
9019 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
9020 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
9021 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
9022 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
9027 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
9028 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
9029 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
9030 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
9031 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9033 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
9035 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
9036 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
9037 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
9044 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
9045 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
9046 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
9047 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
9048 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
9049 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
9051 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
9052 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
9054 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
9055 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
9056 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
9057 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
9058 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
9059 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
9060 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
9061 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
9062 not recognized in an indirected file).
9065 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
9066 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
9068 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
9070 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
9071 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
9074 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
9075 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
9078 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
9081 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
9082 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
9083 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
9086 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
9087 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
9090 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
9092 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
9094 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
9095 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
9096 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
9099 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
9100 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
9101 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
9103 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
9105 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
9106 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
9107 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
9108 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
9109 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
9110 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
9111 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
9114 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
9115 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
9117 accept hosts = *.friend.example
9118 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
9120 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
9121 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
9122 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
9127 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
9129 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
9130 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
9131 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
9132 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
9133 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
9134 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
9135 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
9136 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
9137 host lists such as whitelists.
9141 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
9142 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
9143 .cindex "unknown host name"
9144 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
9145 If a pattern is of the form
9147 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
9151 dbm;/host/accept/list
9153 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
9154 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
9157 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
9158 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
9159 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
9160 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
9161 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
9162 lookup, both using the same file.
9166 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
9167 If a pattern is of the form
9169 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
9171 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
9172 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
9173 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
9175 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
9176 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
9178 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
9179 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
9180 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
9183 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
9184 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
9185 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
9187 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
9188 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
9189 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
9190 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
9191 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
9192 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
9198 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
9199 .cindex "list" "address list"
9200 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
9201 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
9202 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
9203 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
9204 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
9205 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
9206 using this option setting:
9210 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
9211 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
9212 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
9213 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
9215 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
9218 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
9220 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
9221 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
9222 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
9223 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
9224 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
9225 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
9226 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
9228 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
9229 *@+hostile_domains:\
9230 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
9231 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
9233 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9234 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
9235 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
9236 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
9237 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
9239 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
9240 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
9241 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
9242 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
9243 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
9245 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
9248 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
9249 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
9253 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
9254 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
9255 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
9256 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
9257 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
9258 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
9259 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9261 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
9262 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
9264 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
9265 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
9268 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
9269 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
9270 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
9273 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9274 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9275 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9277 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9278 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9279 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9280 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9282 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9283 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9285 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9286 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9287 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9288 default. For example, with this lookup:
9290 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9292 the file could contains lines like this:
9294 user1@domain1.example
9297 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9300 nimrod@jaeger.example
9304 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9305 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9307 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9309 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9310 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9312 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9313 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9314 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9318 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9319 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9324 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9325 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9326 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9327 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9328 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9329 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9330 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9331 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9332 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9334 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9335 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9336 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9337 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9338 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9341 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9343 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9345 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9347 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9349 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9350 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9351 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9352 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9353 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9354 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9356 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9359 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9362 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9363 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9364 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9365 might have entries like
9367 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9368 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9371 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9372 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9373 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9374 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9376 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9377 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9378 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9381 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9382 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9383 can only return a single list of local parts.
9386 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9387 in these two examples:
9390 senders = *@+my_list
9392 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9393 example it is a named domain list.
9398 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
9399 .cindex "case of local parts"
9400 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9401 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9402 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9403 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9404 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
9405 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9406 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9407 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9410 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9411 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9412 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9413 the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9414 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9415 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9416 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9419 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9420 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9421 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9422 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9423 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9424 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9425 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9426 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9430 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9431 .cindex "list" "local part list"
9432 .cindex "local part" "list"
9433 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9434 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9435 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9436 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9437 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9438 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9439 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9440 option is case-sensitive from the start.
9442 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9443 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9444 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9445 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9446 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9447 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9448 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9450 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
9455 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9456 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9458 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9459 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9460 Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9461 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9463 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9464 .cindex expansion "string concatenation"
9465 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9466 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9467 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9468 escape character, as described in the following section.
9470 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9471 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9472 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
9473 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9474 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9476 .cindex "tainted data" expansion
9477 .cindex expansion "tainted data"
9478 and expansion of data deriving from the sender (&"tainted data"&)
9483 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9484 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9485 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9486 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9487 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9488 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9489 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9490 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9492 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9493 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9494 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9495 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9497 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9499 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9500 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9505 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9506 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9507 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9508 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9509 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9510 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9511 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9514 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9515 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9516 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9519 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9520 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9521 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9523 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9524 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9525 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9526 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9527 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9528 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9529 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9532 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9533 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9534 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9537 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9538 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9539 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9540 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9542 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9544 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9545 Exim message identifier. For example:
9547 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9549 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9550 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9553 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9554 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9555 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9556 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9557 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9558 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9559 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9560 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9561 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9562 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9563 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9564 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9570 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9571 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9572 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9573 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9574 white space is significant.
9577 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9578 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9579 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9584 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9585 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9586 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9587 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9588 given, the expansion fails.
9590 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9591 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9592 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9593 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9597 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9598 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9599 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9600 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9601 string easier to understand.
9603 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9604 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9605 expansion item below.
9608 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9609 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9610 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9611 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9612 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9613 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9614 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9615 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9616 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9617 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9618 the result of the expansion.
9619 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9620 the expansion result is an empty string.
9621 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9624 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9625 .cindex authentication "results header"
9626 .cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9627 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
9628 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9629 &'Authentication-Results:'&
9631 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9632 will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9633 Methods that might be present in the result include:
9642 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9644 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9646 This is safe even if no authentication results are available.
9649 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9650 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9651 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9652 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9653 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9654 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9655 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9656 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9660 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9661 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9666 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9670 If the field is found,
9671 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9672 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9673 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9674 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9676 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9677 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9680 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9682 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9683 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9685 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9686 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9687 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9688 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9689 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9690 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9691 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9692 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9694 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9695 take an optional modifier of "int"
9696 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9697 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9698 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9700 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9701 newline-separated by default,
9702 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9703 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9704 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9706 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9707 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9708 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9709 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9710 if so the element tags are omitted.
9712 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9714 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9715 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9717 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9718 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9722 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9723 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9724 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9726 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function.
9729 a local function that is to be called in this way,
9730 first &_DLFUNC_IMPL_& should be defined,
9731 and second &_local_scan.h_& should be included.
9732 The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9733 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9734 must have the following type:
9736 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9738 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9739 function should return one of the following values:
9741 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9742 into the expanded string that is being built.
9744 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9745 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9747 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9748 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9750 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9752 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9753 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9754 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9757 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9758 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9759 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9760 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9762 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9763 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9764 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9766 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9767 appear, for example:
9769 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9771 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9772 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9774 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9776 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9779 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9780 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9783 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9784 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9785 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9786 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9787 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9788 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9789 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9790 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9792 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9795 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9796 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9797 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9798 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9799 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9800 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9801 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9802 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9803 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9805 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9806 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9807 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9810 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9811 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9813 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9814 appear, for example:
9816 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9818 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9819 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9821 .vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9822 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9823 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9824 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9825 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
9826 .cindex JSON expansions
9827 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9828 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9829 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9830 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9832 { <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
9835 The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
9836 the spaces are optional.
9837 Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
9838 For the &"json"& variant,
9839 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9841 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9842 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9843 . XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
9845 The results of matching are handled as above.
9848 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9849 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9850 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9851 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9852 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9853 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9854 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9855 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9856 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9857 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9858 <&'string3'&> as before.
9860 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9861 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9862 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9863 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9864 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9865 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9866 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9867 provided. For example:
9869 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9873 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9875 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9876 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9879 .vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9880 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9881 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9882 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9883 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
9884 .cindex JSON expansions
9885 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9886 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9888 Field selection and result handling is as above;
9889 there is no choice of field separator.
9890 For the &"json"& variant,
9891 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9893 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9894 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9897 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9898 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9899 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9901 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9902 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9904 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9905 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9906 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9907 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9908 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9910 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9912 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9913 to what it was before. See also the &%map%& and &%reduce%& expansion items.
9916 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9917 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9918 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9919 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9920 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9921 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9923 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9924 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9925 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9926 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9928 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9930 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9931 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9932 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9933 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9934 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9936 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9938 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9939 letters appear. For example:
9941 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9942 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9943 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9946 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9947 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9948 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9949 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9950 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9951 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9952 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9953 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9954 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9955 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9956 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9957 .vindex "&$lheader_$&"
9958 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9959 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9960 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9961 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9962 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9966 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9967 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9968 lines) may be present.
9970 The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
9971 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9974 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9975 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9976 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9979 .cindex "list" "of header lines"
9980 &%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
9981 are multiple headers with a given name.
9982 Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
9983 list-processing facilities can be used.
9984 The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
9985 the content is &"raw"&.
9988 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9989 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9990 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9991 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9992 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9993 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9994 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9995 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9998 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9999 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
10000 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
10001 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
10002 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
10003 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
10006 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
10007 command of the following form:
10009 headers charset "UTF-8"
10011 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
10012 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
10013 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
10014 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
10015 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
10018 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
10019 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
10020 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
10021 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
10023 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
10024 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
10025 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
10026 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
10027 router or transport are not accessible.
10029 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
10030 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
10031 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
10032 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
10033 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
10034 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
10035 point they are added.
10036 When any of the above ACLs ar
10037 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
10039 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
10040 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
10041 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
10042 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
10043 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
10044 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
10045 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
10048 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
10049 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
10050 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
10051 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
10052 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
10053 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
10054 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
10055 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
10058 .cindex "tainted data"
10059 When the headers are from an incoming message,
10060 the result of expanding any of these variables is tainted.
10064 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
10065 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
10067 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
10068 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
10069 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
10070 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
10071 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
10072 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
10073 present. For example:
10075 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
10077 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
10080 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
10082 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
10083 an Exim configuration:
10085 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
10087 In a router or a transport you could then have:
10090 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
10091 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
10092 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
10094 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
10095 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
10096 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
10097 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
10098 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
10099 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
10102 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10103 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
10104 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
10105 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
10106 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
10107 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
10109 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
10111 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
10112 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
10113 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
10114 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
10115 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
10117 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
10118 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
10119 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
10121 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
10125 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
10130 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
10131 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
10132 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
10133 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
10134 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
10135 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
10139 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10140 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10141 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10142 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
10143 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
10144 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
10145 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
10146 some of the braces:
10148 ${length_<n>:<string>}
10150 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
10151 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
10152 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
10153 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10156 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
10157 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10158 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
10159 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
10160 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
10161 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
10162 apart from an optional leading minus,
10163 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
10165 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10166 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10168 The first field of the list is numbered one.
10169 If the number is negative, the fields are
10170 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
10171 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
10172 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
10174 If the modulus of the
10175 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
10176 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
10180 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
10184 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
10186 yields &"result: 42"&.
10188 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
10189 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
10191 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
10195 .vitem &*${listquote{*&<&'separator'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
10196 .cindex quoting "for list"
10197 .cindex list quoting
10198 This item doubles any occurrence of the separator character
10199 in the given string.
10200 An empty string is replaced with a single space.
10201 This converts the string into a safe form for use as a list element,
10202 in a list using the given separator.
10206 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
10207 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10208 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
10209 described in the next item.
10211 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
10212 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10213 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
10214 .cindex "file" "lookups"
10215 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
10216 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
10217 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
10218 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
10219 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
10221 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
10222 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
10223 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
10224 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
10225 out by the system administrator.
10227 .vindex "&$value$&"
10228 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
10229 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
10230 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
10231 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
10232 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
10233 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
10234 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
10235 original lookup fails.
10237 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
10238 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
10239 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
10240 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
10241 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
10242 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
10243 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
10244 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
10246 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
10247 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
10248 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
10249 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
10251 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
10252 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
10253 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
10254 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
10256 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
10258 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
10260 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
10261 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
10263 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
10268 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10269 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
10271 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10272 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10274 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
10275 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
10276 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
10277 setting is not included in the output. For example:
10279 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
10281 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
10282 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &%filter%&
10283 and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10285 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10286 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10287 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10288 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10289 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10290 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10291 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10293 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10295 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10296 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10297 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10298 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10301 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10303 returns the string &"6/33"&.
10307 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10308 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10309 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10310 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10311 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10312 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10313 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10314 name of the subroutine, is nine.
10316 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10317 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
10318 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
10319 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
10320 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10323 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10324 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10325 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10327 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10328 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10331 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10332 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10333 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10334 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10335 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10336 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10337 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10338 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10340 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10341 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10342 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10343 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10344 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10345 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10346 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10347 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10348 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10349 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10351 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10352 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10353 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10354 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10356 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10357 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10358 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10359 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10360 is the expansion of the third argument.
10362 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10363 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10364 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10366 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10367 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10368 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10369 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10370 The filename and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
10371 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10372 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10373 newlines are left in the string.
10374 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10375 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10376 the string expansion fails.
10378 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10379 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10383 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10384 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10385 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10386 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10387 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10388 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10389 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10392 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10393 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10395 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10396 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10397 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10398 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10399 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10402 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10404 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10405 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10406 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10407 unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10408 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10409 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10410 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10412 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10415 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10416 and must be present if any options are given.
10417 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10420 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10424 The following option names are recognised:
10427 Defines if the result data can be cached for use by a later identical
10428 request in the same process.
10429 Values are &"yes"& or &"no"& (the default).
10430 If not, all cached results for this connection specification
10431 will be invalidated.
10435 Defines whether or not a write-shutdown is done on the connection after
10436 sending the request. Values are &"yes"& (the default) or &"no"&
10437 (preferred, eg. by some webservers).
10441 Controls the use of TLS on the connection.
10442 Values are &"yes"& or &"no"& (the default).
10443 If it is enabled, a shutdown as descripbed above is never done.
10448 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10449 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10450 turns them into spaces:
10452 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10454 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10455 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10456 addition, the following errors can occur:
10459 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10461 Failure to connect the socket;
10463 Failure to write the request string;
10465 Timeout on reading from the socket.
10468 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10469 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10470 errors occurs. For example:
10472 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10475 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10476 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10477 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10478 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10479 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10481 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10482 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10485 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10486 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10487 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10488 .vindex "&$value$&"
10490 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
10491 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
10492 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10493 Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10494 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10495 list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10496 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10497 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10498 added to the expansion output. The &%reduce%& expansion item can be used in a
10499 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10501 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10503 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10506 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10508 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10509 restored to what they were before. See also the &%filter%& and &%map%&
10512 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10513 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10514 expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10516 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10517 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10518 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10519 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10520 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
10521 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
10522 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10523 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10524 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10526 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10527 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10528 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10529 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10530 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10531 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10532 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10533 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10534 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10537 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10538 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10539 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10540 .vindex "&$value$&"
10541 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10542 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10543 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10544 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10545 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10548 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10549 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10550 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10551 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10553 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10554 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10555 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10558 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10559 log_message = Output of id: $value
10561 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10562 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10564 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10567 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
10568 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10569 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10571 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10572 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10576 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10577 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10580 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10581 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10582 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10583 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10585 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10586 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10589 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10590 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10591 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10592 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10593 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10594 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10595 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10596 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10598 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10600 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10601 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10602 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10604 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10606 yields &"defabc"&, and
10608 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10610 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10611 the regular expression from string expansion.
10613 The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10614 rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10617 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10618 .cindex sorting "a list"
10619 .cindex list sorting
10620 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10621 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10622 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10623 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10624 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10625 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10626 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10627 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10628 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10629 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10630 to give values for comparison.
10632 The item result is a sorted list,
10633 with the original list separator,
10634 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10638 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10640 sorts a list of numbers, and
10642 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10644 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10647 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10648 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10649 .cindex "substring extraction"
10650 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10651 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10652 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10653 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10654 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10656 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10658 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10659 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10662 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10663 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10664 length required. For example
10666 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10668 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10669 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10670 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10671 given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10673 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10674 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10675 the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10677 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10679 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10680 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10681 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10683 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10685 yields an empty string, but
10687 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10691 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10692 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10693 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10694 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10697 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10699 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10701 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10705 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10706 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10707 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10708 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10709 This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
10710 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10711 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10712 replacement list. For example
10714 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10716 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10717 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10718 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10721 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10727 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10728 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10729 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10730 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10731 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10732 following operations can be performed:
10735 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10736 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10737 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10738 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10739 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10740 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10742 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10745 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10746 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10747 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10748 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10749 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10750 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10751 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10752 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10753 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10755 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10756 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10757 character. For example:
10759 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10761 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10762 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10763 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10764 separator explicitly:
10766 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10769 Compare the &%address%& (singular)
10770 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10771 address. See the &%filter%&, &%map%&, and &%reduce%& items for ways of
10774 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10775 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10776 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10777 email address separator. For the example header line:
10779 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10781 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10782 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10783 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10784 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10785 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10786 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10787 quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
10789 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10790 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10792 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10793 Last:user@example.com
10794 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10796 # exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
10800 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10801 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10802 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10803 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10804 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10805 Only lowercase letters are used.
10807 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10808 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10809 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10810 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10811 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10813 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10814 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10815 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10816 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10817 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10818 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10819 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
10820 filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
10821 to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10823 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10824 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10825 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10826 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10827 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10828 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10831 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10832 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10833 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10834 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10835 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10836 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10838 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10839 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10842 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10843 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10844 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10845 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10846 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10849 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10850 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10851 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10852 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10853 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10856 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10857 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10858 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10859 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10860 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10861 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10862 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10864 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10865 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10866 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10867 If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10868 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10869 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10872 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10873 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10874 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10875 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10876 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10877 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10878 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10879 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10880 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10881 C programming language):
10883 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10884 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10885 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10886 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10887 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10889 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10891 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10892 space is permitted before or after operators.
10894 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10895 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10896 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10897 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10898 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10900 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10902 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10903 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10906 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10907 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10908 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10909 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10910 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
10911 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10912 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10913 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10914 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10915 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
10916 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10919 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10923 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10926 {$recipients_count} \
10927 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10930 message = Too many bad recipients
10932 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10933 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10936 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10937 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10938 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10941 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10943 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10944 and then re-expands what it has found.
10947 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10949 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10950 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10951 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10952 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10953 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10954 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10955 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10956 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10957 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10959 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10960 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10961 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10962 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10963 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10964 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10965 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10968 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10969 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10970 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10971 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10972 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10973 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10975 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10977 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10978 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10982 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10983 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10984 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10985 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10986 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10987 be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
10991 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10992 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10993 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10994 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10995 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10996 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
10997 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
11000 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11001 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
11002 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
11003 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
11004 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
11005 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
11006 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
11008 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11009 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
11010 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
11011 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
11012 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
11013 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
11014 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
11015 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
11016 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
11019 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11020 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11021 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11022 .cindex "lower casing"
11023 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11024 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
11025 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
11029 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11031 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11032 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
11033 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
11034 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
11035 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
11036 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
11038 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
11040 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
11041 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
11042 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
11043 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11046 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11047 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
11048 .cindex "list" "item count"
11049 .cindex "list" "count of items"
11050 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
11051 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
11054 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
11055 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
11056 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
11057 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
11058 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
11059 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
11060 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
11061 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
11062 matching list is returned.
11065 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11066 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
11067 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
11068 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
11069 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
11071 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
11074 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
11075 .cindex "masked IP address"
11076 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
11077 .cindex "CIDR notation"
11078 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
11079 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
11080 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
11081 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
11082 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
11083 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
11084 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
11086 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
11088 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
11089 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
11090 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
11091 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
11093 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
11097 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
11099 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
11102 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11104 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
11105 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11106 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
11107 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
11108 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
11110 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11111 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11114 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11115 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
11116 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
11117 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
11118 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
11119 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11121 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
11123 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
11126 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11127 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
11128 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
11129 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
11130 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
11131 is an empty string or
11132 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
11133 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
11134 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
11135 respectively For example,
11143 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
11144 variable or a message header.
11146 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11147 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
11148 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
11149 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
11150 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
11151 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
11152 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
11154 This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
11155 will likely use the quoting form.
11156 Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
11159 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11160 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
11161 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
11162 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
11163 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
11165 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
11171 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
11172 yields an unchanged string.
11175 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
11176 .cindex "random number"
11177 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
11178 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
11179 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
11180 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
11181 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
11182 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
11183 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
11184 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
11188 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
11189 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
11190 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
11191 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
11192 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
11193 for DNS. For example,
11195 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
11196 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
11201 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
11205 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11206 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
11207 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
11208 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
11209 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
11210 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
11211 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
11212 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
11213 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
11216 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
11218 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
11219 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
11223 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11224 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
11225 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
11226 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
11227 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
11228 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
11229 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
11230 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
11232 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
11233 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
11234 to use this operator as well.
11238 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11239 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
11240 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
11241 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
11242 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
11243 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
11244 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
11247 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11248 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11249 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
11250 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11251 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
11252 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
11253 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11255 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11256 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11259 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11260 &*${sha2:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11261 &*${sha2_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11262 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
11263 .cindex "SHA-2 hash"
11264 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11265 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
11266 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
11267 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
11268 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
11270 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11272 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11273 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11275 The operator can also be spelled &%sha2%& and does the same as &%sha256%&
11276 (except for certificates, which are not supported).
11277 Finally, if an underbar
11278 and a number is appended it specifies the output length, selecting a
11279 member of the SHA-2 family of hash functions.
11280 Values of 256, 384 and 512 are accepted, with 256 being the default.
11283 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11284 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11285 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
11286 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
11287 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
11288 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
11290 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11292 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
11293 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
11294 with 256 being the default.
11296 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
11297 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
11298 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
11299 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
11302 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11303 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
11304 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
11305 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
11306 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
11307 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
11308 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
11309 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
11310 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
11311 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
11312 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
11313 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
11314 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
11316 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
11317 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
11318 systems for files larger than 2GB.
11320 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11321 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
11322 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11326 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11327 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
11328 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11329 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11330 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11331 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11332 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11335 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11336 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11337 .cindex "substring extraction"
11338 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11339 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11340 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11341 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11343 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11345 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11346 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11347 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11349 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11350 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11351 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11352 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11355 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11356 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11357 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11358 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11359 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11360 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11363 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11364 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11365 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11366 .cindex "upper casing"
11367 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11368 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11369 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11370 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11372 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11373 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11374 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11375 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11376 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11377 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11378 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11379 In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11380 final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11381 If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11382 the complexity will depend upon the task.
11383 For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11384 extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11385 dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11387 condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11389 (which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11390 literal question mark).
11392 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11393 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11394 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11395 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11396 .cindex expansion UTF-8
11397 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
11399 .cindex internationalisation
11400 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11401 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11402 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11403 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11404 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11405 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11413 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11414 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11415 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11416 while expanding strings:
11419 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11420 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11421 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11422 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11425 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11426 .cindex "numeric comparison"
11427 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11428 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11434 &`>= `& greater or equal
11436 &`<= `& less or equal
11440 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11442 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11443 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11444 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11445 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11446 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11449 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11450 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
11451 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11454 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11455 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11456 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11457 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11458 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11459 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11460 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11461 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11462 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11463 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11464 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11465 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11466 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11467 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11469 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11470 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11471 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11472 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11473 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11474 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11476 An empty string is treated as false.
11477 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11478 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11479 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11481 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11482 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11485 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11489 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11490 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11491 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11492 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11493 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11494 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11495 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11496 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11498 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11500 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11501 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11502 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11503 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11504 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11505 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11506 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11507 included in the binary.
11509 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11510 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11511 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11512 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11513 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11514 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11515 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11516 string in LDAP form is:
11518 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11520 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11521 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11523 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11525 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11530 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11531 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11532 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11533 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11534 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11535 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11539 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11540 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11541 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11542 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11543 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11544 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11547 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11548 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11549 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11550 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11551 whatever its length.
11554 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11555 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11556 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11557 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11559 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11560 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11561 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11562 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11563 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11564 support &[crypt16()]&.
11566 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11567 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11568 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11569 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11570 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11572 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11573 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11574 Exim is seen as very low priority.
11576 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11577 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11578 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11579 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11580 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11582 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11583 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11584 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11585 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11586 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11587 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11589 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11591 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11592 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11594 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11595 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11596 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11597 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11598 exists in the message. For example,
11600 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11602 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11603 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11605 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11606 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11607 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11608 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11609 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11610 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11611 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11612 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11613 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11614 case is defined per the system C locale.
11616 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11617 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11618 .cindex "file" "existence test"
11619 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11620 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11621 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11622 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11623 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11625 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
11626 .cindex "delivery" "first"
11627 .cindex "first delivery"
11628 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11629 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11630 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11631 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11634 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11635 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11636 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11637 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11638 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11640 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11641 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11642 the normal method (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
11643 The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11644 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11645 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11647 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11648 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11649 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11651 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11652 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11653 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11655 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11656 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11657 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11658 list separator is changed to a comma:
11660 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11662 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &%forany%& or &%forall%& is
11663 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11665 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11667 .vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11668 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11669 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11670 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11671 .cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
11672 .cindex JSON expansions
11673 .cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
11674 .cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
11675 .cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
11676 .cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
11677 As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
11679 The array separator is not changeable.
11680 For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
11681 and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
11685 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11686 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11687 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11688 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11689 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11690 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11691 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11692 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11693 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11695 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11697 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11698 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11699 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11700 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11701 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11702 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11703 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11704 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11705 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11707 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11709 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11710 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11711 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11712 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11713 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11714 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11716 For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
11718 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11719 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11721 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11722 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11723 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11724 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11727 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11728 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11729 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11730 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11731 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11732 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11733 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11734 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11735 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11736 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11737 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11739 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11740 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11741 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11742 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11743 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11745 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11746 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11748 This is no longer the case.
11750 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11751 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11753 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11755 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11757 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11758 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11759 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11760 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11761 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11762 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11763 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11764 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11765 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11766 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11767 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11768 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11769 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11773 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11774 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11775 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11776 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11777 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11778 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11779 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11780 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11781 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11783 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11785 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11786 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11787 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11788 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11789 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11790 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11791 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11792 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11793 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11795 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11798 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11799 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11800 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11801 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11802 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11803 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11804 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11805 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11806 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11807 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11808 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11811 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11813 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11814 backslashes is also required.
11816 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11817 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11818 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11819 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11820 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11821 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11822 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
11823 but we might change this in a future Exim release.
11825 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11826 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11827 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11828 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11829 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11830 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11831 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11832 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11834 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11835 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11836 See &*match_local_part*&.
11838 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11839 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11840 See &*match_local_part*&.
11842 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11843 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11844 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11845 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11846 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11847 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11849 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11851 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11854 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11856 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11858 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11859 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11860 in a single test such as
11861 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11862 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11863 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11864 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11866 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11868 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11870 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11872 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11873 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11874 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11875 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11876 masks. For example:
11878 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11880 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11881 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11882 address mask, for example:
11884 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11886 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11887 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11889 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11893 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11894 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11896 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11898 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11899 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11900 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11901 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11902 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11903 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11904 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11905 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11908 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11910 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11911 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11912 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11913 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11915 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11917 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11918 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11919 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11920 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11923 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11924 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11926 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11927 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11928 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11929 matched using &%match_ip%&.
11931 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11932 .cindex "PAM authentication"
11933 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11934 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11935 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11936 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11937 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11938 (&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11939 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11940 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11941 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11945 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11946 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11948 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11949 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11950 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11951 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11952 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11953 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11954 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11956 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11957 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11959 The &%listquote%& expansion item can be used for this.
11960 For example, the configuration
11961 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11963 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${listquote{:}{$auth2}}}}
11965 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11966 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11967 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11968 . --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
11971 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11972 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11974 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11975 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11976 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11977 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11978 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11979 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11981 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11982 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11983 building Exim. For example:
11985 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11987 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11988 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11989 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11990 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11992 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11993 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11994 configuration, you might have this:
11996 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11998 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
12000 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
12002 .vitem &*queue_running*&
12003 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
12004 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
12005 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
12006 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
12007 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
12010 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
12012 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
12013 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
12014 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
12015 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
12016 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
12019 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
12020 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
12021 this library, you need to set
12023 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
12025 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
12026 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
12028 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
12030 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
12031 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
12032 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
12034 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
12035 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
12036 the authentication is successful. For example:
12038 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
12042 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
12043 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
12044 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
12046 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
12047 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
12048 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
12049 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
12050 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
12051 by a process that is not running as root.
12053 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
12054 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
12055 building Exim. For example:
12057 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
12059 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
12060 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
12061 from the Cyrus SASL library.
12063 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
12064 two are mandatory. For example:
12066 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
12068 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
12069 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
12070 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
12075 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
12076 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
12077 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
12078 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
12079 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
12080 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
12081 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
12085 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
12086 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
12087 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
12088 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
12089 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
12092 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
12094 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
12095 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
12096 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
12098 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
12099 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
12100 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
12101 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
12102 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
12103 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
12104 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
12105 parsed but not evaluated.
12107 .ecindex IIDexpcond
12112 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
12113 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
12114 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
12115 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
12116 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
12119 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
12120 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
12121 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
12122 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
12123 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
12124 In the expansion condition case
12125 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
12126 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
12127 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
12128 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
12129 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
12130 matching condition.
12132 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
12133 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
12134 any arguments are copied to these variables,
12135 any unused variables being made empty.
12137 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
12138 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
12139 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
12140 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
12141 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
12142 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
12143 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
12144 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
12145 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
12146 during subsequent delivery.
12148 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
12149 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
12150 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
12151 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
12152 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
12153 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
12154 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
12155 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
12158 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
12159 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
12160 this variable has the number of arguments.
12162 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
12163 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
12164 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
12165 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
12166 be preserved by coding like this:
12168 warn !verify = sender
12169 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
12171 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
12172 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
12175 .vitem &$address_data$&
12176 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12177 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
12178 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
12179 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
12180 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
12181 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
12184 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
12185 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
12186 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
12187 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
12188 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
12189 from the child's routing.
12191 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12192 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
12193 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
12196 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
12197 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
12198 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
12200 .vitem &$address_file$&
12201 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
12202 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
12203 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
12204 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
12205 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
12207 /home/r2d2/savemail
12209 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
12210 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
12211 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
12212 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
12213 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
12214 to the relevant file.
12216 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
12217 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
12218 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
12219 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
12221 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
12222 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
12223 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
12224 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
12226 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
12227 .cindex "authentication" "id"
12228 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
12229 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
12230 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
12231 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
12232 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
12233 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
12234 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
12236 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
12237 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
12238 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
12239 command line option.
12240 This second case also sets up information used by the
12241 &$authresults$& expansion item.
12243 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12244 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
12245 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
12246 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12247 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
12248 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
12249 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
12250 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
12251 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
12255 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
12256 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
12257 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
12258 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12259 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
12260 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
12261 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
12262 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
12263 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
12264 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
12265 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
12267 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12268 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
12269 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
12270 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
12271 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
12274 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
12275 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
12276 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
12277 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
12278 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
12279 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
12280 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
12281 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
12282 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
12283 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
12284 an undefined mechanism.
12286 .vitem &$av_failed$&
12287 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
12288 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
12289 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
12290 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
12291 the ACL malware condition.
12293 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
12294 .cindex "message body" "line count"
12295 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
12296 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
12297 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12298 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
12300 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
12301 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
12302 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
12303 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12304 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
12305 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12306 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
12308 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
12309 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
12310 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
12311 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
12312 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12314 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
12315 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
12316 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
12317 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12318 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12320 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
12321 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12322 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12323 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12324 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12325 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12326 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12328 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
12329 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12330 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12331 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12332 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12333 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12334 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12336 .vitem &$callout_address$&
12337 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12338 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12339 address that was connected to.
12341 .vitem &$compile_number$&
12342 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12343 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12344 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12345 compilations of the same version of Exim.
12347 .vitem &$config_dir$&
12348 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12349 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12350 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12351 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12352 &$config_dir$& is ".".
12354 .vitem &$config_file$&
12355 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
12356 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12358 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12359 Results of DKIM verification.
12360 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12362 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12363 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12364 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12365 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12366 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12368 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12369 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12370 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12371 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12372 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12373 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12374 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12375 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12376 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12377 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12378 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12379 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12380 &$dkim_key_length$&
12381 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12382 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12384 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12385 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12386 When a message has been received this variable contains
12387 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12388 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12390 .vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$& &&&
12391 &$dmarc_status$& &&&
12392 &$dmarc_status_text$& &&&
12393 &$dmarc_used_domains$&
12394 Results of DMARC verification.
12395 For details see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
12397 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12398 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12399 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12401 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12402 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12403 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12404 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12405 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
12406 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12407 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12408 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12409 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12412 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12413 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12414 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12415 case for &$domain$&.
12417 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12418 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12419 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12420 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12422 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12423 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12424 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12425 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12426 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12427 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12429 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12430 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12431 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12433 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12436 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12437 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12438 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12439 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12440 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12441 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12442 the &(smtp)& transport.
12445 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12446 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12447 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12448 rewrite domains by file lookup.
12451 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12452 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12453 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12454 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12455 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12456 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12459 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12460 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12461 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12462 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12466 .cindex "tainted data"
12467 If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12468 the result of expanding this variable is tainted.
12469 When un untainted version is needed, one should be obtained from
12470 looking up the value in a local (therefore trusted) database.
12471 Often &$domain_data$& is usable in this role.
12475 .vitem &$domain_data$&
12476 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12477 When the &%domains%& condition on a router
12481 against a list, the match value is copied to &$domain_data$&.
12482 This is an enhancement over previous versions of Exim, when it only
12483 applied to the data read by a lookup.
12484 For details on match values see section &<<SECTlistresults>>& et. al.
12487 If the router routes the
12488 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12489 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12492 &$domain_data$& set in an ACL is available during
12493 the rest of the ACL statement.
12495 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
12496 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12497 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12499 .vitem &$exim_path$&
12500 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12501 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12503 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
12504 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12505 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12507 .vitem &$exim_version$&
12508 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12509 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12510 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12511 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12512 There may be other characters following the minor version.
12513 This value may be overridden by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
12515 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12516 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12517 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12518 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12519 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12520 See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12522 .vitem &$headers_added$&
12523 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12524 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12525 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12526 The headers are a newline-separated list.
12530 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12531 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12532 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12533 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12534 by a setting on the transport itself.
12536 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12537 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12538 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12542 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12543 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12544 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12545 to local and remote transports.
12547 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12548 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12549 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12550 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12551 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12552 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12553 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12556 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
12557 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
12558 client is connected.
12561 .vitem &$host_address$&
12562 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
12563 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
12564 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
12565 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
12567 .vitem &$host_data$&
12568 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
12569 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
12570 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
12571 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
12573 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
12574 message = $host_data
12576 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12577 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
12578 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12579 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
12580 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
12581 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
12582 variables is set to &"1"&.
12585 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
12586 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12589 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
12590 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
12591 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
12594 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
12595 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
12596 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
12597 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
12598 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
12599 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
12600 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
12601 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
12602 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
12603 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
12605 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
12606 Performing these checks sets up information used by the
12607 &%authresults%& expansion item.
12610 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
12611 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12612 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
12614 .vitem &$host_port$&
12615 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
12616 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
12617 for an outbound connection.
12619 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
12620 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
12621 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
12622 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
12623 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
12624 to &$spool_directory$& later.
12627 .vindex "&$inode$&"
12628 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
12629 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
12630 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
12631 a unique name for the file.
12633 .vitem &$interface_address$&
12634 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12635 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
12637 .vitem &$interface_port$&
12638 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12639 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
12643 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12644 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12645 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12649 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12650 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12651 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12654 .vitem &$load_average$&
12655 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
12656 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12657 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12658 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12660 .vitem &$local_part$&
12661 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12662 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12663 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12664 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12665 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12667 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12668 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12669 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12670 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12674 .cindex "tainted data"
12675 If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12676 the result of expanding this variable is tainted.
12678 &*Warning*&: the content of this variable is usually provided by a potential
12680 Consider carefully the implications of using it unvalidated as a name
12682 This presents issues for users' &_.forward_& and filter files.
12683 For traditional full user accounts, use &%check_local_users%& and the
12684 &$local_part_data$& variable rather than this one.
12685 For virtual users, store a suitable pathname component in the database
12686 which is used for account name validation, and use that retrieved value
12687 rather than this variable.
12688 Often &$local_part_data$& is usable in this role.
12689 If needed, use a router &%address_data%& or &%set%& option for
12690 the retrieved data.
12693 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12694 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12695 the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
12698 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12699 local part of the recipient address.
12701 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12702 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12703 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12705 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12708 "abc:xyz"@test.example
12709 abc\:xyz@test.example
12711 the value of &$local_part$& is
12715 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12716 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12719 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12721 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12722 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12723 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12725 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
12726 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12727 When the &%local_parts%& condition on a router or ACL
12728 matches a local part list
12730 the match value is copied to &$local_part_data$&.
12731 This is an enhancement over previous versions of Exim, when it only
12732 applied to the data read by a lookup.
12733 For details on match values see section &<<SECTlistresults>>& et. al.
12737 The &%check_local_user%& router option also sets this variable.
12740 .vindex &$local_part_prefix$& &&&
12741 &$local_part_prefix_v$& &&&
12742 &$local_part_suffix$& &&&
12743 &$local_part_suffix_v$&
12744 .cindex affix variables
12745 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12746 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12747 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12748 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12750 .cindex "tainted data"
12751 If the specification did not include a wildcard then
12752 the affix variable value is not tainted.
12754 If the affix specification included a wildcard then the portion of
12755 the affix matched by the wildcard is in
12756 &$local_part_prefix_v$& or &$local_part_suffix_v$& as appropriate,
12757 and both the whole and varying values are tainted.
12760 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12761 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12762 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12763 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12765 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12766 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12767 See &$local_user_uid$&.
12769 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12770 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12771 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12772 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12773 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12774 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12775 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12776 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12778 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
12779 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12780 This contains the expanded value of the
12781 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12784 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
12785 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12786 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12787 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12788 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12789 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12791 .vitem &$log_space$&
12792 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12793 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12794 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12795 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12796 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12797 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12800 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12801 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12802 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12803 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12804 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12805 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12806 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12807 and &"yes"& if it was.
12808 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12809 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12810 as authenticated data.
12812 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12813 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12814 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12815 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12816 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12817 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12818 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12821 .vitem &$malware_name$&
12822 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12823 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12824 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12825 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12827 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12828 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12829 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
12830 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
12831 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12832 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12834 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12836 .vitem &$message_age$&
12837 .cindex "message" "age of"
12838 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
12839 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12840 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12843 .vitem &$message_body$&
12844 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12845 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12846 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12847 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
12848 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12849 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12850 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12851 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12852 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12854 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12855 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12856 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12857 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12858 zeros are always converted into spaces.
12860 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
12861 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12862 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12863 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12864 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12865 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12868 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
12869 .cindex "body of message" "size"
12870 .cindex "message body" "size"
12871 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12872 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12873 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12874 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12875 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12877 If the spool file is wireformat
12878 (see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12879 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12881 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12882 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12883 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12884 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12885 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12886 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12887 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12888 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12890 .vitem &$message_headers$&
12891 .vindex &$message_headers$&
12892 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12893 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12894 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12895 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12897 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12898 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12899 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12900 contents of header lines is done.
12902 .vitem &$message_id$&
12903 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12905 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
12906 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12907 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12908 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12909 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12910 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12911 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12912 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12913 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12914 from the body is not counted.
12916 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12917 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12918 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12919 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12920 header and the body).
12922 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12925 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12926 message = Too many lines in message header
12928 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12929 message has not yet been received.
12931 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12933 .vitem &$message_size$&
12934 .cindex "size" "of message"
12935 .cindex "message" "size"
12936 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
12937 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12938 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12939 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12940 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12941 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12942 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12943 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12944 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12946 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12947 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12948 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12949 value may not, of course, be truthful.
12951 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12952 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12953 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12954 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12956 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12957 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12958 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12960 .vitem &$original_domain$&
12961 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12962 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12963 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12964 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12965 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12966 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12967 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12968 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12969 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12971 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12972 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12973 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12975 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
12976 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12977 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12978 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12979 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12980 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12981 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12982 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12983 the original address.
12985 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12986 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12987 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12988 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12989 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12991 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12992 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12993 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12995 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
12996 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12997 .cindex "sender" "gid"
12998 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12999 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
13000 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
13001 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
13002 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
13003 normally the gid of the Exim user.
13005 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
13006 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
13007 .cindex "sender" "uid"
13008 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
13009 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
13010 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
13011 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
13012 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
13015 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
13016 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
13017 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
13018 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
13020 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
13021 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
13022 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
13023 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
13026 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
13028 This variable contains the current process id.
13030 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
13031 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
13032 .cindex "transport" "filter"
13033 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
13034 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
13035 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
13036 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
13037 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
13038 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
13039 variable"& error if encountered.
13041 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
13042 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
13043 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
13044 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
13045 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
13046 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
13047 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
13050 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
13051 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
13052 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
13053 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
13055 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
13057 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
13059 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
13060 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
13061 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
13062 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
13064 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
13065 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
13066 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
13067 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
13069 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
13070 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
13071 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
13072 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
13074 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
13075 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
13076 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
13077 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
13079 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
13080 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
13081 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
13083 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
13084 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
13085 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
13086 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
13088 .vitem &$queue_name$&
13089 .vindex &$queue_name$&
13090 .cindex "named queues" variable
13091 .cindex queues named
13092 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
13094 .vitem &$queue_size$&
13095 .vindex "&$queue_size$&"
13096 .cindex "queue" "size of"
13097 .cindex "spool" "number of messages"
13098 This variable contains the number of messages queued.
13099 It is evaluated on demand, but no more often than once every minute.
13103 .cindex router variables
13104 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& option of a router.
13105 They can be given any name that starts with &$r_$&.
13106 The values persist for the address being handled through subsequent routers
13107 and the eventual transport.
13109 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
13110 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
13111 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13112 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
13113 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
13115 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
13116 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
13117 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
13118 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13119 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
13120 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
13122 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
13123 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
13124 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13125 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
13126 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
13128 .vitem &$received_count$&
13129 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
13130 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
13131 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
13132 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
13135 .vitem &$received_for$&
13136 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
13137 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
13138 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
13139 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
13140 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
13142 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
13143 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
13144 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
13145 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
13146 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
13147 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
13148 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
13151 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
13152 could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
13153 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
13154 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
13155 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
13157 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
13159 .vitem &$received_port$&
13160 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
13161 See &$received_ip_address$&.
13163 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
13164 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
13165 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
13166 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
13167 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
13168 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
13169 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
13170 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
13171 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
13173 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
13174 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
13175 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
13176 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
13177 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
13178 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
13180 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
13181 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
13182 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
13184 .vitem &$received_time$&
13185 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
13186 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
13187 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13189 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
13190 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
13191 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
13192 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
13193 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
13195 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13196 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
13198 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13199 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13200 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13201 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13203 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
13204 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
13205 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
13206 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
13209 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
13210 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
13213 &"route"&: Routing failed.
13216 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
13217 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
13221 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
13224 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
13227 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
13228 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
13230 .vitem &$recipients$&
13231 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
13232 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
13233 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
13234 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
13235 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
13239 In a system filter file.
13241 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
13242 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
13243 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
13244 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
13246 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
13250 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
13251 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
13252 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
13253 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
13254 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
13255 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
13258 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
13259 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
13260 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
13261 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
13263 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
13264 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
13265 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
13266 these variables contain the
13267 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
13270 .vitem &$reply_address$&
13271 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
13272 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
13273 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
13274 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
13275 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
13276 decoding or character code translation takes place.
13278 .vitem &$return_path$&
13279 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
13280 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
13281 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
13282 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
13283 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
13284 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
13285 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
13286 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
13287 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
13288 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
13291 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
13292 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
13293 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
13295 .vitem &$router_name$&
13296 .cindex "router" "name"
13297 .cindex "name" "of router"
13298 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
13299 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
13302 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
13303 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
13304 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
13305 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
13306 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
13307 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
13308 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
13311 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
13312 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
13313 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
13314 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
13315 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
13316 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
13317 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
13318 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
13320 .vitem &$sender_address$&
13321 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
13322 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
13323 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
13324 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
13325 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
13327 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
13328 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
13329 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
13330 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
13331 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
13332 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
13333 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
13334 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
13336 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
13337 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
13338 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
13340 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
13341 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
13342 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
13344 .vitem &$sender_data$&
13345 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
13346 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
13347 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
13348 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
13351 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13352 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
13354 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13355 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13356 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13357 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13359 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
13360 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
13361 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
13362 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
13363 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
13364 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
13365 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
13366 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
13367 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
13368 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
13369 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
13370 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
13371 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
13373 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
13374 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
13375 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
13376 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13377 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13379 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
13380 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
13381 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13382 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13383 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13384 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13386 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13387 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13388 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13389 this variable contains that
13390 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13392 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13393 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13394 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13395 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13396 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13397 &$authenticated_id$&.
13399 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13400 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13401 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13402 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13403 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13404 resolver library states that both
13405 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13406 other times, this variable is false.
13408 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13409 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13410 library, by setting:
13416 In addition, on Linux with glibc 2.31 or newer the resolver library will
13417 default to stripping out a successful validation status.
13418 This will break a previously working Exim installation.
13419 Provided that you do trust the resolver (ie, is on localhost) you can tell
13420 glibc to pass through any successful validation with a new option in
13421 &_/etc/resolv.conf_&:
13427 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13428 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13430 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13431 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13433 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13434 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13435 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13436 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13439 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
13440 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13441 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13442 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13443 other means, this variable is empty.
13445 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13446 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13447 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13448 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13449 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13450 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13451 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13453 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13454 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13455 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13456 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13458 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13459 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13460 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13463 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13464 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13465 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13466 following are true:
13469 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13471 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13472 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13473 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13475 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13476 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13477 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13479 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13480 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13481 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13483 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13484 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13485 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13486 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13488 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13490 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13491 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13495 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13496 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13497 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13498 number that was used on the remote host.
13500 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
13501 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13502 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13503 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13504 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13507 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13508 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13509 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13510 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13512 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13513 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13514 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13515 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13516 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13517 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13518 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13519 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13520 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13521 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13522 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13525 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13526 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13527 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13528 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13529 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13531 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13532 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13533 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13534 about the failure. The details are the same as for
13535 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13537 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13538 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13539 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13540 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13541 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13542 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13543 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13545 .vitem &$sending_port$&
13546 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13547 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13548 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13549 connections, see &$received_port$&.
13551 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13552 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13553 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13554 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13555 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13556 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13558 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
13559 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
13560 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
13561 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
13562 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
13567 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
13568 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
13569 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
13570 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
13572 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
13573 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
13574 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
13575 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
13576 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
13577 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
13578 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
13580 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
13581 .cindex SMTP "command history"
13582 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
13583 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
13584 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
13587 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
13588 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
13589 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
13590 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
13591 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
13592 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
13593 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
13594 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
13595 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
13596 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
13597 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
13599 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
13600 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
13601 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
13602 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
13603 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
13604 message is junk mail.
13606 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
13607 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
13608 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
13609 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
13611 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
13612 &$spf_received$& &&&
13614 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
13615 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
13616 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
13617 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
13619 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
13620 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
13621 The name of Exim's spool directory.
13623 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
13624 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13625 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
13626 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
13627 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
13628 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
13630 .vitem &$spool_space$&
13631 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13632 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
13633 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
13634 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
13635 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
13636 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
13637 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
13639 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
13641 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
13644 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
13645 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
13646 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
13647 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
13648 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
13649 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
13651 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
13652 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
13653 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13654 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
13655 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13656 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13657 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
13658 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
13660 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
13661 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13664 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
13665 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
13666 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13667 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
13668 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13669 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13671 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
13672 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
13673 .cindex certificate variables
13674 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13675 inbound connection when the message was received.
13676 It is only useful as the argument of a
13677 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13678 or a &%def%& condition.
13680 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
13681 when a list of more than one
13682 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
13683 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
13685 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
13686 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
13687 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13688 inbound connection when the message was received.
13689 It is only useful as the argument of a
13690 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13691 or a &%def%& condition.
13692 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13693 which is not the leaf.
13695 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
13696 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13697 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13698 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13699 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13700 or a &%def%& condition.
13702 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13703 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13704 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13705 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13706 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13707 or a &%def%& condition.
13708 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13709 which is not the leaf.
13711 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13712 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13713 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13714 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13716 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13717 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13720 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13721 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13722 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13723 outbound SMTP connection was made,
13724 and &"0"& otherwise.
13726 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13727 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13728 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13729 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13730 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13731 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13732 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13733 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13734 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13736 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13737 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13738 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13740 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
13741 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
13742 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13744 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13745 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13747 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13748 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13749 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13750 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13752 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
13753 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
13754 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13756 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13757 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13758 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13760 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13761 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13762 When a message is received from a remote client connection
13763 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13765 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
13766 1 No response to request
13767 2 Response not verified
13768 3 Verification failed
13769 4 Verification succeeded
13772 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13773 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13774 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13775 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13776 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13778 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13779 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13780 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13781 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13782 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13783 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13784 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13785 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13786 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13787 which is not the leaf.
13789 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13790 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13793 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13794 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13795 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13796 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13797 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13798 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13799 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13800 which is not the leaf.
13802 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13803 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13804 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13805 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13806 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13807 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13808 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13809 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13810 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13811 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13812 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13814 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13815 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13818 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13819 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13820 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13822 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13825 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13826 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13827 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13829 .vitem &$tls_in_ver$&
13830 .vindex "&$tls_in_ver$&"
13831 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
13832 this variable is set to the protocol version, eg &'TLS1.2'&.
13834 .vitem &$tls_out_ver$&
13835 .vindex "&$tls_out_ver$&"
13836 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
13837 this variable is set to the protocol version.
13840 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13841 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13842 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13843 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13845 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13846 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13847 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13849 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13850 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13851 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13853 .vitem &$tod_full$&
13854 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13855 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13856 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13857 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13858 values for those that are behind (west).
13861 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13862 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
13863 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13865 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13866 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13867 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13868 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13871 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
13872 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13873 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13876 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13877 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13878 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13879 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13881 .vitem &$transport_name$&
13882 .cindex "transport" "name"
13883 .cindex "name" "of transport"
13884 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13885 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13888 .vindex "&$value$&"
13889 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13890 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13891 &*reduce*& expansion.
13893 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
13894 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13895 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13896 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13899 .vitem &$version_number$&
13900 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
13901 The version number of Exim. Same as &$exim_version$&, may be overridden
13902 by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
13904 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13905 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13906 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13907 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13909 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13910 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13911 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13912 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13918 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13919 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13921 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13922 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13923 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13924 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13925 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13926 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13931 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13934 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13935 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13936 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13937 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13938 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13939 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13940 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13941 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13942 a newly created Perl interpreter.
13944 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13945 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13946 should usually be something like
13948 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13950 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13951 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13952 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13953 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13954 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13955 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13956 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13957 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13961 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13962 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13963 a startup when Exim is entered.
13965 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13966 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13969 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13970 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13973 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13974 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13975 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13976 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13977 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13978 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13982 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13983 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13984 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13985 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13989 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
13990 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13992 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13993 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13994 with an error message of the form
13996 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13998 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13999 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
14000 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
14001 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
14002 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
14003 that was passed to &%die%&.
14006 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
14007 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
14008 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
14011 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
14013 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
14014 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
14015 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
14017 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
14018 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
14019 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
14020 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
14022 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
14023 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
14024 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
14025 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
14026 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
14027 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
14028 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
14031 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
14032 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
14033 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
14034 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
14035 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
14036 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
14037 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
14038 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
14039 avoided, but the output is lost.
14041 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
14042 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
14043 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
14044 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
14045 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
14046 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
14047 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
14049 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
14051 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
14052 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
14053 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
14054 as the first subroutine argument.
14058 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14059 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14061 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
14062 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
14063 "Starting the daemon"
14064 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
14065 .cindex "interface" "listening"
14066 .cindex "network interface"
14067 .cindex "interface" "network"
14068 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
14069 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
14070 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
14071 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14072 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
14073 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
14074 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
14075 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
14076 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
14077 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
14078 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
14081 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
14082 and ports to listen on.
14084 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
14085 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
14086 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
14087 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
14088 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
14089 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
14090 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
14091 as an error situation.
14093 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
14094 for the outgoing connection.
14098 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
14099 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
14100 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
14101 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
14102 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
14104 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
14105 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
14106 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
14107 chapter describes how they operate.
14109 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
14110 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
14114 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
14115 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
14116 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
14120 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
14122 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
14124 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
14125 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
14128 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
14129 described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
14130 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
14131 colons. For example:
14133 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
14136 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
14138 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
14139 in &%local_interfaces%&:
14142 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
14143 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
14145 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
14146 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
14149 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
14150 with a colon separator, for example:
14152 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
14153 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
14157 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
14158 default setting contains just one port:
14160 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14162 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
14163 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
14164 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
14165 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
14166 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
14170 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
14171 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
14172 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
14173 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
14174 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
14175 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
14177 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14179 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
14181 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14183 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
14187 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
14188 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
14189 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
14190 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
14191 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
14192 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
14195 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
14196 changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
14197 If there are any items that do not
14198 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
14199 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
14200 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
14201 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
14205 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
14208 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
14210 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
14211 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
14212 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
14216 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
14217 .cindex "submissions protocol"
14218 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
14219 .cindex "smtps protocol"
14220 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
14221 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
14222 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
14223 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
14224 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
14225 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
14226 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
14227 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
14228 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
14231 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
14232 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
14233 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
14235 The common use of this option is expected to be
14237 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
14240 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
14241 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
14243 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
14244 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
14245 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
14246 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
14247 connections via the daemon.)
14252 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
14253 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
14254 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
14255 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
14256 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
14257 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
14258 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
14259 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
14261 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
14263 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
14264 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
14265 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
14266 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
14267 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
14268 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
14270 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
14272 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
14273 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
14274 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
14275 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
14276 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
14278 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
14279 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14280 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
14281 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
14282 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
14283 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
14284 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
14285 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14286 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14287 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
14288 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14289 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14291 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
14292 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
14293 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
14294 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
14295 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
14299 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
14300 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
14302 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14303 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14305 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
14306 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
14307 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
14308 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
14310 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
14312 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
14314 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
14316 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
14317 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
14319 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
14320 IPv4 loopback address only:
14322 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
14324 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
14326 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
14328 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
14332 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
14333 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
14334 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
14335 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
14338 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
14339 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
14340 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
14341 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
14343 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
14344 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
14345 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
14346 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
14347 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
14348 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
14349 used for listening. Consider this example:
14351 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
14353 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
14355 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14357 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
14358 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
14361 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
14362 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
14363 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
14364 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
14365 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
14366 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
14367 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
14368 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
14372 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
14373 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
14374 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
14375 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
14376 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
14377 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
14383 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14384 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14386 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
14387 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
14388 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
14389 The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
14392 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
14393 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
14395 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
14396 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
14397 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14399 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14400 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14401 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14402 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14406 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14407 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14408 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14409 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14410 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14411 listed in more than one group.
14413 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14415 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14416 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14417 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14418 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14419 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14420 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14421 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14422 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14423 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14424 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14425 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14429 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14431 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14432 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14433 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14434 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14435 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14436 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14441 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14443 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14444 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14445 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14446 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14447 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14448 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14449 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14450 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14451 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14452 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14453 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14454 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14459 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
14461 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14462 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14463 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14464 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14465 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14466 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14467 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14468 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14469 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14470 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14471 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14472 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14473 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14474 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14475 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14480 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14482 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14483 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14484 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14485 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14490 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14492 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14493 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14494 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14495 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14496 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14497 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14498 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14499 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14500 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14501 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14502 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14503 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14504 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14505 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14506 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14511 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14513 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14514 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14519 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14521 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14522 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14523 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14528 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14530 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14531 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14532 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14533 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14534 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14535 .row &%notifier_socket%& "override compiled-in value"
14536 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14537 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14542 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
14544 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14545 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
14546 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14547 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
14548 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
14549 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
14550 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14551 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14552 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14553 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14554 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14555 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14556 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14557 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14558 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14559 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14561 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14562 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14563 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14564 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
14565 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14570 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
14572 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
14573 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
14574 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
14575 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
14576 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
14577 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
14578 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
14579 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
14580 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
14581 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
14582 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
14583 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
14584 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
14585 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
14586 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
14587 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
14588 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
14589 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
14590 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
14591 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
14592 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
14593 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14595 .row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
14596 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
14597 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
14598 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14599 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14600 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
14601 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
14602 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
14603 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
14604 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
14605 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14606 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14607 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
14608 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
14609 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
14610 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
14611 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
14612 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14613 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
14614 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
14615 .row &%spf_smtp_comment_template%& "template for &$spf_smtp_comment$&"
14620 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
14622 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
14624 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
14626 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
14627 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
14628 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
14633 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
14635 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
14636 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
14637 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
14638 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14639 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
14640 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
14641 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
14642 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
14643 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
14644 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
14645 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
14646 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
14647 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
14648 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
14649 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
14650 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
14651 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
14656 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
14658 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
14659 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
14660 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
14661 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
14662 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
14663 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
14664 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
14665 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
14670 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
14672 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14673 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14674 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
14675 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14676 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
14677 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
14678 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
14679 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
14685 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
14687 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
14694 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
14695 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
14698 .row &%dkim_verify_hashes%& "DKIM hash methods accepted for signatures"
14699 .row &%dkim_verify_keytypes%& "DKIM key types accepted for signatures"
14700 .row &%dkim_verify_min_keysizes%& "DKIM key sizes accepted for signatures"
14701 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domains for which DKIM ACL is run"
14702 .row &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& "DMARC sender for report messages"
14703 .row &%dmarc_history_file%& "DMARC results log"
14704 .row &%dmarc_tld_file%& "DMARC toplevel domains file"
14705 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14706 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14707 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
14708 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
14709 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
14710 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
14711 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
14712 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14713 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14714 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14715 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14716 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14717 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14718 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14720 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14721 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
14722 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
14723 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14724 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14725 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
14726 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
14727 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
14728 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
14729 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
14730 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
14731 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
14732 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
14733 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
14734 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14735 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14740 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14742 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14743 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14744 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14745 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14746 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14747 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14748 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14749 .row &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14750 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14751 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14752 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14757 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14759 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14760 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14761 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14762 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14764 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14765 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14766 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14767 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14768 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14769 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14770 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14771 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14772 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14773 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14778 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
14780 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14781 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14783 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14784 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14785 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14786 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14787 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14792 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14794 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14795 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14796 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14797 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14798 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14799 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14800 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14801 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14802 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14803 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14804 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14805 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14806 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14807 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14808 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14809 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14810 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14811 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14812 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14813 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14814 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14815 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14816 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14817 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14822 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14824 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14825 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14826 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14827 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14828 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14829 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14830 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14831 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14832 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14833 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14834 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14835 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14836 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14837 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14838 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14843 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14844 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14847 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14849 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14850 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14851 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14852 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" 8BITMIME
14853 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14854 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14855 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14856 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14858 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14859 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14860 It now defaults to true.
14861 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14863 &url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14866 To log received 8BITMIME status use
14868 log_selector = +8bitmime
14871 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14872 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14873 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14874 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14875 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14878 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14879 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14880 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14883 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14884 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14885 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14886 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14887 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14889 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14890 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14891 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14892 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14893 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14895 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14896 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14897 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14898 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14900 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14901 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14902 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14903 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14904 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14906 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14907 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14908 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14909 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14910 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14911 This option defines the ACL that,
14912 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14913 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14914 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14915 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14917 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14918 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14919 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14920 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14921 of a received message.
14922 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14924 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14925 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14926 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14927 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14929 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14930 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14931 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14932 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14934 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14935 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14936 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14937 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14938 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14941 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14942 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14943 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14944 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14946 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14947 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14948 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14949 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14950 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14952 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14953 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14954 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14955 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14956 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14958 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14959 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14960 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14961 ends without a QUIT command being received.
14962 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14964 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14965 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14966 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14969 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14970 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14971 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14972 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14974 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14975 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14976 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14977 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14979 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14980 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14981 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14982 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14984 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14985 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14986 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14987 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14989 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
14990 .cindex "environment" "set values"
14991 This option adds individual environment variables that the
14992 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes may use.
14993 Each list element should be of the form &"name=value"&.
14995 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14997 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14998 .cindex "admin user"
14999 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
15000 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
15001 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
15002 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
15003 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
15004 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
15005 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
15007 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
15008 .cindex "domain literal"
15009 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
15010 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
15011 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
15012 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
15014 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
15015 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
15016 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
15017 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
15018 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
15019 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
15020 the local host's IP addresses.
15023 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
15024 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
15025 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
15026 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
15027 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
15028 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
15029 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
15030 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
15031 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
15033 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
15034 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
15035 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
15036 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
15037 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
15038 that at least two other MTAs permit this.
15039 This option allows Exim users to experiment if they wish.
15041 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
15042 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
15043 letters, digits, and hyphens.
15045 If Exim is built with internationalization support
15046 and the SMTPUTF8 ESMTP option is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>&)
15047 this option can be left as default.
15049 if you want to look up such domain names in the DNS, you must also
15050 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
15051 suitable setting is:
15053 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
15054 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
15056 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
15058 dns_check_names_pattern =
15060 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
15063 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15064 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
15065 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
15066 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" AUTH
15067 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
15068 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
15069 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
15070 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
15071 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
15072 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
15073 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
15074 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
15076 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
15077 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
15078 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
15079 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
15080 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
15081 which Exim advertises AUTH.
15083 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
15084 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
15085 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
15086 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
15088 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
15090 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
15091 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
15092 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
15093 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
15096 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
15097 .cindex "thawing messages"
15098 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
15099 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
15100 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
15101 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
15102 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
15103 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
15105 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
15106 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
15107 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
15110 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
15111 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
15112 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
15114 sophie:/var/run/sophie
15116 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
15117 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
15120 .option bi_command main string unset
15122 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
15123 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
15124 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
15125 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
15128 .option bounce_message_file main string&!! unset
15129 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
15130 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
15131 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
15132 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
15133 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&.
15135 .cindex bounce_message_file "tainted data"
15136 The option is expanded to give the file path, which must be
15137 absolute and untainted.
15139 See also &%warn_message_file%&.
15142 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
15143 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
15144 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
15145 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
15147 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
15148 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
15149 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
15150 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
15151 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
15152 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
15153 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
15154 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
15155 point at which the error was detected are returned.
15156 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
15158 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
15159 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
15160 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
15161 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
15162 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
15163 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
15164 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
15165 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
15166 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
15167 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
15169 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
15170 during reception of a message.
15171 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
15173 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
15176 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
15177 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
15178 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
15179 &%bounce_return_body%&.
15182 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
15183 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
15184 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
15185 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
15186 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
15187 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
15188 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
15189 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
15190 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
15192 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
15193 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
15194 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
15195 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
15196 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
15199 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
15200 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
15201 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
15202 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
15203 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
15204 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
15205 connection. A typical setting might be:
15207 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
15209 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
15211 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
15213 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
15216 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
15217 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
15218 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
15219 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
15220 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15221 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15224 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
15225 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
15226 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15227 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15230 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
15231 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
15232 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15233 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15236 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
15237 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
15238 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15239 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15242 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
15243 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
15244 callout verification. The default value is
15246 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
15248 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
15251 .option check_log_inodes main integer 100
15252 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15255 .option check_log_space main integer 10M
15256 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15258 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
15259 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
15260 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
15261 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
15262 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
15263 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
15264 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
15265 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
15266 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
15267 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
15270 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
15271 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15274 .option check_spool_space main integer 10M
15275 .cindex "checking disk space"
15276 .cindex "disk space, checking"
15277 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15278 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
15279 message is accepted.
15281 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
15282 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
15283 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
15284 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
15285 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
15286 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
15287 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
15288 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
15291 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
15292 either value is greater than zero, for example:
15294 check_spool_space = 100M
15295 check_spool_inodes = 100
15297 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
15298 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
15301 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
15302 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
15303 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
15305 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
15306 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
15307 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
15308 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
15309 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
15310 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
15312 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
15313 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
15314 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
15316 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
15317 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
15318 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
15320 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
15321 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
15322 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
15323 may wish to deliberately disable them.
15325 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15326 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
15327 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
15328 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" CHUNKING
15329 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
15331 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
15333 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
15334 .cindex "restricting access to features"
15335 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
15336 administrative user.
15337 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
15339 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
15340 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
15341 .cindex memory debugging
15342 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
15343 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
15344 it should normally be left as default.
15346 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
15347 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
15348 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
15349 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
15350 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
15351 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
15353 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
15354 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
15355 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
15356 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
15357 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
15358 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
15359 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
15361 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
15362 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
15364 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
15365 .cindex "warning of delay"
15366 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
15367 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
15368 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
15369 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
15370 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
15371 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
15372 message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
15373 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
15376 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
15378 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
15379 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
15380 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
15381 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
15385 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
15386 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
15388 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
15390 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
15391 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
15392 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
15394 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
15395 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15396 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
15397 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
15398 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
15399 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
15400 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
15401 not sent. The default is:
15403 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
15404 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
15405 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
15406 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
15409 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
15410 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
15411 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
15412 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
15414 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
15415 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
15416 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
15417 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
15418 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
15419 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
15420 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
15421 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
15423 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15424 .cindex "load average"
15425 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15426 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15427 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15428 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15429 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15432 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15433 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15434 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15435 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15436 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15437 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15438 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15439 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15441 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
15442 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15443 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15444 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15445 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15446 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15447 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15448 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15450 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15451 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15452 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15453 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15456 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15457 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15458 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15459 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15460 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15461 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15462 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15466 .option dkim_verify_hashes main "string list" "sha256 : sha512"
15467 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
15468 This option gives a list of hash types which are acceptable in signatures,
15470 and an order of processing.
15471 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15473 Acceptable values include:
15480 Note that the acceptance of sha1 violates RFC 8301.
15482 .option dkim_verify_keytypes main "string list" "ed25519 : rsa"
15483 This option gives a list of key types which are acceptable in signatures,
15484 and an order of processing.
15485 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15489 .option dkim_verify_min_keysizes main "string list" "rsa=1024 ed25519=250"
15490 This option gives a list of key sizes which are acceptable in signatures.
15491 The list is keyed by the algorithm type for the key; the values are in bits.
15492 Signatures with keys smaller than given by this option will fail verification.
15494 The default enforces the RFC 8301 minimum key size for RSA signatures.
15497 .option dkim_verify_minimal main boolean false
15498 If set to true, verification of signatures will terminate after the
15501 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15502 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15503 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15504 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15505 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15506 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
15509 .option dmarc_forensic_sender main string&!! unset
15510 .option dmarc_history_file main string unset
15511 .option dmarc_tld_file main string unset
15512 .cindex DMARC "main section options"
15513 These options control DMARC processing.
15514 See section &<<SECDMARC>>& for details.
15517 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
15518 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
15519 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
15520 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
15521 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
15522 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
15523 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
15524 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
15525 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
15526 by a setting such as this:
15528 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
15530 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
15531 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
15532 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
15533 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
15534 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
15535 options are applied after this global option.
15537 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
15538 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
15539 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
15540 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
15541 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
15542 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
15543 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
15544 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
15545 value of this option. The default pattern is
15547 dns_check_names_pattern = \
15548 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
15550 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
15551 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
15552 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
15553 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
15554 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
15557 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
15558 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
15559 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15561 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
15562 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
15563 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
15564 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15566 .option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
15567 .cindex DNS "CNAME following"
15568 This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
15569 not do it internally.
15570 As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
15571 If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
15573 The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
15574 thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
15575 given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
15578 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
15579 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15580 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15581 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15582 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
15583 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
15585 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
15588 On Linux with glibc 2.31 or newer this is insufficient, the resolver library
15589 will default to stripping out a successful validation status.
15590 This will break a previously working Exim installation.
15591 Provided that you do trust the resolver (ie, is on localhost) you can tell
15592 glibc to pass through any successful validation with a new option in
15593 &_/etc/resolv.conf_&:
15600 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
15601 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
15602 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
15603 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
15604 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
15605 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
15606 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
15607 domain matches this list.
15609 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
15610 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
15611 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
15612 Note that all lookups, including those done for verification, are affected;
15613 this will result in verify failure for IPv6 connections or ones using names
15614 only valid for IPv6 addresses.
15617 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
15618 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15619 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
15620 .cindex "DNS" timeout
15621 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
15622 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
15623 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
15624 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
15625 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
15626 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
15627 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
15628 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
15630 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
15633 .option dns_retry main integer 0
15634 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
15637 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
15638 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15639 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15640 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
15641 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
15642 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
15643 match with this expanded domain list.
15645 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
15646 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
15647 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
15648 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
15649 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
15650 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
15652 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
15653 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
15654 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
15656 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
15657 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
15658 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
15659 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
15660 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
15662 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15663 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
15664 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15665 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
15666 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
15667 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15668 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
15669 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
15672 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
15674 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
15675 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
15676 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
15679 .option drop_cr main boolean false
15680 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
15681 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
15682 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
15684 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15685 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
15686 .cindex "DSN" "success"
15687 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
15688 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" DSN
15689 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
15690 and accepted from, these hosts.
15691 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
15692 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
15693 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
15694 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
15697 &*Note*&: Supplying success-DSN messages has been criticised
15698 on privacy grounds; it can leak details of internal forwarding.
15701 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
15702 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
15703 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
15704 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
15705 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
15706 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
15708 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
15710 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
15711 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
15713 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
15714 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
15715 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
15716 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15717 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
15718 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
15719 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
15720 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
15721 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15724 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
15725 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
15726 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
15727 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
15728 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
15729 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
15730 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
15731 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
15732 must be enclosed in double quotes.
15734 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
15735 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
15736 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
15737 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
15738 are examined. For example:
15740 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
15741 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
15742 postmaster@mydomain.example
15744 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15745 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15746 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
15747 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
15748 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
15749 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
15750 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
15753 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
15754 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
15755 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
15757 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
15759 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
15760 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
15761 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
15762 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
15763 overrides the default.
15765 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
15766 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
15767 and warning messages. For example:
15769 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
15771 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
15772 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
15773 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
15774 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
15778 .option event_action main string&!! unset
15780 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
15781 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
15784 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
15785 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
15786 .cindex "Exim group"
15787 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15788 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
15789 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
15790 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
15791 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
15795 .option exim_path main string "see below"
15796 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
15797 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
15798 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
15799 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
15800 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
15802 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
15803 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
15804 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
15805 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
15808 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
15809 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
15810 .cindex "Exim user"
15811 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15812 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
15813 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
15814 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
15816 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
15817 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
15818 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
15819 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
15822 .option exim_version main string "current version"
15823 .cindex "Exim version"
15824 .cindex customizing "version number"
15825 .cindex "version number of Exim" override
15826 This option overrides the &$version_number$&/&$exim_version$& that Exim reports in
15827 various places. Use with care; this may fool stupid security scanners.
15830 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
15831 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
15832 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
15833 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
15836 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15837 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15839 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
15840 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
15842 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15843 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15844 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15845 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15846 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15847 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15848 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15849 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15850 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15851 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15855 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
15856 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15857 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15858 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15859 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15860 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15861 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15862 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15865 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15866 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15867 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15868 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15872 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15873 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15874 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15875 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15876 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15877 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15878 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15879 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15880 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15881 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15882 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15883 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15884 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15885 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15886 logging that you require.
15889 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15891 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15892 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15893 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15894 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15895 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15896 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15897 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15898 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15900 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15901 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15902 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15905 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15906 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15907 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15908 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15910 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15914 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
15915 See &%gecos_name%& above.
15918 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15919 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15920 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15921 implementations of TLS.
15924 .option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15925 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15926 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15929 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15934 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
15935 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15936 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15937 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15938 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15939 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15943 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15944 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15945 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15946 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15947 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15948 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15949 sections are rejected.
15952 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15953 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15954 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15955 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15956 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15957 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15958 zero means &"no limit"&.
15963 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15964 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15965 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15966 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15967 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15968 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15969 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15970 if you want to do semantic checking.
15971 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15975 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15976 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15977 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15978 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15979 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15980 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15981 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15983 helo_allow_chars = _
15985 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15988 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15989 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15990 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15991 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15992 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15993 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15994 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15998 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15999 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
16000 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
16001 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
16002 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
16003 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
16004 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
16005 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
16006 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
16007 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
16008 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
16009 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
16011 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
16012 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
16013 EHLO command either:
16016 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
16018 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
16019 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
16020 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
16021 calling host address, or
16023 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
16026 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
16027 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
16028 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
16030 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
16031 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
16032 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
16034 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16035 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
16036 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
16037 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
16038 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
16039 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
16040 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
16041 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
16042 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
16045 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16046 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
16047 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
16048 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
16049 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
16050 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
16051 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
16052 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
16053 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
16055 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
16056 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
16057 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
16058 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
16059 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
16061 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
16062 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
16063 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
16064 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
16067 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
16068 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
16069 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
16070 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
16071 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
16072 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
16073 default configuration file contains
16077 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
16078 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
16080 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
16081 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
16082 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
16084 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
16085 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
16086 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
16087 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
16088 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
16089 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
16092 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
16093 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
16094 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
16095 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
16096 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
16099 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
16100 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
16101 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
16102 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
16106 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
16107 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
16108 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
16109 as soon as the connection is made.
16110 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
16111 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
16112 connections immediately.
16114 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
16115 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
16116 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
16117 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
16118 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
16121 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
16122 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
16123 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
16124 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
16125 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
16126 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
16127 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
16128 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
16129 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
16131 hosts_connection_nolog = :
16133 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
16137 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
16138 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
16139 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
16140 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
16143 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
16144 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
16145 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
16146 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
16147 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
16149 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
16150 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
16152 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
16153 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
16154 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
16155 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
16156 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
16157 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
16158 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
16161 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
16162 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
16163 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
16164 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16165 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
16169 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
16170 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
16171 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
16172 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
16173 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
16174 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
16176 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
16177 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
16178 message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
16179 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
16180 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
16181 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
16182 for frozen messages. For example,
16184 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
16186 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
16187 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
16188 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
16189 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
16190 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
16191 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
16194 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16195 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16196 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16197 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
16198 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
16199 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
16200 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
16201 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
16202 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
16203 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
16206 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
16207 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
16209 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
16210 .cindex "environment" "values from"
16211 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
16212 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
16213 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
16214 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
16215 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
16216 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
16217 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
16219 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
16220 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
16222 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
16223 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
16224 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
16225 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
16227 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
16228 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
16229 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
16232 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
16233 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
16234 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
16238 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
16239 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
16240 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
16241 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
16245 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
16246 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
16247 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
16248 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
16249 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
16250 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
16251 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
16252 and constrained to be a directory.
16255 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
16256 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
16257 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
16258 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
16259 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
16260 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
16261 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
16262 and constrained to be a file.
16265 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
16266 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
16267 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
16268 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
16269 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16270 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
16273 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
16274 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
16275 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
16276 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
16277 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16278 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
16279 identity to be proven.
16282 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
16283 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
16284 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
16285 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
16286 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
16289 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
16290 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
16291 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
16292 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
16293 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
16297 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
16298 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
16299 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
16300 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
16301 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
16302 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
16306 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
16307 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
16308 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
16309 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
16310 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
16312 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
16313 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
16314 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
16317 .option ldap_version main integer unset
16318 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
16319 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
16320 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
16321 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
16322 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
16323 has been built with LDAP support.
16327 .option local_from_check main boolean true
16328 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
16329 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
16330 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16331 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
16332 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
16333 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
16335 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
16336 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
16337 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16339 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
16340 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
16341 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
16342 and the default qualify domain.
16344 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
16345 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
16346 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
16347 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
16349 .cindex "envelope from"
16350 .cindex "envelope sender"
16351 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
16352 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
16353 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
16355 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
16356 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
16357 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16362 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
16363 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
16364 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
16365 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
16366 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
16367 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
16368 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
16371 local_from_prefix = *-
16373 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
16375 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
16377 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
16378 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
16382 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
16383 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
16386 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
16387 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
16388 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
16389 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
16390 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
16391 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
16392 &%local_interfaces%& is
16394 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
16396 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
16398 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
16401 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
16402 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
16403 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
16404 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
16405 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
16406 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
16407 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
16408 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
16412 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
16413 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
16414 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16415 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
16416 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
16417 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
16418 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
16419 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16424 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
16425 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
16426 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
16427 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
16428 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
16429 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
16430 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
16431 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
16432 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
16433 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
16434 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
16435 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
16436 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
16437 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
16438 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
16442 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
16443 .cindex "log" "file path for"
16444 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
16445 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
16446 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
16447 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
16448 or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
16449 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
16450 A path must start with a slash.
16451 To send to syslog, use the word &"syslog"&.
16452 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
16453 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
16454 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
16455 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
16456 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
16457 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
16458 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
16461 .option log_selector main string unset
16462 .cindex "log" "selectors"
16463 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
16464 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
16465 minus characters. For example:
16467 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
16469 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
16470 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
16473 .option log_timezone main boolean false
16474 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
16475 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
16476 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
16477 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
16478 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
16479 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
16480 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
16481 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
16482 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
16483 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
16484 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
16485 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
16488 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
16489 .cindex "too many open files"
16490 .cindex "open files, too many"
16491 .cindex "file" "too many open"
16492 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
16493 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
16494 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
16495 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
16496 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
16497 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
16498 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
16499 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
16500 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
16501 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
16502 &%lookup_open_max%&.
16505 .option max_username_length main integer 0
16506 .cindex "length of login name"
16507 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
16508 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
16509 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
16510 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
16511 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
16512 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
16515 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
16516 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
16517 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
16518 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16519 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16520 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
16521 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
16522 option is set true, this no longer happens.
16525 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
16526 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
16527 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
16528 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16529 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16530 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
16531 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
16534 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
16535 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
16536 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
16537 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
16538 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
16539 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
16540 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
16541 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
16542 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
16543 empty string, the option is ignored.
16546 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
16547 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
16548 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
16549 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
16550 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
16551 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
16552 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
16553 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
16554 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
16555 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
16556 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
16557 colons will become hyphens.
16560 .option message_logs main boolean true
16561 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
16562 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
16563 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
16564 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
16565 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
16566 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
16567 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
16568 which is not affected by this option.
16571 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
16572 .cindex "message" "size limit"
16573 .cindex "limit" "message size"
16574 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
16575 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
16576 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
16577 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
16578 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
16579 optionally followed by K or M.
16581 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension, advertising"
16582 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SIZE
16583 If nonzero the value will be advertised as a parameter to the ESMTP SIZE
16584 service extension keyword.
16586 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
16587 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
16588 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
16589 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
16590 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16592 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
16593 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
16594 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
16595 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
16596 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
16597 message that an individual transport can process.
16599 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
16600 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
16601 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
16602 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
16603 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
16604 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
16605 some problems may result.
16607 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
16608 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
16609 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
16612 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
16613 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
16614 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
16616 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
16618 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
16619 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
16620 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
16621 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
16622 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
16625 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
16626 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
16627 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
16628 contains a full description of this facility.
16632 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
16633 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
16634 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
16635 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
16636 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
16639 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
16640 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
16641 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
16642 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
16643 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
16646 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
16647 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
16648 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
16649 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
16650 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
16652 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
16653 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
16656 never_users = root:daemon:bin
16658 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
16659 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
16664 .option notifier_socket main string "$spool_directory/exim_daemon_notify"
16665 This option gives the name for a unix-domain socket on which the daemon
16666 listens for work and information-requests.
16667 Only installations running multiple daemons sharing a spool directory
16668 should need to modify the default.
16670 The option is expanded before use.
16671 If the platform supports Linux-style abstract socket names, the result
16672 is used with a nul byte prefixed.
16673 Otherwise, it should be a full path name and use a directory accessible
16676 If the Exim command line uses a &%-oX%& option and does not use &%-oP%&
16677 then a notifier socket is not created.
16681 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +no_sslv3 +single_dh_use +no_ticket +no_renegotiation"
16682 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
16683 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
16684 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
16685 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
16687 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
16688 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
16689 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
16690 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
16691 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
16692 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
16693 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
16695 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
16696 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
16697 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
16698 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
16699 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
16701 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
16703 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
16704 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
16705 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
16706 some now infamous attacks.
16710 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
16711 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
16712 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
16714 # Disable older protocol versions:
16715 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
16718 Possible options may include:
16722 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
16724 &`cipher_server_preference`&
16726 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
16730 &`legacy_server_connect`&
16732 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
16734 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
16736 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
16738 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
16740 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
16744 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
16758 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
16762 &`single_ecdh_use`&
16764 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
16766 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
16768 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
16772 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
16775 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
16776 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
16777 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
16778 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
16779 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
16780 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
16783 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
16784 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
16785 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
16786 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16787 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
16790 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16791 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
16792 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
16793 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
16794 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
16795 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
16796 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
16797 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
16798 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
16799 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
16802 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
16803 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
16804 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
16805 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
16806 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
16807 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
16808 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
16811 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
16813 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16814 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16817 .option perl_startup main string unset
16819 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16820 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16822 .option perl_taintmode main boolean false
16824 This option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
16827 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
16828 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
16829 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
16830 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
16831 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
16832 PostgreSQL support.
16835 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
16836 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
16837 .cindex "pid file, path for"
16838 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
16839 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
16842 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
16844 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
16846 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
16847 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
16848 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
16851 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16852 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
16853 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
16854 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16855 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
16856 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
16857 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
16858 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
16859 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
16860 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
16862 .option pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16863 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
16864 .cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
16865 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPE_CONNECT
16866 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
16867 this option controls which hosts the facility is advertised to
16868 and from which pipeline early-connection (before MAIL) SMTP
16869 commands are acceptable.
16870 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
16872 See also the &%hosts_pipe_connect%& smtp transport option.
16875 The SMTP service extension keyword advertised is &"PIPE_CONNECT"&.
16879 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
16880 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
16881 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PRDR
16882 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
16883 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
16884 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
16885 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
16886 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
16887 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
16889 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
16890 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
16891 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
16892 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
16893 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
16894 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
16895 volume of mail. Use with care!
16898 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
16899 .cindex "name" "of local host"
16900 .cindex "host" "name of local"
16901 .cindex "local host" "name of"
16902 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16903 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
16904 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
16905 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
16906 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
16907 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16909 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16910 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16911 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16912 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16913 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16914 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16917 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16918 .cindex "printing characters"
16919 .cindex "8-bit characters"
16920 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
16921 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16922 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16923 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16924 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16927 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16928 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16929 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16930 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16931 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16935 .option process_log_path main string unset
16936 .cindex "process log path"
16937 .cindex "log" "process log"
16938 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16939 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16940 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16941 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16942 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16943 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16944 different spool directories.
16947 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16948 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16952 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16953 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16954 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16957 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16958 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16959 .cindex "address" "qualification"
16960 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16961 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16962 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16963 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16964 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16965 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16967 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16968 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16969 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16970 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16971 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16972 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16973 &%primary_hostname%& value.
16976 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16977 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16978 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16982 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16983 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16984 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16985 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16986 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16987 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16988 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16989 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16992 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16993 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16995 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16996 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16997 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16998 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
17001 .option queue_only main boolean false
17002 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17003 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
17004 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
17005 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
17006 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
17007 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
17009 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
17010 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
17011 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
17012 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
17015 .option queue_only_file main string unset
17016 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17017 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
17018 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
17019 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
17020 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
17021 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
17022 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
17023 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
17025 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
17027 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
17028 &_/some/file_& exists.
17031 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
17032 .cindex "load average"
17033 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17034 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
17035 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
17036 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
17037 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
17038 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
17039 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
17042 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
17043 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
17044 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
17045 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
17048 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
17049 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
17050 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
17051 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
17052 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
17053 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
17054 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
17055 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
17056 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
17057 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
17058 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
17059 re-evaluated for each message.
17062 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
17063 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17064 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
17065 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
17066 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
17067 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
17070 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
17071 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
17072 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
17073 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
17074 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
17075 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
17076 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
17077 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
17078 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
17079 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
17080 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
17081 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
17082 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
17086 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
17087 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
17088 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
17089 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
17090 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
17091 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
17092 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
17093 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
17094 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
17096 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
17097 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
17098 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
17099 the daemon's command line.
17101 .cindex queues named
17102 .cindex "named queues" "resource limit"
17103 To set limits for different named queues use
17104 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
17106 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17107 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17108 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
17109 .cindex "first pass routing"
17110 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
17111 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
17112 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
17113 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
17114 message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
17115 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
17116 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
17117 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
17118 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
17119 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
17123 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
17124 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
17125 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
17126 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
17127 the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
17128 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
17129 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
17131 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
17132 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
17133 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
17134 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
17135 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
17136 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
17137 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
17138 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
17139 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
17141 The default setting is:
17144 received_header_text = Received: \
17145 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
17146 {${if def:sender_ident \
17147 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
17148 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
17149 by $primary_hostname \
17150 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
17151 ${if def:tls_in_ver { ($tls_in_ver)}}\
17152 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
17153 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
17154 ${if def:sender_address \
17155 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
17156 id $message_exim_id\
17157 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
17160 The references to the TLS version and cipher are
17161 omitted when Exim is built without TLS
17162 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
17163 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
17164 header lines such as the following:
17166 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
17167 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
17168 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
17169 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
17170 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
17171 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
17172 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
17174 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
17175 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
17176 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
17177 message was accepted.
17180 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
17181 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
17182 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
17183 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
17184 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
17185 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
17186 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
17187 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
17190 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17191 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
17192 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
17193 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
17194 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
17195 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
17196 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
17197 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
17198 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
17199 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
17200 option was not set.
17203 .option recipients_max main integer 50000
17204 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
17205 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
17206 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
17207 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
17208 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
17209 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
17210 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
17213 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
17214 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
17215 RCPT commands in a single message.
17218 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
17219 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
17220 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
17221 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
17222 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
17223 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
17224 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
17227 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
17228 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
17229 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
17230 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
17231 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
17232 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
17233 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
17234 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
17235 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
17236 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
17237 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
17238 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
17239 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
17240 tagged with its process id.
17242 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
17243 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
17244 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
17245 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
17248 .cindex "number of deliveries"
17249 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
17250 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
17251 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
17252 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
17253 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
17254 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
17255 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
17256 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
17257 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
17258 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
17260 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
17261 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
17262 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
17263 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
17266 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17267 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
17268 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
17269 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
17270 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
17272 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
17274 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
17275 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
17278 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
17279 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
17280 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
17281 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
17282 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
17286 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
17287 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
17288 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
17289 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
17290 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
17291 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
17292 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
17296 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
17297 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
17298 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
17299 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
17300 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
17301 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
17302 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
17303 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
17304 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
17305 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
17308 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
17309 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
17312 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
17314 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
17315 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
17316 an item in the list.
17317 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
17320 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
17321 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
17322 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
17323 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
17324 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
17327 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17328 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
17329 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
17330 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
17331 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
17332 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
17333 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
17334 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
17335 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
17336 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
17339 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
17340 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
17341 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
17342 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
17343 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
17344 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
17345 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
17349 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
17350 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
17351 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
17352 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
17353 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
17354 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
17355 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
17356 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
17357 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
17358 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
17359 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
17363 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
17364 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
17365 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17367 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
17368 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
17369 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
17370 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
17371 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
17372 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
17374 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
17375 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
17376 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
17377 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
17380 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
17381 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
17382 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
17383 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
17384 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
17385 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
17386 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
17387 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
17389 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
17390 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
17391 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
17392 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
17393 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
17394 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
17395 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
17396 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
17399 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17400 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
17401 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
17402 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
17406 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
17407 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
17408 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
17409 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
17410 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
17411 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
17412 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
17413 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
17414 . the option name to split.
17416 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
17417 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17418 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
17419 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
17420 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
17421 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
17422 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
17423 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
17424 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
17428 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
17429 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
17430 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
17431 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
17432 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
17433 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
17434 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
17435 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
17436 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
17437 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
17438 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
17440 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
17441 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
17442 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
17443 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
17444 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
17445 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
17449 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
17450 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17451 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17452 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
17453 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
17454 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
17455 in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
17456 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
17457 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
17458 to all messages received in the same connection.
17460 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
17461 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
17462 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
17463 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
17466 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17468 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
17469 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
17470 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17471 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
17472 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
17473 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
17474 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
17475 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
17476 number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
17477 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
17478 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
17479 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
17480 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
17483 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
17484 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
17485 .cindex "host" "reserved"
17486 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
17487 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
17488 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
17489 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
17490 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
17491 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
17492 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
17493 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
17496 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
17497 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
17498 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
17499 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
17502 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
17503 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
17504 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
17505 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17506 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
17507 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
17508 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
17509 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
17510 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
17512 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
17513 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
17514 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
17515 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
17517 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
17518 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
17519 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
17520 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
17521 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
17524 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
17525 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
17528 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
17529 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
17530 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
17531 &%helo_data%& value.
17533 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
17534 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
17535 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
17536 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
17537 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
17538 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
17539 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
17541 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
17542 $version_number $tod_full
17544 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
17545 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
17546 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
17547 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
17548 multiline response).
17551 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
17552 .cindex "checking disk space"
17553 .cindex "disk space, checking"
17554 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
17555 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
17556 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
17557 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
17558 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
17559 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
17562 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
17563 .cindex "connection backlog"
17564 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
17565 .cindex "backlog of connections"
17566 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
17567 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
17568 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
17569 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
17570 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
17571 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
17572 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
17573 attacks by SYN flooding.
17576 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
17577 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
17578 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
17579 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
17580 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
17581 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
17582 fewer, but they still exist.
17584 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
17585 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
17586 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
17587 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
17588 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
17589 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
17590 does detect many instances.
17592 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
17593 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
17594 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
17595 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
17599 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
17600 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
17601 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ETRN
17602 .vindex "&$domain$&"
17603 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
17604 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
17605 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
17606 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
17607 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
17610 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
17611 $sender_host_address
17614 If the option is not set, the argument for the ETRN command must
17615 be a &'#'& followed by an address string.
17616 In this case an &'exim -R <string>'& command is used;
17617 if the ETRN ACL has set up a named-queue then &'-MCG <queue>'& is appended.
17620 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
17621 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
17622 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
17623 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
17624 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
17628 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
17629 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
17630 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
17631 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
17632 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
17635 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
17636 .cindex "load average"
17637 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
17638 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
17639 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
17640 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
17641 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
17642 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
17646 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
17647 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
17648 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
17649 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
17650 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
17652 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
17654 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
17655 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
17656 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
17657 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
17658 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
17660 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
17661 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
17662 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
17663 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
17664 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
17665 not count towards the limit.
17669 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
17670 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
17671 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
17672 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
17673 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
17676 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
17677 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
17681 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17682 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
17683 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
17684 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
17685 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
17686 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
17689 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
17690 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
17691 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
17692 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
17694 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
17695 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
17696 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
17697 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
17701 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
17703 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
17704 fractional parts are allowed here.
17706 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
17708 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
17709 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
17712 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
17713 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
17715 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
17716 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
17718 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
17719 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
17720 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
17721 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
17724 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
17725 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17728 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
17729 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17732 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
17733 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
17734 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
17735 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
17736 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
17737 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
17738 the message is abandoned.
17739 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
17741 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
17742 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
17744 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
17745 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
17747 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
17748 expanded before use and may depend on
17749 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
17753 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
17754 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
17755 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
17756 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
17757 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
17760 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17761 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
17762 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
17765 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
17766 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
17767 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
17768 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
17769 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
17770 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
17771 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
17772 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
17773 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
17774 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
17776 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
17777 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
17781 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17782 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "ESMTP extension, advertising"
17783 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SMTPUTF8
17784 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
17785 the availability thereof is advertised in
17786 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17787 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
17790 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
17791 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
17792 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
17793 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
17797 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
17798 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
17799 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
17802 .option spf_smtp_comment_template main string&!! "Please%_see%_http://www.open-spf.org/Why"
17803 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support. It
17804 allows the customisation of the SMTP comment that the SPF library
17805 generates. You are strongly encouraged to link to your own explanative
17806 site. The template must not contain spaces. If you need spaces in the
17807 output, use the proper placeholder. If libspf2 can not parse the
17808 template, it uses a built-in default broken link. The following placeholders
17809 (along with Exim variables (but see below)) are allowed in the template:
17813 &*%{L}*&: Envelope sender's local part.
17815 &*%{S}*&: Envelope sender.
17817 &*%{O}*&: Envelope sender's domain.
17819 &*%{D}*&: Current(?) domain.
17821 &*%{I}*&: SMTP client Ip.
17823 &*%{C}*&: SMTP client pretty IP.
17825 &*%{T}*&: Epoch time (UTC).
17827 &*%{P}*&: SMTP client domain name.
17829 &*%{V}*&: IP version.
17831 &*%{H}*&: EHLO/HELO domain.
17833 &*%{R}*&: Receiving domain.
17835 The capitalized placeholders do proper URL encoding, if you use them
17836 lowercased, no encoding takes place. This list was compiled from the
17839 A note on using Exim variables: As
17840 currently the SPF library is initialized before the SMTP EHLO phase,
17841 the variables useful for expansion are quite limited.
17845 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
17846 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
17847 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
17848 .cindex "directories, multiple"
17849 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
17850 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
17851 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
17852 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
17853 arrival of the message.
17855 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
17856 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
17857 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
17858 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
17859 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
17861 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
17862 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
17863 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
17864 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
17865 automatically deleted.
17867 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
17868 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
17869 trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
17870 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
17871 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
17872 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
17873 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
17874 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
17875 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
17878 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
17879 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
17880 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
17881 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
17882 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
17883 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
17884 &$primary_hostname$&.
17886 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
17887 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
17888 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
17889 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
17890 as failures in the configuration file.
17892 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
17893 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
17895 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
17896 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
17897 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
17898 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
17899 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
17900 Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
17903 The following variables will not have useful values:
17905 $max_received_linelength
17910 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
17911 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
17912 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
17913 will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
17915 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
17916 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
17917 The transmission benefit is maintained.
17919 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
17920 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
17921 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
17922 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
17924 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
17925 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
17926 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
17927 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
17928 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
17929 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
17931 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
17932 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
17933 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
17934 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
17935 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
17936 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
17937 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
17940 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
17941 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
17942 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
17943 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
17944 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
17945 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
17946 domain causes a syntax error.
17947 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
17951 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
17952 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
17953 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
17954 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
17955 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17956 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17957 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17958 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17959 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17960 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17961 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17962 the LOG_ALERT priority.
17965 .option syslog_facility main string unset
17966 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17967 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17968 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17969 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17970 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17971 details of Exim's logging.
17974 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
17975 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
17976 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17977 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17978 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17979 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17980 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17984 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17985 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17986 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17987 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17988 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17992 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17993 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17994 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17995 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17996 details of Exim's logging.
17999 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
18000 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
18001 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
18002 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
18003 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
18004 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
18005 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
18006 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
18007 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
18008 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
18009 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
18010 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
18013 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
18014 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
18015 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
18016 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
18017 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
18018 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
18021 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
18022 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
18023 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
18024 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
18025 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
18027 .option system_filter_group main string unset
18028 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
18029 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
18030 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
18031 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
18033 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
18034 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
18035 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
18036 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
18037 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
18038 contains the pipe command.
18041 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
18042 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
18043 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
18044 is used in a system filter.
18047 .option system_filter_user main string unset
18048 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
18049 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
18050 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
18051 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
18052 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
18053 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
18054 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
18055 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
18056 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
18058 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
18059 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
18060 transport option overrides.
18063 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
18064 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
18065 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
18066 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
18067 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
18068 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
18069 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
18070 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
18071 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
18072 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
18073 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
18074 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
18078 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
18079 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
18080 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
18081 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
18082 message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
18083 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
18084 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
18085 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
18086 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
18087 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
18089 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
18090 frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
18091 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
18094 .option timezone main string unset
18095 .cindex "timezone, setting"
18096 .cindex "environment" "values from"
18097 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
18098 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
18099 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
18100 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
18104 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
18105 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
18106 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
18107 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
18108 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
18109 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
18112 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
18113 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
18114 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
18115 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
18116 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
18117 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
18118 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
18119 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
18120 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
18121 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
18122 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
18123 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
18126 .option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
18127 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
18128 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
18129 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
18130 files which contain the server's certificates (in PEM format).
18131 Commonly only one file is needed.
18132 The server's private key is also
18133 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
18134 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
18136 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
18137 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
18138 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
18139 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
18141 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
18142 separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) to avoid confusion under IPv6.
18144 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
18145 when a list of more than one
18146 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
18147 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
18149 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
18150 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
18151 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
18152 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
18154 If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
18155 generated for every connection.
18157 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
18158 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
18159 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
18160 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
18161 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
18163 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
18165 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
18166 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
18167 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
18169 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18172 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
18173 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
18174 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
18175 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
18176 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
18177 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
18179 The value must be at least 1024.
18181 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
18182 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
18183 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
18185 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
18188 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
18189 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
18190 larger prime than requested.
18193 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
18194 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
18195 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
18196 to be used by Exim.
18198 This option is ignored for GnuTLS version 3.6.0 and later.
18199 The library manages parameter negotiation internally.
18201 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend,
18202 for other TLS library versions,
18203 using a filename with site-generated
18204 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
18205 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
18206 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
18208 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
18209 then it names a file from which DH
18210 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
18211 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
18212 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
18213 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
18214 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
18215 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
18217 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
18220 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
18221 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
18222 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
18223 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
18225 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
18226 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
18228 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
18229 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
18230 in IKE is assigned number 23.
18232 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
18233 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
18234 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
18235 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
18236 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
18238 The available standard primes are:
18239 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
18240 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
18241 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
18242 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
18244 The available additional primes are:
18245 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
18247 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
18248 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
18249 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
18250 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
18251 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
18253 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
18254 they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
18255 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
18257 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
18258 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
18259 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
18260 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
18261 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
18264 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
18265 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
18266 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
18267 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
18268 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
18269 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
18270 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
18273 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
18274 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
18275 This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
18276 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
18278 After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
18279 &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
18280 for valid selections.
18282 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
18283 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
18284 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
18286 If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
18289 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
18290 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
18291 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
18293 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
18294 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
18295 Certificate Authority.
18297 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
18298 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP" will be defined for those versions.
18300 For OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later, and
18301 for GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
18302 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
18303 The ordering of the two lists must match.
18304 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP_LIST" will be defined for those versions.
18306 The file(s) should be in DER format,
18307 except for GnuTLS 3.6.3 or later
18309 when an optional filetype prefix can be used.
18310 The prefix must be one of "DER" or "PEM", followed by
18311 a single space. If one is used it sets the format for subsequent
18312 files in the list; the initial format is DER.
18313 If multiple proofs are wanted, for multiple chain elements
18314 (this only works under TLS1.3)
18315 they must be coded as a combined OCSP response.
18317 Although GnuTLS will accept PEM files with multiple separate
18318 PEM blobs (ie. separate OCSP responses), it sends them in the
18319 TLS Certificate record interleaved with the certificates of the chain;
18320 although a GnuTLS client is happy with that, an OpenSSL client is not.
18322 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
18325 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
18326 operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
18327 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
18328 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
18332 .option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
18333 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
18334 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
18335 files which contains the server's private keys.
18336 If this option is unset, or if
18337 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
18338 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
18339 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
18341 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18344 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
18345 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
18346 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
18347 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
18348 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
18349 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
18353 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
18354 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
18355 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
18356 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
18357 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
18358 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
18359 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
18360 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
18361 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
18362 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
18363 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
18366 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18367 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18368 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18369 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
18372 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
18373 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18374 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18375 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
18377 or the absolute path to
18378 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
18379 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
18381 The "system" value for the option will use a
18382 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
18383 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
18384 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
18387 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
18388 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
18390 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
18392 either by file or directory
18393 are added to those given by the system default location.
18395 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
18396 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
18397 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
18398 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
18399 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
18400 use the explicit directory version.
18402 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18404 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
18408 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18409 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18410 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18411 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
18412 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
18413 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
18414 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
18415 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
18417 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
18418 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
18419 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
18420 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
18421 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
18422 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
18423 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
18425 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
18426 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
18427 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
18428 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
18429 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
18430 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
18431 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
18434 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
18438 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
18439 .cindex "trusted groups"
18440 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
18441 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18442 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
18443 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
18444 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
18445 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
18446 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
18449 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
18450 .cindex "trusted users"
18451 .cindex "user" "trusted"
18452 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18453 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
18454 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
18455 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
18456 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
18457 Exim user are trusted.
18459 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
18460 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
18461 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
18462 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
18463 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
18464 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
18465 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
18466 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
18467 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
18470 .option unknown_username main string unset
18471 See &%unknown_login%&.
18473 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
18474 .cindex "trusted users"
18475 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
18476 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
18477 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
18478 .cindex "envelope from"
18479 .cindex "envelope sender"
18480 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
18481 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
18482 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
18483 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
18484 is used) is ignored.
18486 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
18487 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
18489 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
18491 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
18492 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
18493 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
18494 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
18495 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
18496 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
18497 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
18498 followed by a hyphen
18499 by a setting like this:
18501 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
18503 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
18504 restriction, you can use
18506 untrusted_set_sender = *
18508 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
18509 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
18510 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
18511 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
18512 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
18513 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
18514 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
18515 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
18517 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
18518 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
18519 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
18520 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
18524 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
18525 .cindex "&""From""& line"
18526 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
18527 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
18528 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
18529 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
18530 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
18531 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
18532 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
18533 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
18535 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
18536 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
18538 The pattern can be seen by running
18540 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
18542 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
18543 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
18544 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
18545 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
18546 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
18547 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
18550 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
18551 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
18554 .option warn_message_file main string&!! unset
18555 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
18556 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
18557 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
18558 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
18559 been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
18560 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
18561 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&.
18563 .cindex warn_message_file "tainted data"
18564 The option is expanded to give the file path, which must be
18565 absolute and untainted.
18567 See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
18570 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
18571 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
18572 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
18573 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
18574 .ecindex IIDconfima
18575 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
18580 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18581 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18583 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
18584 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
18585 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
18586 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
18587 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
18589 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
18590 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
18591 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
18592 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
18593 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
18596 The name of a router is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
18597 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
18602 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
18603 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
18604 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
18605 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
18606 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
18607 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
18608 delivery of the address to be deferred.
18610 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18611 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
18612 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
18613 routers, and the eventual transport.
18615 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
18616 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
18617 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
18618 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
18619 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
18621 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
18622 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
18623 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
18624 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
18625 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
18627 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
18628 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
18629 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
18631 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
18633 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
18635 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
18637 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
18638 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
18640 See also the &%set%& option below.
18642 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
18643 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18644 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
18645 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
18646 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
18647 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
18648 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
18652 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
18654 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
18655 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
18656 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
18657 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
18658 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
18663 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
18664 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
18665 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
18666 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
18667 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
18668 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
18669 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
18670 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
18671 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
18672 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
18675 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
18677 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
18680 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
18682 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
18683 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
18684 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
18685 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
18688 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
18689 .cindex "case of local parts"
18690 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
18691 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
18692 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
18693 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
18694 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
18695 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
18696 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
18699 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18700 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
18701 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
18702 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
18703 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
18704 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
18705 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
18706 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
18707 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
18709 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
18710 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
18711 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
18712 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
18716 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
18717 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
18718 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
18719 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
18721 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
18722 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
18723 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
18724 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
18725 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
18726 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
18727 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
18728 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
18729 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
18730 the router is skipped.
18732 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
18733 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
18734 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
18735 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
18736 setting to achieve this. For example:
18738 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
18740 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
18741 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
18742 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
18746 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
18747 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
18748 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
18749 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
18750 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
18751 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
18752 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
18753 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
18755 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
18756 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
18758 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
18759 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
18761 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
18762 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
18763 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
18765 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18767 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
18769 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
18772 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
18774 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18775 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
18779 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
18780 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
18781 be specified using &%condition%&.
18783 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
18784 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
18785 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
18786 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18787 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18788 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
18789 Router rules processing behavior.
18791 This is best illustrated in an example:
18793 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
18794 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
18796 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18799 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18802 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
18803 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
18804 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
18805 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
18806 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
18807 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
18808 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
18809 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
18811 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
18812 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
18813 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
18814 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
18817 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
18818 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
18819 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
18820 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
18821 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
18824 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
18825 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18826 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18827 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
18828 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
18829 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18830 output, and Exim carries on processing.
18831 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18832 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
18833 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
18834 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
18835 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
18836 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
18837 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
18841 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
18842 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
18843 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
18844 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
18845 transport option of the same name.
18847 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" *
18848 .cindex "MX record" "security"
18849 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18850 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18851 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18852 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
18853 the dnssec request bit set.
18854 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18856 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18857 .cindex "MX record" "security"
18858 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18859 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18860 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18861 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
18862 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
18863 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
18864 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18867 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
18868 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
18869 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
18870 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
18871 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
18872 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
18873 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
18874 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
18878 .option driver routers string unset
18879 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
18883 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
18884 .cindex "DSN" "success"
18885 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
18886 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
18887 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
18888 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
18889 Not effective on redirect routers.
18893 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
18894 .cindex "envelope from"
18895 .cindex "envelope sender"
18896 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
18897 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
18898 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
18899 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
18900 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
18901 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
18902 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
18904 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
18905 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
18906 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
18909 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
18910 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
18911 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
18912 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
18914 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
18915 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
18916 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
18917 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
18923 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
18924 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
18925 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
18926 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
18927 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
18929 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18930 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
18931 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
18932 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
18933 setting &%return_path%&.
18935 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
18936 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
18937 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
18941 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
18942 .cindex "address" "testing"
18943 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
18944 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
18945 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
18946 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
18947 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
18948 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
18949 on for the system alias file.
18950 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18953 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
18954 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
18955 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
18959 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
18960 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
18961 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
18962 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18966 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
18967 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18968 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
18972 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
18973 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18974 verifying a sender, verification fails.
18978 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
18979 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
18980 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
18981 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
18982 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
18983 changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
18984 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
18985 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
18986 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
18988 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
18989 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18990 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18991 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18992 transport for further details.
18995 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
18996 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18997 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18998 .cindex "transport" "local"
18999 .cindex "router" "setting group"
19000 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19001 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
19003 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19004 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19005 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
19006 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
19007 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19011 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
19012 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
19013 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
19014 This option specifies a list of text headers,
19015 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
19016 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
19017 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
19018 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
19019 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
19020 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
19021 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
19022 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
19023 &"see"& the added header lines.
19025 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
19026 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
19027 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
19028 failures are treated as configuration errors.
19030 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
19031 for a router; all listed headers are added.
19033 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
19034 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
19036 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
19037 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
19038 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
19039 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
19040 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
19041 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
19042 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
19043 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
19044 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
19045 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
19049 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
19050 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
19051 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
19052 This option specifies a list of text headers,
19053 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
19054 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
19055 However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
19056 Each list item is separately expanded, at transport time.
19058 If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
19061 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
19062 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
19063 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
19064 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
19065 &"see"& the original header lines.
19067 The &%headers_remove%& option is handled after &%errors_to%& and
19068 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
19069 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
19072 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
19073 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
19075 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
19076 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
19078 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
19079 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
19080 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
19081 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
19083 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
19084 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
19085 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
19089 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
19090 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
19091 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
19092 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
19093 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
19094 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
19095 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
19098 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
19102 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
19104 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
19105 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
19106 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
19107 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
19108 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
19109 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
19111 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
19112 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
19114 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
19115 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
19117 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
19118 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
19120 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
19121 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19122 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
19123 domain that is being routed.
19125 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19126 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
19129 .option initgroups routers boolean false
19130 .cindex "additional groups"
19131 .cindex "groups" "additional"
19132 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19133 .cindex "transport" "local"
19134 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
19135 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
19136 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
19137 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
19138 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19142 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
19143 .cindex affix "router precondition"
19144 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
19145 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
19146 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
19147 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
19148 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
19151 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
19152 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
19153 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
19154 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
19155 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
19156 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
19157 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
19158 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
19159 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
19161 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19162 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
19163 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
19164 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
19165 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
19166 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
19167 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
19168 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
19169 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
19170 the relevant transport.
19173 .vindex &$local_part_prefix_v$&
19174 If wildcarding (above) was used then the part of the prefix matching the
19175 wildcard is available in &$local_part_prefix_v$&.
19178 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
19179 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
19180 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
19183 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
19184 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
19185 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
19186 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
19187 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
19191 local_part_prefix = real-
19193 transport = local_delivery
19195 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
19196 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
19198 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
19199 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
19202 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
19203 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
19204 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
19205 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
19208 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
19209 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
19213 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
19214 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
19215 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
19216 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
19217 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
19218 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
19219 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
19220 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
19221 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
19225 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
19226 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
19230 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
19231 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
19232 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
19233 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
19234 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19236 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
19237 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
19240 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
19242 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
19243 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
19244 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
19245 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
19246 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
19247 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
19248 each virtual domain:
19252 local_parts = postmaster
19253 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
19257 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
19258 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
19259 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
19260 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
19261 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
19262 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
19263 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
19264 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
19265 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
19266 redirect addresses.
19270 .option more routers boolean&!! true
19271 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19272 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19273 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19274 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
19275 delivery to be deferred.
19277 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
19278 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
19280 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
19281 means of the setting
19285 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
19286 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
19287 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
19289 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
19290 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
19291 controls what happens next.
19294 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
19295 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
19296 .cindex "router" "timeout"
19297 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
19298 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
19299 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
19300 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
19301 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
19303 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
19304 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
19305 applies to all of them.
19309 .option pass_router routers string unset
19310 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
19311 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
19312 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
19313 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
19314 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
19315 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
19316 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
19317 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
19318 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
19319 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
19323 .option redirect_router routers string unset
19324 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
19325 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
19326 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
19327 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
19328 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
19330 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
19331 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
19332 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
19333 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
19337 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
19338 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
19339 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
19340 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
19341 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
19342 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
19343 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
19345 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
19346 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
19347 (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
19348 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
19349 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
19351 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
19352 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
19353 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
19354 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
19355 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
19358 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
19359 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
19362 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
19363 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
19364 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
19365 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
19366 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
19367 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
19368 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
19369 transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
19371 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
19372 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
19373 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
19374 operates as follows:
19376 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
19377 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
19378 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
19379 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
19382 require_files = mail:/some/file
19383 require_files = $local_part_data:$home/.procmailrc
19385 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
19386 &%require_files%& condition fails.
19388 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
19389 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
19390 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
19391 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
19393 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
19394 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
19395 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
19396 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
19397 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
19399 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
19400 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
19401 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
19402 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
19403 check again in that process.
19405 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
19406 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
19407 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
19408 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
19409 not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
19410 for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
19411 as if the file did not exist. For example:
19413 require_files = +/some/file
19415 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
19416 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
19417 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
19421 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
19422 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
19423 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
19424 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
19425 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
19426 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
19427 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
19428 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
19431 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
19432 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
19433 router. The default value is true for any router that has any of
19434 &%check_local_user%&,
19437 &%local_part_prefix%&,
19438 &%local_part_suffix%&,
19441 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
19442 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
19445 Failing to set this option when it is needed
19446 (because a remote router handles only some of the local-parts for a domain)
19447 can result in incorrect error messages being generated.
19449 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
19450 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
19451 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
19455 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
19456 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
19457 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
19459 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
19460 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
19461 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
19462 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
19463 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
19464 cause the router to defer.
19466 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
19467 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
19469 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19471 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
19472 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
19474 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
19475 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
19476 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
19477 of these values that is set:
19480 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19482 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19484 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19486 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19489 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
19490 router, but not for the transport.
19494 .option self routers string freeze
19495 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19496 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19497 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
19498 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
19499 and &(manualroute)& routers.
19500 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
19502 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
19503 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
19504 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
19505 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
19506 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19508 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
19509 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
19510 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
19511 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
19512 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
19517 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
19519 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
19520 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
19521 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
19522 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
19524 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
19525 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
19526 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
19531 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
19532 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
19533 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
19534 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
19535 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
19536 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
19542 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
19543 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
19544 be passed to the next router.
19547 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
19550 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
19551 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
19552 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
19553 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
19554 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
19555 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
19560 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
19561 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
19562 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
19563 address matches something on the list.
19564 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19567 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
19568 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
19569 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
19570 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
19571 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
19572 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
19573 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
19577 .option set routers "string list" unset
19578 .cindex router variables
19579 This option may be used multiple times on a router;
19580 because of this the list aspect is mostly irrelevant.
19581 The list separator is a semicolon but can be changed in the
19584 Each list-element given must be of the form &"name = value"&
19585 and the names used must start with the string &"r_"&.
19586 Values containing a list-separator should have them doubled.
19587 When a router runs, the strings are evaluated in order,
19588 to create variables which are added to the set associated with
19590 The variable is set with the expansion of the value.
19591 The variables can be used by the router options
19592 (not including any preconditions)
19593 and by the transport.
19594 Later definitions of a given named variable will override former ones.
19595 Variable use is via the usual &$r_...$& syntax.
19597 This is similar to the &%address_data%& option, except that
19598 many independent variables can be used, with choice of naming.
19601 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
19602 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
19603 .cindex "packet radio"
19604 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
19605 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
19606 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
19607 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
19608 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
19609 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
19610 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
19611 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
19613 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19614 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
19615 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
19616 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
19617 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
19618 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
19619 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
19620 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
19621 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
19622 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
19624 translate_ip_address = \
19625 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
19628 The file would contain lines like
19630 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
19631 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
19633 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
19638 .option transport routers string&!! unset
19639 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
19640 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
19641 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
19642 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
19643 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
19644 delivery is deferred.
19646 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
19647 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
19648 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
19652 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
19653 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
19654 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
19655 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
19656 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
19657 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
19658 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
19659 overridden by a setting on the transport.
19660 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19661 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19662 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
19668 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
19669 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19670 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
19671 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
19672 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
19673 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
19674 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
19675 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
19676 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19677 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19679 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
19680 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
19681 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
19682 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
19683 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
19685 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
19691 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
19692 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
19693 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19694 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19695 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19696 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
19697 delivery to be deferred.
19699 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
19700 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
19701 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
19702 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
19703 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
19704 sometimes true and sometimes false).
19706 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
19707 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
19708 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
19709 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
19710 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
19711 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
19712 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
19713 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
19715 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
19716 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
19717 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
19718 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
19719 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
19720 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
19721 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
19722 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
19723 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
19724 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
19726 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
19727 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
19728 subsequent routers.
19731 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
19732 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19733 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19734 .cindex "transport" "local"
19735 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
19736 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
19737 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19738 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
19739 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19740 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19741 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
19742 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
19743 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
19744 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
19745 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
19746 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19750 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
19751 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
19752 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19755 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
19756 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
19758 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
19759 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
19760 delivering in cutthrough mode or
19761 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
19762 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
19763 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
19764 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
19766 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
19767 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
19768 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
19772 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
19773 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
19775 delivering in cutthrough mode
19776 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
19777 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19779 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19782 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
19783 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
19784 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
19785 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19787 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19788 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
19789 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
19796 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19797 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19799 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
19800 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
19801 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
19802 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
19803 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
19804 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
19805 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
19806 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
19807 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
19811 domains = mydomain.example
19813 transport = local_delivery
19815 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
19816 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
19817 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
19818 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
19825 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19826 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19828 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
19829 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
19830 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
19831 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
19832 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
19833 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
19835 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
19836 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
19837 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
19838 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
19841 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
19842 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
19843 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
19844 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
19845 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19846 generic option, the router declines.
19848 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
19849 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
19850 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
19852 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19853 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19854 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
19855 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
19856 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
19857 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
19860 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
19861 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
19862 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
19863 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
19864 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
19865 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
19867 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
19868 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
19869 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
19870 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
19871 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
19872 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
19873 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
19874 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
19875 case routing fails.
19878 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
19879 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
19880 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
19881 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
19882 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
19884 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
19885 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
19887 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
19889 The domain does not exist in DNS
19891 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
19892 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
19893 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
19895 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
19897 MX record points to a non-existent host.
19899 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
19900 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
19902 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
19903 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
19905 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
19906 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
19908 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
19909 not be found in the MX records (see below)
19915 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
19916 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
19917 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
19919 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
19920 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
19921 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
19922 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
19923 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
19924 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
19925 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19928 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
19929 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
19930 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
19931 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
19932 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
19933 required. For example,
19937 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
19938 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
19939 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
19940 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
19941 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
19944 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
19945 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
19946 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
19947 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
19948 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
19949 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
19951 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
19952 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
19953 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
19954 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
19955 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
19956 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
19957 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
19958 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
19960 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
19961 when there is a DNS lookup error.
19966 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19967 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
19968 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
19969 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
19970 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
19971 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
19972 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
19973 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
19977 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
19978 .cindex IPv6 disabling
19979 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
19980 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19981 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19982 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19983 only A records are used.
19985 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
19986 .cindex IPv4 preference
19987 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
19988 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19989 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19990 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19991 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
19993 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19994 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
19995 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
19996 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
19997 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
19998 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
19999 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
20002 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
20004 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
20005 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
20006 the address record.
20009 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20010 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
20011 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
20012 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
20017 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
20018 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
20019 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
20020 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
20021 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
20022 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
20023 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
20024 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
20025 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
20030 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
20031 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
20032 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
20033 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
20034 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
20035 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
20036 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
20037 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
20038 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
20039 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
20040 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
20042 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
20043 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
20046 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
20047 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
20048 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
20049 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
20050 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
20054 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
20055 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
20056 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
20057 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
20058 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
20059 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
20060 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
20061 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
20063 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
20064 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
20065 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
20066 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
20067 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
20068 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
20069 without processing them independently,
20070 provided the following conditions are met:
20073 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
20074 &%headers_remove%&.
20076 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
20083 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
20084 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
20085 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
20086 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
20087 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
20088 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
20089 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
20090 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
20091 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
20092 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
20094 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
20095 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
20100 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20101 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
20102 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
20103 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
20108 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
20109 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
20110 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
20111 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
20114 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
20116 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
20117 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
20118 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
20119 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
20120 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
20121 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
20124 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
20125 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
20126 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
20127 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
20128 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
20130 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
20131 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
20132 such as that implied by
20136 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
20137 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
20138 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
20139 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
20149 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20150 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20152 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
20153 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
20154 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
20155 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
20156 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
20157 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
20158 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
20159 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
20160 router handles the address
20164 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
20165 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
20166 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
20168 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
20170 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
20171 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
20173 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
20174 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
20175 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
20176 &%self%& option determines what happens.
20178 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
20179 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
20180 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
20181 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
20185 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20186 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20188 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
20189 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
20190 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
20191 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
20192 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
20193 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
20196 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
20198 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
20200 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
20201 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
20202 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
20203 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
20204 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
20205 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
20206 must not be specified for it.
20208 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
20209 .option hosts iplookup string unset
20210 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
20211 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
20212 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
20213 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
20214 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
20217 .option optional iplookup boolean false
20218 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
20219 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
20220 delivery to the address is deferred.
20223 .option port iplookup integer 0
20224 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
20225 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
20229 .option protocol iplookup string udp
20230 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
20231 protocols is to be used.
20234 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
20235 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
20238 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
20240 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
20241 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
20244 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
20245 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
20246 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
20247 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
20248 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
20249 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
20250 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
20251 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
20254 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
20255 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
20256 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
20257 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
20258 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
20259 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
20260 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
20261 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
20262 following could be used:
20264 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
20265 reroute = $local_part@$1
20268 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
20269 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
20270 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
20271 call. It does not apply to UDP.
20276 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20277 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20279 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
20280 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
20281 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
20282 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
20283 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
20284 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
20285 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
20286 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
20287 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
20288 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
20290 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
20291 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
20292 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
20293 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
20294 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
20295 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
20296 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
20299 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
20300 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
20301 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
20302 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
20303 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
20304 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
20305 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
20308 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
20309 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
20310 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
20311 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
20312 below, following the list of private options.
20315 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
20317 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
20318 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
20320 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
20321 See &%host_find_failed%&.
20323 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
20324 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
20325 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
20326 of the following values:
20335 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
20336 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
20337 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
20340 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
20341 router only if &%more%& is true.
20343 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
20344 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
20345 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
20346 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
20348 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
20349 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
20350 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
20353 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
20354 .cindex "randomized host list"
20355 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
20356 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
20357 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
20358 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
20359 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
20360 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
20361 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
20362 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
20364 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
20365 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
20366 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
20367 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
20369 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
20371 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
20372 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
20373 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
20374 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
20375 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
20378 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
20379 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
20380 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
20383 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
20385 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
20386 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
20390 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
20391 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
20392 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
20393 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
20396 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
20397 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
20398 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
20399 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
20400 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
20401 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
20402 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
20403 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
20405 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
20406 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
20407 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
20408 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
20409 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
20410 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
20411 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
20412 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
20417 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
20418 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
20419 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
20420 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
20421 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
20422 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
20424 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
20426 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
20430 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
20431 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20433 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
20434 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
20435 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
20436 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
20437 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
20438 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
20439 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
20440 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
20441 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
20442 in a &%route_list%&).
20444 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
20445 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
20446 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
20447 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
20451 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
20452 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
20453 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
20454 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
20455 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
20456 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
20457 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
20460 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
20461 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20463 This data can be accessed by setting
20465 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
20467 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
20468 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
20469 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
20470 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
20471 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
20476 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
20477 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
20478 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
20479 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
20480 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
20481 If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
20482 The format of each item
20483 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
20484 as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
20486 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
20487 variables are set during its expansion:
20490 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20491 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
20492 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
20494 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
20497 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
20499 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
20502 .vindex "&$value$&"
20503 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
20504 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
20506 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
20510 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
20511 semicolon is the default route list separator.
20515 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
20516 Each item in the list of hosts can be either a host name or an IP address,
20517 optionally with an attached port number, or it can be a single "+"
20518 (see &%hosts_randomize%&).
20519 When no port is given, an IP address
20520 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
20521 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
20522 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
20525 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
20526 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
20527 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
20529 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
20530 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
20533 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
20534 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
20535 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
20536 number follows. For example:
20538 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
20542 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
20543 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
20544 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
20545 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
20546 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
20549 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
20550 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
20551 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
20552 records in the DNS. For example:
20554 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
20556 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
20559 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
20561 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
20562 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
20563 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
20564 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
20565 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
20566 happens is controlled by the
20567 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20568 &%self%& option of the router.
20570 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
20571 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
20572 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
20573 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
20574 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
20575 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
20576 defined by MX preferences.
20578 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
20579 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
20580 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
20582 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
20583 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
20584 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
20585 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
20587 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
20588 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
20591 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
20592 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
20593 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
20595 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
20596 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
20600 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
20601 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
20602 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
20603 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
20604 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
20605 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
20606 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
20609 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
20610 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20612 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
20613 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20615 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
20616 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
20617 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
20619 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
20620 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
20621 timeout), delivery is deferred.
20623 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
20625 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
20630 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
20631 domain2 host4:host5
20633 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
20634 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
20635 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
20636 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
20639 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
20640 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
20641 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
20642 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
20645 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
20646 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
20651 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
20652 &%host_find_failed%& option.
20655 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
20656 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
20660 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
20661 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
20662 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
20665 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
20666 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
20667 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
20668 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
20670 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
20672 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
20673 your first router something like this:
20676 driver = manualroute
20677 domains = !+local_domains
20678 transport = remote_smtp
20679 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
20681 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
20682 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
20683 they are tried in order
20684 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
20685 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
20688 driver = manualroute
20689 transport = remote_smtp
20690 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
20692 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
20693 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
20694 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
20695 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
20696 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
20697 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
20698 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
20699 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
20702 .cindex "mail hub example"
20703 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
20704 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
20705 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
20706 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
20707 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
20708 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
20709 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
20710 lookup is easier to manage.
20712 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
20713 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
20717 driver = manualroute
20718 transport = remote_smtp
20719 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
20721 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
20722 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
20723 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
20724 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
20725 domain can be used to find the host:
20728 driver = manualroute
20729 transport = remote_smtp
20730 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
20732 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
20733 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
20734 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
20738 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
20739 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
20740 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
20741 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
20742 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
20743 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
20746 driver = manualroute
20747 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
20748 route_list = saved.domain.example
20750 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
20751 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
20752 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
20755 driver = manualroute
20757 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
20758 *.saved.domain2.example \
20759 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
20762 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20764 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
20765 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
20766 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
20767 the address if the lookup fails.
20770 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
20771 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
20772 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
20773 one way it can be done:
20779 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
20780 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
20781 return_fail_output = true
20786 driver = manualroute
20788 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
20790 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
20792 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
20794 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
20795 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
20796 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
20798 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
20799 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
20808 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20809 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20811 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
20812 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
20813 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
20814 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
20815 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
20816 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
20817 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
20818 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
20819 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
20820 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
20822 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
20824 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
20825 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
20826 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
20827 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
20828 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
20831 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
20832 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
20833 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
20834 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
20835 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
20836 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
20839 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
20840 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
20841 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
20842 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
20843 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
20844 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
20845 not set, a value for the gid also.
20847 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
20848 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
20849 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
20850 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
20851 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
20852 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
20856 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
20857 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
20858 before running the command.
20861 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
20862 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
20863 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
20867 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
20868 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
20869 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
20870 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
20871 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
20874 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
20877 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
20878 &%no_more%& is set.
20880 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
20881 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
20882 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
20883 included in the SMTP response.
20885 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
20886 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
20887 included in any SMTP response.
20889 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
20891 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
20892 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
20894 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
20895 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
20896 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
20899 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
20900 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
20903 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
20904 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
20906 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
20907 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
20908 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
20909 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
20911 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
20912 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
20913 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
20914 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
20915 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
20917 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
20918 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
20919 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
20920 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
20921 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
20923 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
20924 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
20925 variable. For example, this return line
20927 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
20929 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
20930 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
20931 .ecindex IIDquerou1
20932 .ecindex IIDquerou2
20937 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20938 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20940 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
20941 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
20942 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
20943 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
20944 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
20945 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
20946 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
20947 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
20948 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
20949 redirected in several different ways:
20952 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
20955 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
20957 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
20959 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
20961 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
20963 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
20965 It can be discarded.
20968 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
20969 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
20970 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
20971 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
20973 If success DSNs have been requested
20974 .cindex "DSN" "success"
20975 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
20976 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
20980 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
20981 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
20982 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
20983 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
20984 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
20985 aliases, in a configuration like this:
20989 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
20991 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
20992 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
20993 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
20994 cause delivery to be deferred.
20996 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
20997 &_.forward_& files, like this:
21002 file = $home/.forward
21005 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
21006 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
21007 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
21008 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
21012 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
21013 .cindex redirect "tainted data"
21014 Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
21016 &*Warning*&: It is unwise to use &$local_part$& or &$domain$&
21017 directly for redirection,
21018 as they are provided by a potential attacker.
21019 In the examples above, &$local_part$& is used for looking up data held locally
21020 on the system, and not used directly (the second example derives &$home$& via
21021 the passsword file or database, using &$local_part$&).
21026 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
21027 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
21028 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
21029 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
21032 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
21033 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
21034 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
21035 practice the router may not be able to operate.
21037 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
21038 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
21039 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
21040 saves some resources.
21048 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
21049 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
21050 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
21051 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
21052 can be interpreted in two different ways:
21055 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
21056 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
21057 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
21058 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
21059 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
21060 document is intended for use by end users.
21062 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
21063 described in the next section.
21066 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
21067 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
21068 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
21069 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
21070 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
21074 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
21075 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
21076 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
21077 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
21078 addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
21079 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
21080 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
21081 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
21082 commas or newlines.
21083 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
21086 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
21087 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
21088 next newline character is ignored.
21090 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
21091 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
21092 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
21093 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
21096 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21097 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
21098 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
21099 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
21100 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
21101 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
21104 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
21108 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
21109 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
21110 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
21111 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
21112 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
21113 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
21114 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
21115 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
21116 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
21117 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
21118 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
21120 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
21121 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
21122 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
21123 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
21124 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
21126 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
21128 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
21129 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
21130 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
21131 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
21132 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
21135 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
21136 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
21137 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
21138 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
21139 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
21141 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
21142 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
21147 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
21148 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
21151 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
21153 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
21154 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
21155 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
21156 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
21157 should really contain
21159 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
21161 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
21162 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
21163 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
21167 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
21168 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
21169 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
21172 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
21173 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
21174 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
21175 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
21176 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
21177 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
21178 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
21180 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
21181 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
21182 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
21183 in double quotes, for example:
21185 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
21187 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
21188 quote just the command. An item such as
21190 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
21192 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
21194 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
21195 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
21196 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
21197 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
21198 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
21199 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
21200 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
21201 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
21202 an &%accept%& router.
21205 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
21206 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
21207 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
21208 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
21210 /home/world/minbari
21212 is treated as a filename, but
21214 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
21216 is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
21217 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
21218 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
21219 filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
21221 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
21222 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
21224 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
21225 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
21226 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
21227 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
21230 .cindex "included address list"
21231 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
21232 If an item is of the form
21234 :include:<path name>
21236 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
21237 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
21238 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
21239 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
21240 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
21241 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
21243 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
21245 It must be given as
21247 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
21250 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
21251 .cindex redirect "tainted data"
21252 Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
21255 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
21256 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
21257 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
21258 .cindex "black hole"
21259 .cindex "abandoning mail"
21260 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
21261 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
21262 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
21266 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
21267 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
21268 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
21270 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
21271 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
21272 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
21273 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
21277 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
21278 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
21279 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
21280 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
21281 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
21282 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
21283 redirection items of the form
21288 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
21289 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
21290 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
21291 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
21293 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
21295 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
21297 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
21298 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
21300 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
21301 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
21302 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
21304 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21305 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
21306 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
21307 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
21308 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
21309 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
21310 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
21311 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
21312 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
21315 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
21316 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
21317 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
21318 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
21320 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
21321 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
21322 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
21323 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
21324 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
21326 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
21327 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
21328 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
21329 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
21330 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
21334 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
21335 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
21336 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
21337 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
21338 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
21339 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
21340 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
21344 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
21345 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
21346 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
21347 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
21348 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
21349 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
21350 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
21351 aliasing scheme of the type
21353 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
21357 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
21358 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
21359 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
21362 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
21363 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
21365 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
21366 the pipes are distinct.
21370 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
21371 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
21372 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
21373 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
21374 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
21375 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
21376 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
21377 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
21378 can be used to avoid this.
21381 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
21382 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
21383 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
21384 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
21385 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
21386 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
21387 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
21391 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
21393 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
21394 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
21397 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
21398 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
21399 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
21402 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
21403 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
21404 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
21405 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
21408 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
21409 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
21410 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
21411 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
21412 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
21413 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
21414 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
21416 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
21417 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
21420 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
21421 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
21422 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
21423 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
21424 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
21428 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
21429 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
21430 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
21431 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
21432 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
21433 let ordinary users do.
21437 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
21438 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
21439 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
21440 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
21441 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
21442 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
21444 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
21445 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
21446 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
21447 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
21448 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
21449 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
21451 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
21453 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
21454 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
21455 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
21456 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
21457 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
21458 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
21459 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
21460 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
21463 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
21464 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
21465 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
21466 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
21467 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
21468 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
21469 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
21470 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
21474 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
21475 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
21476 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
21477 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
21478 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
21479 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
21482 .option data redirect string&!! unset
21483 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
21484 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
21485 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
21486 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
21487 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
21489 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
21490 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
21491 terminated with newline characters. For example:
21493 data = #Exim filter\n\
21494 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
21496 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
21497 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
21498 choice into a newline.
21501 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
21502 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
21503 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21504 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21505 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
21508 .option file redirect string&!! unset
21509 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
21510 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
21511 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
21512 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
21513 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
21514 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
21515 entirely of comments), the router declines.
21517 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
21518 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
21519 runs a check on the containing directory,
21520 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
21521 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
21522 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
21523 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
21524 not, the router declines.
21527 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
21528 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21529 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
21530 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21531 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21532 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
21533 it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
21536 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
21537 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
21538 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
21539 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
21540 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
21543 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
21544 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21545 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21546 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
21550 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
21551 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21552 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21553 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
21554 &%allow_filter%& is true.
21559 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
21560 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21561 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
21562 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21563 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
21564 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
21565 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
21566 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
21567 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
21568 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
21569 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
21572 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
21573 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21574 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21575 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21576 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
21579 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
21580 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21581 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21582 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
21583 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21584 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
21586 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
21587 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21588 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21589 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
21590 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
21591 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
21592 &_.forward_& files).
21595 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
21596 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21597 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21598 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21599 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
21602 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
21603 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21604 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21605 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
21606 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
21607 of the embedded Perl support.
21610 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
21611 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21612 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21613 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21614 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
21617 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
21618 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21619 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21620 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21621 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
21624 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
21625 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21626 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21627 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
21628 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
21629 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
21630 &%one_time%& is set.
21633 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
21634 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21635 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21636 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21637 to make use of &%run%& items.
21640 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
21641 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21642 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21643 If this option is true, items of the form
21645 :include:<path name>
21647 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
21650 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
21651 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21652 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21653 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
21654 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
21655 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
21656 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
21659 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
21660 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21661 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21662 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
21663 &%allow_filter%& is true.
21666 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21667 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
21668 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
21669 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
21670 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
21675 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
21676 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
21677 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
21678 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
21679 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
21680 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
21681 bounce may well quote the generated address.
21684 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
21686 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21687 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
21688 file did not exist.
21691 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
21693 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21694 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
21695 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
21697 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
21698 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
21699 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
21700 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
21701 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
21702 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
21703 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
21704 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
21708 .option include_directory redirect string unset
21709 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
21710 redirection list must start with this directory.
21713 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
21714 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
21715 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
21718 .option one_time redirect boolean false
21719 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
21720 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
21721 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
21722 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
21723 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
21724 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
21725 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
21726 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
21727 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
21728 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
21729 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
21730 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
21731 before they subscribed.
21733 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
21734 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
21735 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
21736 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
21739 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
21740 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
21741 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
21742 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
21744 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
21745 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
21746 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
21748 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
21751 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
21752 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
21753 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
21754 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
21755 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
21759 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
21760 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
21761 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
21762 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
21763 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
21764 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
21765 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
21766 See &%check_owner%& above.
21769 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
21770 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
21771 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
21772 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
21775 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
21776 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21777 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
21778 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
21779 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
21780 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
21781 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
21784 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
21785 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
21786 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
21787 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
21788 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
21789 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
21790 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
21791 &$qualify_recipient$&.
21793 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
21794 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
21795 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
21798 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
21799 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
21800 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
21801 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
21802 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
21803 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
21804 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
21805 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
21806 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
21807 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
21810 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
21811 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
21812 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
21813 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
21814 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
21815 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
21818 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
21819 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
21820 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
21821 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
21822 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
21823 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
21826 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
21827 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
21828 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
21829 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
21830 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
21833 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
21834 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
21835 :subaddress part of an address.
21837 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
21838 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
21839 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
21840 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
21843 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
21844 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
21845 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
21846 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
21847 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
21848 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
21849 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
21853 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
21854 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
21855 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
21856 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
21857 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
21858 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
21859 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
21860 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
21861 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
21862 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
21863 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
21864 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
21865 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
21866 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
21867 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
21868 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
21870 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
21871 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
21872 the following routers.
21874 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
21875 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
21876 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
21877 so it is passed to the following routers.
21879 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
21880 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
21881 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
21882 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
21884 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
21885 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
21886 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
21887 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
21893 file = $home/.forward
21894 file_transport = address_file
21895 pipe_transport = address_pipe
21896 reply_transport = address_reply
21899 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
21900 syntax_errors_text = \
21901 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
21902 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
21903 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
21904 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
21905 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
21906 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
21907 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
21908 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
21909 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
21910 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
21912 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
21913 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
21914 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
21919 local_part_prefix = real-
21920 transport = local_delivery
21922 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
21923 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
21925 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
21926 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
21930 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
21931 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21934 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
21935 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21936 .ecindex IIDredrou1
21937 .ecindex IIDredrou2
21944 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21945 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21947 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
21948 "Environment for local transports"
21949 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
21950 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
21951 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
21952 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
21953 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
21954 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
21955 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
21957 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
21958 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
21959 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
21960 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
21962 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
21963 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
21964 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
21965 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
21966 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
21970 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
21971 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
21972 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
21973 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
21974 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
21975 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
21976 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
21979 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
21980 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
21984 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
21986 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
21987 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
21988 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
21989 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
21994 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
21995 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
21996 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
21997 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
21998 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
21999 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
22000 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
22001 group (set by the transport). For example:
22004 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
22008 transport = group_delivery
22011 # This transport overrides the group
22013 driver = appendfile
22014 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part_data
22017 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
22018 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
22019 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
22022 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
22023 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
22024 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
22025 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
22026 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
22027 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
22029 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
22030 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
22031 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
22032 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
22033 original gid is also used.
22035 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
22036 following that is set is used:
22039 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
22041 A &%group%& setting of the router;
22043 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
22044 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
22046 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
22048 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
22049 the uid is the creator's uid;
22051 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
22054 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
22055 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
22056 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
22057 The first of the following that is set is used:
22060 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
22062 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
22064 A &%user%& setting of the router;
22066 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
22071 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
22072 &%never_users%& list.
22078 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
22079 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
22080 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
22081 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
22082 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
22083 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
22084 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
22085 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
22086 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
22087 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
22090 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
22092 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
22094 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
22096 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
22099 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
22102 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
22104 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
22108 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
22109 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
22110 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
22114 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
22115 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22116 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22117 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
22118 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
22119 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
22120 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
22121 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
22122 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
22123 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
22124 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
22125 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
22126 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
22127 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
22135 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22136 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22138 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
22139 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
22140 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
22141 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
22143 The name of a transport is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
22144 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
22148 The following generic options apply to all transports:
22151 .option body_only transports boolean false
22152 .cindex "transport" "body only"
22153 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
22154 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
22155 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
22156 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
22157 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
22158 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
22159 automatically suppress them.
22162 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
22163 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
22164 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
22165 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
22166 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
22167 logged, and delivery is deferred.
22170 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
22171 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
22172 deliveries by the transport or for any
22173 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
22174 what you are doing.
22177 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
22178 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
22179 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
22180 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
22182 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
22183 output, and Exim carries on processing.
22184 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
22185 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
22186 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
22187 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
22189 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
22190 transport and the router that called it.
22192 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
22193 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
22194 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
22195 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
22196 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
22197 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
22198 safely be resent to other recipients.
22201 .option driver transports string unset
22202 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
22203 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
22206 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
22207 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22208 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
22209 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
22210 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
22211 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
22212 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
22213 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
22214 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
22215 resent to other recipients.
22218 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
22220 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
22221 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
22224 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
22225 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
22226 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
22227 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
22228 &%user%& (see below).
22231 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
22232 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
22233 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
22234 This option specifies a list of text headers,
22235 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
22236 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
22237 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
22238 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
22239 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
22240 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
22241 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
22243 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
22244 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
22247 .option headers_only transports boolean false
22248 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
22249 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
22250 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
22251 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
22252 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
22253 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
22254 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
22257 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
22258 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
22259 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
22260 This option specifies a list of text headers,
22261 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
22262 to be removed from the message.
22263 However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
22264 Each list item is separately expanded.
22265 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
22266 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
22267 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
22269 If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
22272 Matching headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
22273 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
22276 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
22277 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
22279 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
22280 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
22281 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
22285 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
22286 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
22287 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22288 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
22289 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
22290 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
22291 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
22292 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
22295 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
22298 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
22299 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
22300 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
22301 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
22302 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
22303 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
22304 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
22305 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
22306 change envelope recipients at this time.
22309 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
22310 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
22312 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
22313 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
22314 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
22315 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
22316 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
22317 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
22318 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
22322 .option initgroups transports boolean false
22323 .cindex "additional groups"
22324 .cindex "groups" "additional"
22325 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
22326 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
22327 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
22328 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
22331 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
22332 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
22333 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
22334 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
22335 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
22336 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
22337 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
22338 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
22340 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
22341 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
22342 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
22343 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
22344 Obviously there is scope for
22345 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
22346 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
22348 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
22349 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
22350 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
22351 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
22352 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
22355 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
22356 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
22357 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
22358 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
22359 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
22360 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
22361 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
22362 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
22363 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
22364 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
22365 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
22366 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
22367 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
22372 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
22373 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
22374 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
22375 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
22376 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
22377 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
22378 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
22379 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
22382 local_part_prefix = *-
22384 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
22387 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
22389 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
22390 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
22391 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
22392 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
22393 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
22396 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
22397 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
22398 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
22399 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
22400 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
22401 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
22402 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
22403 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
22404 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
22406 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
22407 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
22408 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
22409 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
22411 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
22412 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
22413 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
22416 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
22417 .cindex "envelope sender"
22418 .cindex "envelope from"
22419 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
22420 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
22421 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
22422 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
22423 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
22424 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
22425 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
22426 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
22427 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
22429 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
22430 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
22432 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
22433 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
22434 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
22435 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
22436 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
22437 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
22438 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
22440 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
22441 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
22442 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
22443 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
22444 &%errors_to%& in a router.
22448 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
22449 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
22450 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
22451 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
22452 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
22453 have easy access to it.
22455 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
22456 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
22457 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
22458 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
22459 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
22463 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
22464 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
22467 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
22468 .cindex "shadow transport"
22469 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
22470 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
22471 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
22473 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
22474 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
22475 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
22476 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
22477 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
22478 cause a log line to be written.
22480 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
22481 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
22482 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
22483 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
22484 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
22487 ST=<shadow transport name>
22489 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
22490 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
22491 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
22492 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
22493 headers that some sites insist on.
22496 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
22497 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22498 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22499 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
22500 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
22501 individual users or via a system filter.
22502 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
22504 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
22505 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
22506 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
22507 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
22508 command must be specified as an absolute path.
22510 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
22511 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
22512 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
22513 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
22514 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
22515 &(pipe)& transports.
22517 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
22518 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
22519 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
22520 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
22521 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
22523 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
22524 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
22525 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
22526 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
22528 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
22529 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
22530 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
22531 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
22532 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
22533 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
22535 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension"
22536 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
22537 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
22538 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
22539 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
22540 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
22541 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
22542 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
22544 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22545 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
22546 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
22547 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
22548 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
22549 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
22550 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
22551 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
22552 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
22553 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
22556 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22557 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
22558 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
22559 which the message is being sent. For example:
22561 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
22562 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
22565 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
22566 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
22567 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
22569 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
22570 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
22571 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
22574 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
22576 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
22577 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
22578 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
22579 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
22580 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
22581 Exim tried to expand the first one.
22583 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
22584 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
22585 arguments. Consider this example:
22587 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22588 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22590 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
22591 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
22593 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22594 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22598 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
22599 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
22600 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
22601 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
22602 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
22603 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
22604 bounced from a transport filter.
22606 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
22607 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
22608 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
22611 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
22612 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
22613 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
22614 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
22615 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
22616 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
22617 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
22618 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
22619 becomes a temporary error.
22622 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
22623 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22624 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
22625 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
22626 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
22627 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
22628 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
22631 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
22632 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
22633 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
22635 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
22636 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
22637 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
22638 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
22640 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
22641 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
22642 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
22649 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22650 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22652 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
22654 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
22655 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
22656 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
22657 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
22658 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
22659 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
22660 copy of the message is delivered each time.
22662 .cindex "batched local delivery"
22663 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
22664 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
22665 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
22666 local transport, for example:
22669 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
22670 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
22671 recipients saves space.
22673 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
22674 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
22676 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
22677 to a scanner program or
22678 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
22682 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
22683 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
22684 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
22686 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
22687 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
22688 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
22689 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
22690 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
22691 to certain conditions:
22694 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22695 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
22696 batching is possible.
22698 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22699 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
22700 addresses with the same domain are batched.
22702 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
22703 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
22704 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
22705 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
22706 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
22709 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
22710 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
22711 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
22715 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
22716 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
22717 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
22718 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
22719 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
22720 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
22721 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
22724 escape_string = ".."
22726 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
22727 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
22728 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
22730 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22731 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
22732 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
22733 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
22734 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
22735 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
22737 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
22738 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22739 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
22740 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
22741 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
22742 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
22743 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
22744 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
22745 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
22750 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22751 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22753 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
22754 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
22755 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
22756 .cindex "directory creation"
22757 .cindex "creating directories"
22758 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
22759 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
22760 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
22761 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
22762 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
22763 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
22764 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
22765 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
22766 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
22767 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
22769 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
22770 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
22771 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
22774 .cindex "quota" "system"
22775 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
22776 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
22777 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
22779 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
22780 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
22781 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
22782 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
22784 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
22785 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
22788 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
22789 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
22790 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
22791 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
22796 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
22797 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
22798 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
22799 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
22800 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
22802 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
22803 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22804 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
22805 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
22806 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
22807 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
22808 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
22809 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
22810 operation. There are two cases:
22813 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
22814 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
22815 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
22816 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
22817 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
22818 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
22819 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
22821 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
22822 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
22823 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
22826 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
22827 .cindex appendfile "tainted data"
22828 Tainted data may not be used for a file or directory name.
22829 This means that, for instance, &$local_part$& cannot be used directly
22830 as a component of a path. It can however be used as the key for a lookup
22831 which returns a path (or component).
22835 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
22836 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
22837 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
22838 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
22843 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
22845 require "fileinto";
22846 fileinto "folder23";
22848 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
22849 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
22850 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
22851 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
22852 way of handling this requirement:
22854 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
22855 {/var/mail/$local_part_data} \
22856 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
22858 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
22862 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
22863 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
22864 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
22866 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
22867 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
22868 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
22869 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
22870 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
22871 path to the transport.
22873 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
22874 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
22879 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
22880 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
22884 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
22885 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
22886 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
22887 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
22888 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
22889 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
22890 delivery is deferred.
22893 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
22894 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22895 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22896 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
22897 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
22898 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
22899 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
22900 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
22903 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
22904 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22905 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
22906 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
22910 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
22911 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22914 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
22915 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
22916 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
22917 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
22918 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
22921 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
22922 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
22923 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
22924 process is running.
22927 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
22928 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22929 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
22930 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
22931 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
22932 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
22933 contains is significant.
22935 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
22936 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
22937 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
22938 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
22939 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
22941 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
22942 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
22943 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
22944 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
22945 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
22946 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
22948 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22949 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
22950 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22951 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22953 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
22954 .cindex "directory creation"
22955 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
22956 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
22957 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
22959 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
22960 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
22961 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
22962 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
22963 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
22967 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
22968 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
22969 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
22970 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
22971 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
22974 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
22975 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
22976 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
22977 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
22978 are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
22979 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
22980 &%file_must_exist%&.
22983 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
22984 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
22985 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
22986 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
22988 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
22989 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
22990 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
22991 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
22992 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
22995 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
22997 .vindex "&$inode$&"
22998 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
22999 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
23000 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
23002 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
23004 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
23005 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
23009 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
23010 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
23011 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
23014 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
23015 See &%check_string%& above.
23018 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
23019 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
23020 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
23021 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
23022 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
23023 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
23026 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23027 .cindex "locking files"
23028 .cindex "lock files"
23029 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
23030 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
23032 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
23033 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
23036 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part_data
23037 file = /home/$local_part_data/inbox
23040 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
23041 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
23042 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
23043 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
23044 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
23045 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
23049 .option file_format appendfile string unset
23050 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
23051 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
23052 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
23053 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
23054 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
23055 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
23056 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
23057 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
23060 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
23061 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
23063 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
23064 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
23065 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
23066 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
23067 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
23068 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
23069 delivery is deferred.
23072 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
23073 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
23074 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
23075 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
23078 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
23079 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
23080 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
23081 .cindex "locking files"
23082 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
23083 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
23084 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
23085 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
23086 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
23087 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
23088 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
23089 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
23091 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
23092 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
23093 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
23094 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
23096 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
23097 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
23100 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
23102 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
23103 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
23104 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
23106 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
23107 local deliveries because of errors of the form
23109 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
23112 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
23113 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
23114 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
23115 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
23118 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
23119 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
23120 for details of locking.
23123 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
23124 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
23125 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
23128 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
23129 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
23130 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
23133 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
23134 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
23135 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
23136 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
23137 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
23140 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
23141 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
23142 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23143 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
23144 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
23145 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
23146 external source that maintains the data.
23149 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
23150 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
23151 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23152 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
23153 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
23154 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
23155 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
23156 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
23160 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
23161 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
23162 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
23163 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
23164 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
23165 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
23166 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
23167 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
23168 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
23169 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
23172 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
23173 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
23174 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
23175 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
23176 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
23177 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
23178 calculation. The default value is:
23180 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
23182 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
23183 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
23185 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
23187 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
23189 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
23190 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
23191 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
23192 directly into that directory.
23195 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
23196 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
23197 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
23200 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
23201 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
23202 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
23205 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
23206 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23207 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
23208 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
23209 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
23210 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
23211 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
23212 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
23214 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
23215 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
23216 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
23217 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
23218 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
23219 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
23220 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
23221 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
23222 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
23223 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
23226 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
23227 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
23228 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
23229 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
23230 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
23231 below for further details.
23234 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
23235 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
23236 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
23239 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
23240 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
23241 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
23244 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
23245 .cindex "locking files"
23246 .cindex "file" "locking"
23247 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
23248 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
23249 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23250 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
23251 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
23252 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
23253 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
23255 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
23256 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
23257 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
23264 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
23265 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
23266 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
23267 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
23268 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
23269 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
23270 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
23271 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
23273 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
23274 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
23275 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
23276 append messages to it.
23279 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
23280 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23281 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23282 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
23283 in which case it is:
23285 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
23286 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
23288 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23289 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23291 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
23292 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23293 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
23294 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
23299 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23300 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23302 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
23303 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
23304 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
23305 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
23306 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
23307 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
23308 value, and this option is ignored.
23311 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
23312 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
23313 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
23314 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
23315 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
23318 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
23319 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
23320 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
23321 on users about incoming mail.
23324 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
23325 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
23326 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
23327 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
23328 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
23329 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
23330 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
23331 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
23332 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
23334 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
23335 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
23336 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
23338 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
23339 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
23340 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
23341 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
23342 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
23343 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
23345 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
23346 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
23347 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
23348 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
23349 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
23352 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
23353 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
23355 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
23357 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
23358 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
23359 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
23360 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
23361 system quota failures.
23363 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
23364 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
23365 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
23366 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
23367 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
23368 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
23369 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
23370 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
23371 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
23372 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
23375 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
23376 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
23377 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
23378 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
23379 delivery directory.
23382 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
23383 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
23384 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
23385 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
23386 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
23389 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
23390 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
23392 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
23393 See &%quota%& above.
23396 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
23397 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
23398 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
23399 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
23400 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
23401 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
23402 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
23404 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
23405 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
23406 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
23407 the file length to the filename. For example:
23409 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
23410 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
23412 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
23413 number of lines in the message.
23415 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
23416 filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
23417 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
23419 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
23421 This option should not be used when other message-handling software
23422 may duplicate messages by making hardlinks to the files. When that is done Exim
23423 will count the message size once for each filename, in contrast with the actual
23424 disk usage. When the option is not set, calculating total usage requires
23425 a system-call per file to get the size; the number of links is then available also
23426 as is used to adjust the effective size.
23429 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
23430 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
23431 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
23433 quota_warn_message = "\
23434 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
23435 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
23436 This message is automatically created \
23437 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
23438 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
23439 a warning threshold that is\n\
23440 set by the system administrator.\n"
23444 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
23445 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
23446 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
23447 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23448 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
23449 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
23450 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
23451 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
23452 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
23456 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
23458 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
23459 percent sign is ignored.
23461 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
23462 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
23463 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
23464 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
23465 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
23466 &'From:'& line, the default is:
23468 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
23470 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
23471 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
23474 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
23475 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
23479 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
23480 .cindex "envelope from"
23481 .cindex "envelope sender"
23482 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
23483 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
23484 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
23485 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
23486 for details of batch SMTP.
23489 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
23490 .cindex "carriage return"
23492 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23493 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23494 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
23495 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23497 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
23498 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
23499 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
23500 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
23501 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
23502 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23505 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23506 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
23507 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
23508 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
23509 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23510 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
23513 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
23514 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
23515 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
23516 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
23517 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
23519 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
23520 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
23521 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
23522 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
23524 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
23525 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
23526 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
23527 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
23528 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
23531 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
23532 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
23535 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
23536 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
23537 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
23538 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
23539 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
23540 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
23541 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
23543 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23544 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
23545 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
23546 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
23549 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
23550 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
23551 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
23554 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23555 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23556 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
23557 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
23558 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
23559 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
23560 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
23561 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
23562 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
23564 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23565 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
23566 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
23567 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
23572 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
23573 .cindex "appending to a file"
23574 .cindex "file" "appending"
23575 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
23578 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
23582 .cindex "directory creation"
23583 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
23584 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
23585 &%directory_mode%& option.
23588 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
23589 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
23593 .cindex "file" "locking"
23594 .cindex "locking files"
23595 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23596 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
23597 reliably over NFS, as follows:
23600 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
23601 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
23602 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
23604 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
23606 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
23607 Unlink the hitching post name.
23609 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
23610 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
23611 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
23612 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
23614 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
23615 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
23616 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
23617 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
23618 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
23619 it before trying again.
23623 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
23624 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
23625 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
23628 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
23629 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
23630 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
23631 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
23632 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
23633 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
23634 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
23635 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
23636 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
23640 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
23641 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
23642 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
23643 delivery is deferred.
23646 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
23647 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
23648 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
23652 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
23653 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
23654 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
23657 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
23658 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
23659 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
23662 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
23663 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
23664 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
23665 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
23666 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
23667 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
23668 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
23669 that prevents link following.
23672 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
23673 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
23674 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
23675 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
23676 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
23679 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
23682 .cindex "file" "locking"
23683 .cindex "locking files"
23684 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
23685 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
23686 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
23687 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
23688 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
23690 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
23692 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
23693 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
23694 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
23696 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
23697 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
23698 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
23700 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
23701 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
23702 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
23703 delivery is deferred.
23705 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
23706 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
23707 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
23708 immediately. It retries up to
23710 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
23712 times (rounded up).
23715 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
23716 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
23719 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
23720 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
23721 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23722 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
23723 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
23724 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
23725 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
23726 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
23727 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
23728 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
23730 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
23731 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
23732 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
23733 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
23734 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
23735 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
23736 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
23738 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
23739 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
23740 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
23741 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
23744 .cindex "maildir format"
23745 .cindex "mailstore format"
23746 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
23747 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
23748 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
23749 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
23750 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
23752 .cindex "directory creation"
23753 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
23754 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
23755 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
23756 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
23757 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
23758 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
23763 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
23764 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
23765 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
23766 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
23767 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
23768 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
23769 &_new_& subdirectory.
23771 In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
23772 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
23773 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
23774 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
23775 filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
23776 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
23777 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
23779 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
23780 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
23781 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
23782 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
23783 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
23784 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
23785 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
23786 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
23788 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
23789 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
23790 folders. Consider this example:
23792 maildir_format = true
23793 directory = /var/mail/$local_part_data\
23794 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
23795 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
23796 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
23798 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
23799 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
23800 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
23801 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
23802 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
23803 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
23805 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
23806 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
23807 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
23808 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
23809 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
23811 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
23812 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
23813 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
23815 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23816 .cindex "maildir++"
23817 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
23818 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
23819 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
23820 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
23821 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
23822 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
23823 amount of space used.
23825 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
23826 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
23827 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
23828 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
23829 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
23830 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
23835 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
23836 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
23837 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
23838 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
23839 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
23840 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
23843 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
23844 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
23845 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
23846 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
23847 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
23848 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
23849 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
23850 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
23851 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
23852 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
23853 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
23854 backwards compatibility).
23856 For one common implementation, you might set:
23858 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
23860 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
23862 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
23863 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
23864 &[stat()]& each message file.
23867 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
23868 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23869 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23870 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
23871 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
23872 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
23873 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
23874 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
23875 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
23877 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
23878 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
23879 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
23880 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
23881 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
23882 need to know the quota.
23884 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
23885 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
23887 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
23888 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
23889 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
23893 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
23894 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
23895 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
23896 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
23897 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
23898 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
23899 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
23900 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
23902 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
23903 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
23904 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
23905 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
23906 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
23907 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
23909 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
23910 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
23911 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
23912 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
23913 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
23914 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
23916 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
23917 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
23918 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
23919 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
23922 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
23923 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
23924 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
23925 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
23926 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
23928 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
23930 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
23931 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
23932 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
23933 .ecindex IIDapptra1
23934 .ecindex IIDapptra2
23941 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23942 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23944 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
23945 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
23946 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
23947 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
23948 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
23949 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
23950 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
23951 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
23953 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
23954 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
23955 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
23956 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
23957 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
23960 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
23961 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
23962 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
23963 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
23964 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
23966 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
23967 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
23968 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
23969 transport is run as a consequence of a
23971 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
23972 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
23973 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
23974 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
23975 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
23976 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
23978 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
23979 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
23980 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
23981 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
23983 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
23984 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
23985 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
23986 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
23987 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
23988 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
23989 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
23991 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
23992 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
23993 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
23994 the transport defers.
23995 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
23996 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
23998 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
23999 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
24000 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
24001 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
24003 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24004 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
24005 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
24006 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
24007 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
24008 problems. They are just discarded.
24012 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
24013 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
24015 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
24016 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
24017 message when the message is specified by the transport.
24020 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
24021 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
24022 when the message is specified by the transport.
24025 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
24026 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
24027 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
24028 string comes first.
24031 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
24032 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
24033 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
24036 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
24037 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
24038 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
24041 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
24042 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
24043 specified by the transport.
24046 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
24047 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
24048 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
24049 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
24052 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
24053 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
24054 the message is specified by the transport.
24057 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
24058 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
24062 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
24063 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
24064 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
24065 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
24066 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
24070 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
24071 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
24072 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
24073 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
24075 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
24076 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
24077 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
24078 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
24079 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
24080 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
24081 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
24084 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
24085 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
24086 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
24087 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
24088 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
24090 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
24091 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
24092 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
24093 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
24094 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
24095 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
24098 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
24099 See &%once%& above.
24102 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
24103 See &%once%& above.
24104 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
24107 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
24108 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
24109 specified by the transport.
24112 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
24113 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
24114 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
24115 configuration option.
24118 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
24119 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
24120 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
24121 automatic responses. For example:
24123 subject = Re: $h_subject:
24125 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
24126 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
24127 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
24128 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
24133 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
24134 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
24135 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
24136 the text comes first.
24139 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
24140 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
24141 when the message is specified by the transport.
24142 .ecindex IIDauttra1
24143 .ecindex IIDauttra2
24148 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24149 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24151 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
24152 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
24153 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
24154 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
24155 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
24156 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
24158 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
24159 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
24160 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
24161 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
24162 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
24163 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
24167 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
24168 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
24169 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
24172 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
24173 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24176 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
24177 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
24178 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
24179 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
24180 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24183 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
24184 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
24185 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
24186 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
24187 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
24188 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
24191 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
24192 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24193 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
24194 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
24195 in its response to the LHLO command.
24197 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
24198 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
24199 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
24200 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
24203 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
24204 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
24205 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
24206 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
24211 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
24215 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
24216 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
24220 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24221 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24223 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
24224 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
24225 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
24226 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
24227 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
24228 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
24229 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
24230 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
24234 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24235 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
24236 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
24237 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
24238 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
24240 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24241 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
24242 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
24243 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
24244 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
24245 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
24246 that are routed to the transport.
24248 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
24249 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
24250 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
24251 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
24252 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
24253 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
24254 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
24258 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
24259 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
24260 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
24262 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
24263 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
24264 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
24265 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
24266 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
24267 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
24268 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
24271 .cindex "tainted data" "in pipe command"
24272 .cindex pipe "tainted data"
24273 Tainted data may not be used for the command name.
24277 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
24278 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
24279 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
24280 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
24281 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
24282 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
24283 of "1" to enforce serialization.
24288 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
24289 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
24290 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
24291 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
24292 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
24293 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
24294 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
24295 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
24296 &"local delivery failed"&.
24298 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
24299 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
24300 will be sent as normal.
24302 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
24303 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
24304 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
24305 apply in this case.
24307 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
24308 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
24309 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
24310 a non-existent command may be the problem.
24312 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
24313 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
24314 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
24315 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
24316 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
24317 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
24318 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
24323 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
24324 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
24325 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
24326 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
24327 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
24330 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
24331 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
24332 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
24333 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
24335 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
24336 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
24337 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
24338 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
24339 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
24341 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
24343 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
24344 arguments. You have to write
24346 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
24348 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
24349 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
24350 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
24351 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
24352 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
24353 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
24356 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
24359 .cindex "transport" "filter"
24360 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24361 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24362 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
24363 &`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
24364 This is not a general expansion variable; the only
24365 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
24366 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
24367 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
24368 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
24369 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
24371 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, special handling takes place
24372 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
24373 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
24374 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
24375 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
24376 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
24377 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
24378 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
24380 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
24381 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
24382 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
24383 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
24384 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
24385 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
24386 control what is done with it.
24388 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
24389 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
24390 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
24391 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
24392 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
24393 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
24394 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
24395 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
24396 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
24397 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
24398 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
24402 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
24403 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
24404 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
24405 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
24406 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
24407 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
24408 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
24409 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
24411 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
24412 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
24413 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
24414 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
24415 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
24416 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
24417 &`LOGNAME `& see below
24418 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
24419 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
24420 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
24421 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
24422 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
24423 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
24424 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
24425 &`USER `& see below
24427 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
24428 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
24429 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
24430 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
24431 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
24432 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
24433 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
24436 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
24437 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
24438 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
24442 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
24443 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
24444 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
24445 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
24448 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
24449 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
24453 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
24454 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
24455 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
24456 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
24457 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
24458 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
24459 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
24460 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
24461 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
24462 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
24463 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
24466 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
24468 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
24469 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
24470 &%use_shell%& is set.
24473 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
24474 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24477 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
24478 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
24479 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24482 .option check_string pipe string unset
24483 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
24484 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
24485 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
24486 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
24487 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
24488 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
24489 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
24493 .option command pipe string&!! unset
24494 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
24495 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
24496 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
24497 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
24498 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
24499 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
24502 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
24503 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
24504 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
24505 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
24506 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
24507 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
24508 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
24511 .option escape_string pipe string unset
24512 See &%check_string%& above.
24515 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
24516 .cindex "exec failure"
24517 .cindex "failure of exec"
24518 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
24519 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
24520 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
24521 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
24522 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
24525 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
24526 .cindex "signal exit"
24527 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
24528 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
24529 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
24530 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
24533 .option force_command pipe boolean false
24534 .cindex "force command"
24535 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
24536 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
24537 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
24538 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
24539 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
24540 command. For example:
24542 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
24546 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
24547 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
24548 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
24551 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
24552 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
24553 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
24554 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
24555 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
24556 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
24558 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
24559 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
24562 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
24563 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
24564 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
24565 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
24566 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
24567 written to the main log.
24570 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
24571 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
24572 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
24573 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
24574 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
24575 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
24579 .option log_output pipe boolean false
24580 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
24581 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
24582 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
24583 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24586 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
24587 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
24588 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
24589 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
24590 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
24591 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
24592 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
24593 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
24596 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
24597 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
24598 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
24601 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
24605 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
24606 .cindex "&""From""& line"
24607 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
24608 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
24609 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
24614 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24615 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
24618 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
24619 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
24620 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
24621 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
24625 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24626 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
24629 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
24630 This option is expanded and
24631 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
24632 variable of the subprocess.
24633 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
24634 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
24635 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
24638 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
24639 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
24640 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
24641 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
24642 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
24643 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
24644 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
24645 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
24646 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
24649 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
24650 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
24651 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
24652 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
24653 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
24654 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
24655 accept the message is used.
24658 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
24659 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
24660 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
24661 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
24662 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
24663 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
24666 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
24667 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
24668 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
24669 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
24670 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
24671 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
24672 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24676 .option return_output pipe boolean false
24677 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
24678 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
24679 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
24680 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
24681 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
24682 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
24683 of them may be set.
24687 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
24688 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
24689 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
24690 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
24691 and &%return_output%& is not set,
24692 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
24693 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
24694 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
24695 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
24696 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
24697 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
24698 and 73, respectively.
24701 .option timeout pipe time 1h
24702 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
24703 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
24704 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
24705 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
24706 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
24707 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
24709 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
24710 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
24711 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
24712 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
24713 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
24714 delivery to be deferred.
24716 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
24717 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
24720 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
24721 .cindex "envelope sender"
24722 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
24723 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
24724 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
24725 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
24726 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
24728 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
24729 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
24730 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
24731 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
24732 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
24733 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
24737 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
24738 .cindex "carriage return"
24740 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
24741 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
24742 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
24743 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
24745 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
24746 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
24747 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
24748 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
24749 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
24752 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
24753 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24754 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
24755 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
24756 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
24757 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
24758 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
24759 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
24760 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
24765 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
24766 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
24767 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
24768 .cindex "external local delivery"
24769 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
24770 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
24771 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
24772 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
24773 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
24774 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
24775 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
24776 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
24777 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
24778 configuration for &%procmail%&:
24783 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part_data
24787 check_string = "From "
24788 escape_string = ">From "
24790 user = $local_part_data
24797 transport = procmail_pipe
24799 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
24800 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
24801 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
24802 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
24803 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
24804 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
24806 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
24810 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
24811 use a shell to run pipe commands.
24814 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
24815 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
24818 local_delivery_cyrus:
24820 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
24821 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
24833 local_part_suffix = .*
24834 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
24836 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
24837 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
24839 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
24840 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
24843 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24844 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24846 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
24847 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
24848 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
24849 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
24850 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
24851 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
24852 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
24853 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
24856 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
24857 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
24861 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
24862 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
24863 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
24864 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
24865 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
24866 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
24867 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
24869 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
24870 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
24871 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
24872 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
24873 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
24874 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
24879 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
24880 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
24881 no further messages are sent over that connection.
24885 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
24887 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24888 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
24889 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
24890 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
24891 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
24892 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
24893 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
24894 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
24897 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
24898 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
24899 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24900 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24901 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
24902 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
24903 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
24904 are the values that were set when the message was received.
24905 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
24906 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
24907 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
24908 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
24909 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
24910 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
24912 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
24913 and will be removed in a future release.
24916 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
24917 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
24918 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
24921 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
24922 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
24923 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
24924 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
24925 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
24926 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
24927 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
24928 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
24930 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
24931 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
24932 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24933 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
24934 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
24935 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
24936 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
24937 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
24938 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
24941 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
24943 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
24944 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
24945 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
24946 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
24947 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
24950 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
24951 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
24952 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
24953 particular connection.
24955 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
24956 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
24957 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
24958 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
24960 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
24961 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
24962 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
24964 authenticated_sender = $local_part
24966 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
24967 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
24969 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
24970 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
24974 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
24975 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
24976 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
24977 authenticated as a client.
24980 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
24981 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
24982 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
24983 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
24986 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
24987 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
24988 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
24989 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
24990 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
24991 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
24992 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
24995 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
24996 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
24997 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
24998 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24999 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
25000 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
25001 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
25005 .option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
25006 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
25007 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
25008 .cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
25009 This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
25010 where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
25011 If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
25012 Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
25013 configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
25014 been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
25015 TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
25016 counter-intuitively decreasing it.
25017 If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
25018 be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
25021 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
25022 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
25023 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
25024 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
25027 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
25028 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25029 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
25030 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25031 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
25032 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25033 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
25034 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25035 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
25036 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25037 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
25038 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25039 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
25040 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25041 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
25042 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25043 .option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
25044 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25047 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
25048 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
25049 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
25050 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
25051 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
25054 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
25055 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
25056 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
25057 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
25058 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
25059 unhappy at this prospect, so...
25061 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25062 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
25063 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25064 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
25065 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
25066 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
25067 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
25068 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
25072 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
25073 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
25074 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
25075 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
25076 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
25079 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
25080 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
25081 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
25082 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
25086 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" *
25087 .cindex "MX record" "security"
25088 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
25089 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
25090 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
25091 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
25092 the dnssec request bit set. Setting this transport option is only useful if the
25093 transport overrides or sets the host names. See the &%dnssec_request_domains%&
25098 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
25099 .cindex "MX record" "security"
25100 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
25101 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
25102 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
25103 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
25104 the dnssec request bit set. Setting this transport option is only
25105 useful if the transport overrides or sets the host names. See the
25106 &%dnssec_require_domains%& router option.
25110 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
25111 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
25112 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
25113 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
25114 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
25115 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
25116 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
25118 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
25119 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
25120 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
25121 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
25122 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
25125 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
25126 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
25127 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
25128 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
25129 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
25130 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
25131 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
25132 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
25134 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
25135 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
25136 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
25137 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
25138 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
25139 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
25141 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
25142 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
25143 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
25144 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
25145 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
25147 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
25148 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
25149 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
25150 copy of the message is sent.
25152 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
25153 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
25154 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
25155 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
25159 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
25160 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
25161 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
25164 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
25165 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
25166 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
25167 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
25168 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
25169 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
25171 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
25172 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
25173 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
25174 implementations of TLS.
25176 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
25177 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
25178 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
25179 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
25180 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
25181 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
25182 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
25187 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
25188 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
25189 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
25190 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
25191 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
25192 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
25193 interface address, you could use this:
25195 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
25196 {$primary_hostname}}
25198 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
25201 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
25202 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
25203 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
25204 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
25205 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
25206 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
25208 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
25209 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
25210 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
25211 &%hosts_override%& is set.
25213 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
25214 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
25215 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
25216 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
25217 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
25218 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
25219 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
25221 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
25222 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
25223 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
25224 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
25225 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
25226 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
25227 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
25230 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
25231 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
25234 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
25235 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
25236 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
25237 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
25238 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
25239 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
25240 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
25241 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
25242 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
25243 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
25246 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
25247 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
25248 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
25249 Exim will not use the ESMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
25250 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
25252 .option hosts_pipe_connect smtp "host list&!!" unset
25253 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
25254 .cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
25255 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
25256 this option controls which to hosts the facility watched for
25257 and recorded, and used for subsequent connections.
25259 The retry hints database is used for the record,
25260 and records are subject to the &%retry_data_expire%& option.
25261 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
25262 It also turns SMTP into a client-first protocol
25263 so combines well with TCP Fast Open.
25265 See also the &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& main option.
25268 When the facility is used, the transport &%helo_data%& option
25269 will be expanded before the &$sending_ip_address$& variable
25271 A check is made for the use of that variable, without the
25272 presence of a &"def:"& test on it, but suitably complex coding
25273 can avoid the check and produce unexpected results.
25274 You have been warned.
25277 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25278 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
25279 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
25280 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25282 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25283 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
25284 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
25285 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
25286 to any host that matches this list.
25289 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
25290 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25291 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
25292 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
25293 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
25294 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
25295 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
25296 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
25299 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
25300 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
25301 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
25306 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25307 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
25308 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25309 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25310 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
25311 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
25312 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
25313 explanation of when this might be needed.
25315 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25316 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
25317 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25318 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25319 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
25320 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
25321 message on the same session.
25323 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
25324 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
25325 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
25326 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
25327 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
25328 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
25333 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
25334 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
25335 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
25336 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
25337 &%fallback_hosts%&.
25340 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
25341 .cindex "randomized host list"
25342 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
25343 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
25344 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
25345 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
25346 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
25347 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
25348 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
25349 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
25351 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
25352 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
25353 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
25354 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
25356 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
25358 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
25359 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
25360 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
25362 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
25363 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
25364 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
25365 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
25366 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
25367 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
25368 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
25369 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
25370 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
25373 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
25374 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25375 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
25376 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
25377 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
25379 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
25380 .cindex DANE "transport options"
25381 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
25382 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
25383 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
25384 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made. See
25385 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
25386 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
25387 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
25389 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
25390 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25391 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
25392 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
25393 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
25395 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25396 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25397 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
25398 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25399 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
25400 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
25402 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
25403 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
25404 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25405 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
25406 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
25407 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
25408 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
25410 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
25411 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
25412 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
25413 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
25414 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25415 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
25417 Unless DKIM signing is being done,
25419 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
25421 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" *
25422 .cindex DANE "transport options"
25423 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
25425 If built with DANE support, Exim will look up a
25426 TLSA record for any host matching the list,
25427 If one is found and that lookup was DNSSEC-validated,
25428 then Exim requires that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made for that host;
25429 there will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
25431 See the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
25432 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
25434 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" *
25435 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
25436 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
25437 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
25438 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
25439 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
25440 perform a TCP Fast Open.
25441 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
25442 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
25443 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
25445 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
25446 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
25448 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
25449 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
25450 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
25451 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
25452 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
25454 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
25455 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
25456 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PRDR
25457 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25458 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
25459 for multi-recipient messages.
25460 The option can usually be left as default.
25462 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
25463 .cindex "bind IP address"
25464 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
25466 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25467 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
25468 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
25469 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
25470 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
25471 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
25472 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
25473 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
25476 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
25477 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
25478 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
25479 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
25480 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
25481 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
25484 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
25486 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
25487 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
25488 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
25489 interface to use if the host has more than one.
25492 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
25493 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
25494 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
25495 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
25496 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
25497 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
25498 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
25499 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
25500 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
25501 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
25505 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
25506 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
25507 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
25508 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
25509 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
25511 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
25512 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
25513 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
25514 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
25515 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
25519 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
25520 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25521 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
25522 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
25523 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
25524 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
25525 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
25526 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
25528 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
25529 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
25530 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
25532 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
25533 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
25534 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
25535 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
25536 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
25537 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
25538 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
25539 variable that contains an outgoing port.
25541 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
25542 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
25544 but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
25545 and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
25546 If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
25549 Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
25550 to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
25554 .option protocol smtp string smtp
25555 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
25556 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
25557 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
25559 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
25560 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
25561 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
25562 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
25563 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
25565 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
25566 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
25567 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
25568 The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
25569 but as of RFC 8314 it is perferred over STARTTLS for message submission
25570 (as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
25573 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
25574 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
25575 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
25576 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
25577 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
25578 addresses is not affected.
25580 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
25581 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
25582 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
25583 Exim to use only the host name.
25584 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
25587 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25588 .cindex "serializing connections"
25589 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
25590 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
25591 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
25592 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
25593 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
25594 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
25595 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
25597 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
25598 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
25599 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
25600 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
25601 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
25602 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
25604 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
25605 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
25606 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
25607 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
25608 are used for ETRN serialization.
25610 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
25613 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
25614 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension"
25615 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
25616 .cindex "size" "of message"
25617 .cindex "transport" "filter"
25618 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
25619 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
25620 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
25621 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
25622 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
25623 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
25624 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
25626 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
25627 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
25630 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
25631 .cindex proxy SOCKS
25632 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
25633 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
25636 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
25637 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
25638 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
25640 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25641 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25642 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
25643 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
25644 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
25647 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
25648 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
25649 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
25650 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
25654 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
25655 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
25656 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
25657 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
25658 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
25661 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
25662 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
25663 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
25664 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
25665 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
25666 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
25669 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
25672 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
25673 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
25675 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25676 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25677 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
25678 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
25679 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25680 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
25681 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
25682 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25685 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
25686 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
25687 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
25689 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25690 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
25691 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
25692 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
25693 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25694 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
25695 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
25696 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
25697 ciphers is a preference order.
25701 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
25702 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
25703 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
25704 If this option is set
25706 and the connection is not DANE-validated
25708 then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
25709 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
25710 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
25711 certificate and private key for the session.
25713 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
25715 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
25721 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
25722 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
25723 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
25724 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
25725 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
25726 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
25727 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
25728 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
25729 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25730 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25734 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
25735 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25736 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25737 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25738 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
25739 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25740 Note that unless the host is in this list
25741 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
25742 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
25743 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
25744 certificate verification succeeds.
25747 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
25748 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
25749 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25750 This option give a list of hosts for which,
25751 while verifying the server certificate,
25752 checks will be included on the host name
25753 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
25754 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
25755 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
25757 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
25760 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
25761 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25762 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25764 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25765 The value of this option must be either the
25767 or the absolute path to
25768 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
25769 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
25771 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
25772 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
25773 is taken as empty and an explicit location
25776 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
25777 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
25779 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
25781 either by file or directory
25782 are added to those given by the system default location.
25784 The values of &$host$& and
25785 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25786 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25788 For back-compatibility,
25789 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
25790 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
25791 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
25794 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25795 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25796 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25797 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25798 certificate verification must succeed.
25799 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25800 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
25801 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
25803 .option utf8_downconvert smtp integer&!! -1
25804 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
25805 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
25806 If built with internationalization support,
25807 this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message envelope addresses
25809 If, after expansion, the value is 1, 0, or -1 then this value overrides
25810 any value previously set for the message. Otherwise, any previously
25811 set value is used. To permit use of a previous value,
25812 set this option to an empty string.
25813 For details on the values see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
25818 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
25820 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25821 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
25822 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
25823 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
25824 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
25827 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
25828 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
25829 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
25830 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
25833 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
25834 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
25835 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
25837 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
25838 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
25839 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
25840 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
25841 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
25843 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
25844 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
25845 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
25846 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
25847 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
25848 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
25849 see below for an exception).
25851 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
25852 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
25853 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
25854 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
25855 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
25857 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
25858 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
25859 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
25860 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
25861 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
25862 reached their retry times.
25864 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
25865 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
25866 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
25867 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
25868 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
25869 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
25870 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
25871 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
25872 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
25873 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
25876 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
25877 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
25878 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
25879 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
25880 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
25881 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
25883 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
25884 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
25885 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
25886 possible IP addresses have been tried.
25887 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
25888 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
25894 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25895 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25897 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
25898 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
25899 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
25900 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
25901 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
25902 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
25904 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
25905 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
25906 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
25907 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
25908 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
25909 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
25910 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
25912 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
25913 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
25914 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
25915 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
25918 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
25919 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
25920 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
25921 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
25923 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
25924 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
25925 facility; you do not have to use it.
25927 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
25928 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
25929 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
25930 address to which it applies.
25932 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
25933 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
25934 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
25935 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
25936 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
25937 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
25940 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
25941 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
25942 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
25943 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
25946 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
25947 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
25948 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
25949 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
25950 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
25953 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
25954 illustrated by these examples:
25957 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
25958 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
25959 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
25960 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
25962 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
25963 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
25968 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
25969 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
25970 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
25971 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
25972 message's processing.
25974 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25975 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
25976 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
25977 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
25978 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
25979 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
25980 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
25981 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
25982 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
25984 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25985 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25986 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
25987 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
25988 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
25989 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
25990 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
25991 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
25992 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
25993 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
25995 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
25996 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
25997 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
25998 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
25999 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
26000 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
26002 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
26003 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
26004 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
26006 .cindex "envelope from"
26007 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
26008 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
26009 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
26010 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
26011 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
26012 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
26013 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
26014 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
26015 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
26017 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
26018 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
26024 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
26025 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
26026 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
26027 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
26028 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
26029 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
26030 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
26031 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
26032 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
26033 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
26035 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
26037 might produce the output
26039 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26040 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26041 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26042 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26043 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26044 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26045 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26046 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26048 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
26049 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
26050 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
26051 set for a particular transport.
26054 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
26055 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
26056 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
26059 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
26061 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
26062 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
26063 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
26064 any colons must be doubled, of course).
26066 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
26067 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
26068 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
26069 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
26072 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
26073 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
26074 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
26076 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
26077 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
26078 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
26079 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
26080 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
26081 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
26082 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
26084 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26085 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26086 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
26087 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
26088 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
26092 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
26093 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
26096 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
26097 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
26098 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
26099 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
26100 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
26101 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
26102 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
26103 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
26104 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
26106 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
26107 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
26108 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
26110 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
26111 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
26112 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
26113 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
26114 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
26115 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
26116 of pattern they are set as follows:
26119 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
26120 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
26121 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
26124 *queen@*.fict.example
26126 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
26128 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
26132 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
26133 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
26136 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
26137 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
26138 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
26139 rewriting rule of the form
26141 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
26143 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
26149 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
26150 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
26151 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
26152 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
26153 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
26157 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
26158 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
26159 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
26160 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
26161 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
26163 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
26165 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
26168 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26169 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26170 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
26171 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
26172 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
26173 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
26174 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
26175 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
26176 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
26177 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
26178 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
26179 entry written to the panic log.
26183 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
26184 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
26187 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
26190 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
26192 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
26195 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
26196 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
26200 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
26202 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
26203 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
26204 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
26205 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
26206 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
26207 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
26209 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
26210 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
26211 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
26212 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
26213 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
26214 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
26215 &`h`& rewrite all headers
26216 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
26217 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
26218 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
26220 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
26221 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
26222 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
26224 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
26225 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
26228 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
26229 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
26230 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
26231 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
26232 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
26233 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
26234 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
26235 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
26236 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
26238 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26239 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26240 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
26241 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
26242 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
26243 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
26244 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
26245 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
26248 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
26249 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
26250 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
26251 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
26254 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
26255 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
26256 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
26258 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
26259 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
26260 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
26261 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
26263 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
26264 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
26265 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
26267 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
26268 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
26269 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
26270 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
26272 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
26276 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
26279 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
26280 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
26281 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
26282 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
26283 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
26284 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
26285 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
26286 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
26288 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
26289 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
26293 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
26294 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
26296 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
26297 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
26298 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
26300 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
26301 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
26302 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
26303 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
26304 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
26305 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
26306 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
26307 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
26309 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
26310 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
26312 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
26314 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
26315 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
26317 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
26318 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
26319 messages that originate outside the local host:
26321 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
26322 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
26324 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
26327 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
26328 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
26329 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
26330 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
26331 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
26332 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
26333 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
26334 components. For example, the rule
26336 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
26338 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
26339 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
26340 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
26341 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
26342 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
26343 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
26344 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
26351 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26352 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26354 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
26355 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
26356 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
26357 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
26358 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
26359 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
26360 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
26361 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
26362 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
26363 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
26364 address, domain and error.
26366 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
26367 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
26368 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
26369 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
26370 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
26371 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
26372 log selector is set, the message
26373 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
26374 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
26375 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
26376 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
26378 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
26379 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
26380 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
26381 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
26382 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
26383 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
26384 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
26385 domain are maintained independently.
26387 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
26388 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
26389 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
26390 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
26391 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
26392 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
26393 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
26394 the local address is reached.
26396 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
26397 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
26398 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
26399 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
26400 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
26402 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
26403 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
26404 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
26405 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
26406 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
26407 messages that it should now be retaining.
26411 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
26412 .cindex "retry" "rules"
26413 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
26414 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
26415 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
26416 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
26417 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
26418 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
26419 message's sender, respectively.
26422 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
26423 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
26424 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
26425 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
26426 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
26427 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
26430 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26432 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
26435 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26437 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
26438 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
26441 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
26442 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
26443 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
26444 expressions work in address lists.
26446 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
26447 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
26451 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
26452 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
26453 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
26454 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
26455 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
26456 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
26457 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
26458 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
26459 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
26461 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
26462 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
26463 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
26464 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
26467 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
26468 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
26469 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
26470 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
26471 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
26472 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
26473 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
26474 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
26475 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
26476 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
26481 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
26483 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
26484 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
26485 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
26486 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
26487 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
26488 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
26490 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
26494 and the retry rules are
26496 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
26497 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
26499 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
26500 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
26501 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
26502 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
26503 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
26504 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
26506 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
26507 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
26508 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
26509 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
26511 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
26512 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
26513 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
26515 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
26517 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
26518 textual form of the IP address.
26520 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
26521 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
26522 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
26523 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
26526 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
26527 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
26528 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
26530 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
26531 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
26532 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
26534 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
26535 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
26537 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
26538 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
26541 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
26542 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
26543 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
26544 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
26545 retry rule of this form:
26547 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
26549 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
26550 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
26553 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
26554 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
26555 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
26556 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
26559 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
26560 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
26561 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
26562 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
26563 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
26565 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
26566 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
26568 .vitem &%refused_A%&
26569 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
26572 A connection was refused.
26574 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
26575 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
26577 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
26578 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
26580 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
26581 A connection attempt timed out.
26583 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
26584 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
26585 obtained from an MX record.
26587 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
26588 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
26589 obtained from an MX record.
26592 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
26594 .vitem &%tls_required%&
26595 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
26596 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
26597 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
26600 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26603 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
26604 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
26605 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
26606 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26607 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
26608 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
26612 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
26613 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
26614 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
26615 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
26616 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
26620 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
26621 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
26622 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
26624 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
26625 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
26626 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
26627 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
26628 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
26629 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
26630 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
26632 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
26633 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
26636 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
26637 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
26638 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
26643 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
26644 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
26645 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
26646 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
26647 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
26650 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
26652 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
26654 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
26656 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
26657 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
26660 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
26662 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
26663 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
26664 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
26665 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
26666 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
26668 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
26669 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
26671 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
26673 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
26674 list is never matched.
26680 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
26681 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
26682 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
26683 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
26685 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
26687 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
26688 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
26689 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
26690 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
26691 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
26693 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
26694 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
26695 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
26696 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
26697 The available algorithms are:
26700 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
26703 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
26704 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
26705 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
26707 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
26708 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
26709 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
26710 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
26711 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
26712 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
26713 queue processing times.
26716 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
26717 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
26718 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
26719 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
26720 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
26721 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
26722 interval is found. The main configuration variable
26723 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
26724 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
26725 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
26726 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
26727 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
26729 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
26730 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
26731 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
26732 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
26733 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
26734 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
26737 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
26738 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
26739 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
26740 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
26741 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
26742 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
26743 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
26744 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
26745 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
26746 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
26747 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
26748 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
26750 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
26751 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
26752 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
26753 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
26754 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
26755 deliveries that have been deferred.
26758 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
26759 Here are some example retry rules:
26761 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
26762 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
26763 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
26764 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26765 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
26766 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
26768 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
26769 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
26770 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
26771 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
26772 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
26773 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
26774 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
26777 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
26778 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
26779 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
26780 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
26781 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
26783 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
26784 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
26785 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
26786 were not obtained from an MX record.
26788 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
26789 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
26790 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
26791 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
26792 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
26796 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
26797 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
26798 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
26799 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
26800 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
26801 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
26802 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
26803 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
26804 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
26805 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
26806 failing for the first time.
26808 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
26809 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
26810 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
26811 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
26813 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
26814 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
26815 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
26820 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
26821 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
26822 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
26823 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
26824 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
26825 default retry rule:
26827 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
26829 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
26830 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
26831 failure for the recipient address that counts.
26833 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
26834 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
26835 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
26836 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
26837 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
26839 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
26840 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
26841 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
26843 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
26844 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
26845 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
26846 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
26847 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
26848 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
26849 as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
26850 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
26851 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
26852 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
26853 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
26855 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
26856 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
26857 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
26858 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
26859 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
26862 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
26863 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
26864 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
26865 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
26866 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
26867 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
26868 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
26869 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
26870 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
26873 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
26874 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
26875 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
26876 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
26877 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
26878 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
26879 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
26880 failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
26883 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
26884 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
26885 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
26886 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
26887 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
26888 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
26889 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
26890 time out the address.
26892 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
26893 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
26894 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
26895 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
26896 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
26897 considered immediately.
26898 .ecindex IIDretconf1
26899 .ecindex IIDregconf2
26906 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26907 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26909 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
26910 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
26911 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
26912 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
26913 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
26914 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
26915 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
26916 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
26917 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
26921 The name of an authenticator is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
26922 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
26926 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
26927 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" AUTH
26928 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
26931 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
26932 the client's EHLO command.
26934 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
26935 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
26937 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
26938 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
26939 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
26940 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
26941 with the AUTH command.
26943 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
26945 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
26946 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
26947 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
26950 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
26951 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
26952 unauthenticated connection.
26955 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
26956 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
26957 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
26958 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
26960 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
26961 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
26962 &`Connected to server.example.`&
26963 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
26964 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
26965 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
26966 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
26967 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
26972 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
26973 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
26974 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
26975 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
26976 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
26977 included by setting
26980 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
26984 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
26989 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
26990 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
26991 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
26992 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
26993 work via a socket interface.
26994 The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
26995 as defined by RFC 4422 Appendix A.
26996 The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
26997 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
26998 The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
26999 supporting setting a server keytab.
27000 The seventh can be configured to support
27001 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
27002 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
27003 The eighth authenticator
27004 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
27005 The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
27006 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
27008 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
27009 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
27010 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
27011 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
27012 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
27013 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
27014 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
27016 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
27017 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
27018 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
27019 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
27020 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
27021 both sets of options, is required. For example:
27025 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27026 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
27028 client_secret = secret2
27030 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
27031 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
27033 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
27034 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
27035 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
27038 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
27039 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
27040 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
27041 authenticating data.
27043 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
27044 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
27045 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
27046 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
27047 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
27048 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
27049 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
27050 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
27051 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
27052 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
27055 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
27056 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
27057 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
27058 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
27062 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
27063 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
27064 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
27066 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27067 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
27068 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
27069 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
27070 encrypted by a setting such as:
27072 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
27076 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
27077 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
27078 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
27079 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
27082 .option driver authenticators string unset
27083 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
27084 authenticators is to be used.
27087 .option public_name authenticators string unset
27088 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
27089 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
27090 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
27091 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
27092 defaults to the driver's instance name.
27095 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27096 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
27097 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
27098 mechanism is not advertised.
27099 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
27100 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
27101 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
27104 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27105 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
27106 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
27109 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
27110 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
27112 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
27113 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
27114 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
27115 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
27116 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
27117 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
27118 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27119 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
27120 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
27124 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
27125 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
27126 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
27127 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
27128 out the values of variables.
27129 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
27130 output, and Exim carries on processing.
27133 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
27134 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27135 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
27136 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
27137 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
27138 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
27139 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
27140 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
27141 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
27142 On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
27143 the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
27144 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
27147 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27148 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
27149 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
27150 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
27151 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
27152 remembered for later use.
27153 How it is used is described in the following section.
27159 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
27160 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
27161 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
27162 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
27163 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
27167 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
27168 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
27170 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
27172 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
27173 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
27174 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
27175 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
27176 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
27177 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
27178 given for the MAIL command.
27180 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
27181 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
27184 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
27185 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
27186 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
27187 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
27188 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
27189 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
27190 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
27195 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
27196 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
27197 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
27198 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
27200 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
27201 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
27202 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
27203 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
27204 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
27209 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
27210 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
27211 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
27212 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
27216 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
27218 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
27219 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
27222 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
27223 the mechanisms are advertised.
27225 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
27226 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
27227 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
27228 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
27229 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
27230 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
27231 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
27233 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
27235 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
27237 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
27238 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
27239 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
27242 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
27244 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
27245 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
27246 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
27248 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
27249 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
27250 command. This is the case if
27253 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
27255 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
27257 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
27258 server authenticators.
27262 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
27263 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
27264 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
27266 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
27267 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
27268 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
27269 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
27270 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
27271 rejected with a 504 error.
27273 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
27274 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
27275 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
27276 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
27277 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
27278 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
27279 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
27280 no successful authentication.
27282 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
27283 Successful authentication sets up information used by the
27284 &%authresults%& expansion item.
27289 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
27290 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
27291 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
27292 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
27293 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
27294 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
27295 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
27299 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
27301 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
27302 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
27303 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
27304 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
27305 command line to run this script on such data might be
27307 encode '\0user\0password'
27309 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
27310 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
27311 whose code value is zero.
27313 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
27314 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
27315 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
27316 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
27318 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
27319 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
27320 example, a command such as
27322 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
27324 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
27326 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
27327 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
27329 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
27331 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
27332 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
27333 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
27334 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
27338 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
27339 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
27340 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
27341 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
27342 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
27343 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
27346 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
27347 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
27348 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
27349 of the authenticator.
27352 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27353 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
27354 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
27355 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
27356 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
27357 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
27358 delivery to be deferred.
27360 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
27361 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
27362 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
27365 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
27366 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
27367 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
27368 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
27369 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
27370 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
27371 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
27372 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
27373 deliver the message unauthenticated.
27376 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
27377 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
27378 upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
27379 router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
27380 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
27381 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
27382 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
27383 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
27385 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
27387 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
27388 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
27389 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
27390 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
27391 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
27392 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
27393 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
27394 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
27395 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
27396 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
27397 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
27398 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
27399 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
27406 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27407 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27409 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
27410 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
27411 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
27412 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
27413 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
27414 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
27415 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
27416 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
27417 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
27418 connections as you do for login accounts.
27420 .section "Avoiding cleartext use" "SECTplain_TLS"
27421 The following generic option settings will disable &(plaintext)& authenticators when
27422 TLS is not being used:
27424 server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
27425 client_condition = ${if def:tls_out_cipher}
27428 &*Note*&: a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not vulnerable to casual snooping,
27429 but is still vulnerable to a Man In The Middle attack unless certificates
27430 (including their names) have been properly verified.
27432 .section "Plaintext server options" "SECID171"
27433 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
27434 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
27436 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27437 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
27438 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
27440 .option server_prompts plaintext "string list&!!" unset
27441 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
27442 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
27445 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
27446 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27447 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27448 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
27449 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27450 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27451 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27453 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
27454 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
27455 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
27456 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
27457 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
27458 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
27459 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
27461 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
27462 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
27463 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
27464 string expansions that also use them for other things.
27466 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
27467 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
27468 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
27470 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27471 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
27472 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
27473 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
27474 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
27475 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27476 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
27477 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
27478 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
27479 string as the error text.
27481 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
27482 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
27483 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
27487 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
27488 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
27489 .cindex authentication PLAIN
27490 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
27491 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
27492 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
27493 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
27494 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
27496 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
27497 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
27498 configured as follows:
27502 public_name = PLAIN
27504 server_condition = \
27505 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
27506 server_set_id = $auth2
27508 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
27509 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
27510 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
27511 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
27513 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
27514 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
27515 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
27516 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
27520 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
27522 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
27524 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
27525 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
27529 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
27530 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
27532 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
27533 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
27534 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
27535 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
27536 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
27538 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
27539 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
27540 authenticating clients it could make sense.
27542 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
27543 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
27544 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
27545 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
27546 This is an incorrect example:
27548 server_condition = \
27549 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
27551 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
27552 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
27553 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
27554 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
27555 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
27556 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
27557 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
27559 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
27560 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
27562 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
27563 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
27564 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
27565 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
27566 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
27569 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
27570 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
27571 .cindex authentication LOGIN
27572 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
27573 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
27574 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
27575 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
27579 public_name = LOGIN
27580 server_prompts = User Name : Password
27581 server_condition = \
27582 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
27583 server_set_id = $auth1
27585 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
27586 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
27587 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
27588 strings are used to obtain two data items.
27590 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
27591 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
27592 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
27593 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
27594 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
27598 public_name = LOGIN
27599 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
27600 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
27603 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
27604 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
27605 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
27606 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
27608 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
27609 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
27610 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
27611 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
27612 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
27613 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
27614 uninterpreted string.
27617 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
27618 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
27619 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
27620 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
27621 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
27627 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
27628 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
27629 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
27631 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
27632 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
27633 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
27634 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
27637 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
27638 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
27639 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
27640 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
27641 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
27642 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
27643 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
27644 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
27645 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
27646 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
27647 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
27648 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
27650 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
27651 splitting takes priority and happens first.
27653 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
27654 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
27655 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
27656 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
27659 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
27660 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
27664 public_name = PLAIN
27665 client_send = ^username^mysecret
27667 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
27668 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs.
27670 Note that due to the ambiguity of parsing three consectutive circumflex characters
27671 there is no way to provide a password having a leading circumflex.
27676 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
27680 public_name = LOGIN
27681 client_send = : username : mysecret
27683 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
27684 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
27686 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
27687 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
27692 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27693 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27695 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
27696 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27697 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
27698 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
27699 .cindex authentication CRAM-MD5
27700 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
27701 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
27702 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
27703 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
27704 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
27705 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
27706 available in plain text at either end.
27709 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
27710 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
27711 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
27712 authenticator as a server:
27714 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27715 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27716 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
27717 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
27718 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
27719 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
27720 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
27721 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
27722 returned to the client.
27724 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
27725 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
27726 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
27727 numeric variables for other things.
27729 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
27730 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
27731 user name, authentication fails.
27735 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27736 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
27737 server_set_id = $auth1
27739 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27740 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
27741 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
27742 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
27746 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27747 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
27749 server_set_id = $auth1
27751 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
27752 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
27754 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
27755 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
27756 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
27761 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27762 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
27763 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27764 server_set_id = $auth1
27767 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
27768 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
27769 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
27773 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
27774 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
27775 computing the response to the server's challenge.
27778 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27779 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
27780 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
27784 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27785 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
27786 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
27787 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
27788 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
27789 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
27790 send the message to the current server.
27792 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
27797 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27799 client_secret = secret
27801 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
27802 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
27806 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27807 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27809 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
27810 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
27811 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
27812 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
27814 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
27815 at A L Digital Ltd.
27817 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
27818 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
27819 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
27820 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
27821 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
27823 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
27824 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
27825 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
27826 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
27828 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
27829 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
27830 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
27831 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
27832 depending on the driver you are using.
27834 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
27835 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
27836 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
27837 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
27838 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
27841 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
27842 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
27843 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
27844 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
27845 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
27846 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
27847 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
27848 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
27851 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
27852 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
27853 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
27854 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
27855 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
27856 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
27860 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
27861 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27862 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
27863 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
27866 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
27867 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27868 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27869 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27873 driver = cyrus_sasl
27874 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27875 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27876 server_set_id = $auth1
27879 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
27880 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27883 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
27884 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27887 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
27888 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
27889 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
27890 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
27893 driver = cyrus_sasl
27894 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27895 server_set_id = $auth1
27898 driver = cyrus_sasl
27899 public_name = PLAIN
27900 server_set_id = $auth2
27902 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
27903 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
27904 but it is present in many binary distributions.
27905 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
27906 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
27911 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27912 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27913 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
27914 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
27915 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
27916 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
27917 Dovecot 2 POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
27918 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
27919 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
27920 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
27921 authenticator only. There is only one option:
27923 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
27925 This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
27926 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
27927 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
27928 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
27932 public_name = PLAIN
27933 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27934 server_set_id = $auth1
27939 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27940 server_set_id = $auth1
27942 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
27943 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
27944 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
27945 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
27946 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
27947 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
27950 The Dovecot configuration to match the above wil look
27953 conf.d/10-master.conf :-
27958 unix_listener auth-client {
27965 conf.d/10-auth.conf :-
27967 auth_mechanisms = plain login ntlm
27971 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
27972 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
27975 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27976 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27977 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
27978 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
27979 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
27980 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
27981 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
27982 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27983 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27984 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
27985 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
27986 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
27987 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
27988 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM family"
27989 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides integration for the GNU SASL
27990 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
27991 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
27992 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
27993 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
27994 without code changes in Exim.
27997 The library is expected to add support in an upcoming
27998 realease for the SCRAM-SHA-256 method.
27999 The macro _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_SHA_256 will be defined
28003 .option client_authz gsasl string&!! unset
28004 This option can be used to supply an &'authorization id'&
28005 which is different to the &'authentication_id'& provided
28006 by &%client_username%& option.
28007 If unset or (after expansion) empty it is not used,
28008 which is the common case.
28010 .option client_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
28011 See &%server_channelbinding%& below.
28013 .option client_password gsasl string&!! unset
28014 This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
28015 the password to be used, in clear.
28017 .option client_username gsasl string&!! unset
28018 This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
28019 the account name to be used.
28023 .option client_spassword gsasl string&!! unset
28024 If a SCRAM mechanism is being used and this option is set
28025 it is used in preference to &%client_password%&.
28026 The value after expansion should be
28027 a 40 (for SHA-1) or 64 (for SHA-256) character string
28028 with the PBKDF2-prepared password, hex-encoded.
28029 Note that this value will depend on the salt and iteration-count
28030 supplied by the server.
28035 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
28036 Do not set this true and rely on the properties
28037 without consulting a cryptographic engineer.
28039 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
28040 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
28041 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
28042 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
28045 This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
28046 non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
28047 server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
28051 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
28052 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
28053 When using this feature the "-PLUS" variants of the method names need to be used.
28056 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
28057 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
28058 of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
28060 However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be vulnerable in current versions.
28061 Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
28062 with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
28065 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
28066 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
28067 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
28068 Some mechanisms will use this data.
28071 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
28072 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
28073 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
28074 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
28079 public_name = X-ANYTHING
28080 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
28081 server_set_id = $auth1
28085 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
28086 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
28087 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
28088 the password itself.
28090 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
28091 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
28092 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
28093 if available, else the empty string.
28094 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
28095 else the empty string.
28097 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
28099 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
28100 option to be simply "true".
28103 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
28104 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
28105 Some mechanisms will use this data.
28108 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! 4096
28109 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
28111 The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
28112 when this option is expanded.
28114 The result of expansion should be a decimal number,
28115 and represents both a lower-bound on the security, and
28116 a compute cost factor imposed on the client
28117 (if it does not cache results, or the server changes
28118 either the iteration count or the salt).
28119 A minimum value of 4096 is required by the standards
28120 for all current SCRAM mechanism variants.
28123 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
28124 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
28126 The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
28127 when this option is expanded.
28128 The value should be a base64-encoded string,
28129 of random data typically 4-to-16 bytes long.
28130 If unset or empty after expansion the library will provides a value for the
28131 protocol conversation.
28136 .option server_key gsasl string&!! unset
28137 .option server_skey gsasl string&!! unset
28138 These options can be used for the SCRAM family of mechanisms
28139 to provide stored information related to a password,
28140 the storage of which is preferable to plaintext.
28142 &%server_key%& is the value defined in the SCRAM standards as ServerKey;
28143 &%server_skey%& is StoredKey.
28145 They are only available for version 1.9.0 (or later) of the gsasl library.
28146 When this is so, the macros
28147 _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_GSASL_SERVER_KEY
28148 and _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_S_KEY
28151 The &$authN$& variables are available when these options are expanded.
28153 If set, the results of expansion should for each
28154 should be a 28 (for SHA-1) or 44 (for SHA-256) character string
28155 of base64-coded data, and will be used in preference to the
28156 &%server_password%& option.
28157 If unset or not of the right length, &%server_password%& will be used.
28159 The libgsasl library release includes a utility &'gsasl'& which can be used
28160 to generate these values.
28164 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
28165 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
28166 Some mechanisms will use this data.
28169 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
28170 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28171 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
28172 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
28174 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
28175 meanings for these variables:
28178 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
28179 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
28181 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
28182 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
28184 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
28185 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
28188 On a per-mechanism basis:
28191 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
28192 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
28193 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
28195 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
28196 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
28197 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
28199 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
28200 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
28201 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
28202 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
28205 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
28206 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
28207 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
28210 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
28211 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
28213 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
28215 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28216 server_realm = imap.example.org
28217 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
28218 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
28219 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
28220 server_condition = yes
28224 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28225 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28227 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
28228 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
28229 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
28230 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
28231 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
28232 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
28233 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
28236 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
28237 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
28238 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
28239 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
28241 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
28242 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
28243 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
28244 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
28246 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
28247 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
28248 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
28252 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
28253 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
28254 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
28255 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
28257 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
28258 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
28259 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
28260 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
28262 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28264 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
28265 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
28267 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
28268 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
28269 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
28274 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28275 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28277 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
28278 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
28279 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
28280 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
28281 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
28282 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
28283 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
28284 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
28285 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
28286 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
28287 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
28288 taken from the Samba project (&url(https://www.samba.org/)). The code for the
28289 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
28293 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
28294 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
28296 The server sends back a challenge.
28298 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
28299 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
28302 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
28306 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
28307 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
28308 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
28310 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
28311 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
28312 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
28313 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
28314 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
28315 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
28316 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
28317 for other things. For example:
28322 server_password = \
28323 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
28325 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
28326 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
28332 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
28333 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
28334 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
28338 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
28339 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
28342 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
28343 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
28346 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
28347 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
28348 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
28354 client_username = msn/msn_username
28355 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
28356 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
28358 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
28359 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
28365 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28366 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28368 .chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
28369 .scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
28370 .scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
28371 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
28372 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
28373 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
28374 The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
28375 authentication based on non-SMTP information.
28376 The specification is in RFC 4422 Appendix A
28377 (&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422)).
28378 It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
28379 the process of authentication is entirely controlled
28380 by the server configuration.
28382 The client presents an identity in-clear.
28383 It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
28384 and for clients to only attempt,
28385 this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
28387 One possible use, compatible with the
28388 K-9 Mail Andoid client (&url(https://k9mail.github.io/)),
28389 is for using X509 client certificates.
28391 It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
28392 (see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
28393 but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
28394 rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
28395 client certificates only.
28397 The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
28398 client-certificate authentication is being done.
28400 The client must present a certificate,
28401 for which it must have been requested via the
28402 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
28403 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
28404 For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
28405 verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
28407 .section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
28408 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
28409 The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
28411 .option server_param2 external string&!! unset
28412 .option server_param3 external string&!! unset
28413 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
28414 These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
28415 and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
28416 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
28417 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
28419 They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
28421 .section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
28422 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
28423 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
28424 "in &(external)& authenticator"
28425 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28426 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
28428 When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
28429 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
28430 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
28431 values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
28432 an identity for authentication and
28433 placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
28435 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
28436 the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
28437 variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
28438 string expansions that also use them for other things.
28440 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
28441 Once an identity has been received,
28442 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
28443 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
28444 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
28445 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
28446 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
28447 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
28448 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
28449 string as the error text.
28453 ext_ccert_san_mail:
28455 public_name = EXTERNAL
28457 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
28458 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
28459 {$tls_in_peercert}}
28460 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
28461 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
28462 server_set_id = $auth1
28464 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
28465 of your configured trust-anchors
28466 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
28467 and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
28469 &*Note*&: up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN.
28470 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
28471 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
28475 .section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
28476 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
28477 The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
28479 .option client_send external string&!! unset
28480 This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
28481 identity being asserted.
28487 public_name = EXTERNAL
28489 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
28490 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
28494 .ecindex IIDexternauth1
28495 .ecindex IIDexternauth2
28501 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28502 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28504 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
28505 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
28506 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
28507 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
28508 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
28509 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
28510 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
28511 authentication based on client certificates.
28513 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
28514 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
28515 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
28516 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
28517 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
28518 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
28520 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
28521 for which it must have been requested via the
28522 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
28523 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
28525 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
28526 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
28527 and can authenticate the connection.
28528 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
28530 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
28533 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
28534 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
28536 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
28537 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
28538 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
28539 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
28540 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
28541 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
28543 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
28544 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
28545 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
28547 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
28554 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
28555 {$tls_in_peercert}}
28556 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
28559 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
28560 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
28561 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
28563 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
28565 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
28566 of your configured trust-anchors
28567 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
28568 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
28570 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
28571 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
28572 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
28574 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
28576 . An alternative might use
28578 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
28580 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
28581 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
28582 . This would help for per-device use.
28584 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
28585 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
28587 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
28588 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
28591 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
28592 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
28593 a connect- or helo-ACL.
28597 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28598 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28600 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
28601 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
28602 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
28603 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
28604 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
28607 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
28608 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
28609 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
28610 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
28611 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
28612 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
28613 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
28614 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
28615 certificates are used.
28617 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
28618 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
28619 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
28620 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
28621 between them is encrypted.
28623 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
28624 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
28625 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
28626 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
28629 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
28630 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
28631 in order to get TLS to work.
28635 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
28637 .cindex "submissions protocol"
28638 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
28639 .cindex "smtps protocol"
28640 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
28641 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
28642 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
28643 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
28644 contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
28645 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
28646 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
28647 by them in preference to STARTTLS.
28649 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
28650 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
28651 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
28653 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
28654 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
28655 reassigned for other use.
28656 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
28658 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
28659 not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
28660 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
28662 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
28663 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
28664 the most common use is expected to be:
28666 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
28668 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
28669 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
28670 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
28671 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
28672 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
28675 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
28676 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
28683 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
28684 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
28685 TLS is supported in Exim using either the OpenSSL or GnuTLS library.
28686 To build Exim to use OpenSSL you need to set
28692 To build Exim to use GnuTLS, you need to set
28698 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
28699 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
28701 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
28704 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
28705 cannot be the path of a directory
28706 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
28707 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
28709 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
28711 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28712 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
28713 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
28714 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
28715 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
28717 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
28718 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
28719 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
28720 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
28721 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
28722 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
28723 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
28726 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
28727 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
28729 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
28730 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
28731 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
28732 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
28734 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
28735 main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
28737 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
28738 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
28739 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
28740 implementation, then patches are welcome.
28743 The output from "exim -bV" will show which (if any) support was included
28745 Also, the macro "_HAVE_OPENSSL" or "_HAVE_GNUTLS" will be defined.
28750 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
28751 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
28752 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
28753 but not the chosen filename.
28754 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
28755 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
28757 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
28758 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
28759 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
28760 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
28762 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
28763 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
28764 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
28765 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
28766 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
28767 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
28768 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
28770 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
28771 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
28772 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
28773 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
28774 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
28776 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
28777 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
28778 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
28779 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
28780 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
28781 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
28783 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
28784 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
28785 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
28787 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
28788 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
28789 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
28790 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
28793 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
28796 # chown exim:exim new-params
28797 # chmod 0600 new-params
28798 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
28799 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
28800 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
28801 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
28802 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
28803 # chmod 0400 new-params
28804 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
28806 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
28807 stalling is removed.
28809 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
28810 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
28811 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
28812 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
28813 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
28814 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
28815 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
28816 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
28817 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
28818 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
28819 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
28821 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
28822 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
28823 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
28824 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
28826 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
28827 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
28828 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
28829 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
28830 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
28833 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
28834 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
28835 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
28836 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
28837 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
28838 are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
28839 The list is colon separated and may contain names like
28840 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
28841 directly to this function call.
28842 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
28843 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
28844 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
28845 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
28848 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
28850 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
28851 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
28852 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
28855 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
28856 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
28857 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
28861 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
28864 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
28865 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
28868 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
28869 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
28871 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
28872 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
28875 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
28876 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
28877 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
28878 not be moved to the end of the list.
28881 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
28884 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
28885 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
28888 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28889 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
28890 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
28891 choice of clients used:
28893 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
28894 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28899 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
28901 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
28904 For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
28905 and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
28906 The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
28907 TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
28909 As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
28911 TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
28915 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
28917 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
28918 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
28919 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
28920 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
28921 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
28922 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
28923 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
28924 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
28925 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
28926 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
28928 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
28929 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
28931 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
28932 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
28933 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
28934 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
28935 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
28936 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
28938 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
28939 "Priority strings". This is online as
28940 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
28941 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
28942 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
28943 then the example code
28944 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
28945 on that site can be used to test a given string.
28949 # Disable older versions of protocols
28950 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
28953 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
28954 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
28955 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
28957 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28958 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
28959 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
28960 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
28964 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28970 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
28971 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
28972 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
28973 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
28974 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
28975 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
28976 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
28977 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
28979 If STARTTLS is to be used you
28980 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
28982 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
28983 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
28984 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
28987 554 Security failure
28989 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
28990 rejected with a 554 error code.
28992 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
28993 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
28995 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
28996 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
28997 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
28998 from someone able to intercept the communication.
29000 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
29002 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
29004 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
29005 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
29007 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
29008 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
29009 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
29010 that goes with it. These files need to be
29011 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
29012 always be given as full path names.
29013 The key must not be password-protected.
29014 They can be the same file if both the
29015 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
29016 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
29017 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
29018 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
29019 the server's certificate.
29021 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
29022 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
29023 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
29024 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
29025 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
29026 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
29028 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
29029 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
29030 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
29032 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
29033 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
29034 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
29037 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
29038 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
29039 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
29041 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
29043 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
29044 with the parameters contained in the file.
29045 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
29050 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
29051 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
29052 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
29053 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
29059 for a way of generating file data.
29061 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
29062 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
29063 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
29064 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
29065 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
29067 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
29068 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
29069 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
29070 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
29071 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
29072 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
29073 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
29074 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
29075 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
29077 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
29078 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
29079 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
29080 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
29081 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
29082 documentation for more details.
29084 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
29085 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
29088 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
29089 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
29090 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
29091 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
29092 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
29093 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
29094 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
29095 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
29096 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
29097 expected trust-anchors or certificates.
29098 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
29099 an explicit file or,
29100 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
29101 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
29103 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
29106 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
29107 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
29108 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
29110 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
29112 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
29114 There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
29115 Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
29117 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
29118 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
29119 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
29120 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
29121 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
29122 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
29123 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
29124 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
29125 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
29126 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
29128 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
29129 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
29130 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
29131 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
29133 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
29134 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
29135 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
29136 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
29137 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
29138 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
29141 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
29142 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
29143 .cindex "revocation list"
29144 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
29145 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
29146 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
29147 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
29148 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
29149 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
29150 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
29152 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
29153 file from every certificate authority they know of.
29155 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
29156 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
29157 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
29158 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
29159 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
29160 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
29162 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
29163 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
29164 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
29165 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
29167 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
29168 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
29169 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
29170 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
29171 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
29172 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
29173 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
29174 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
29176 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
29177 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
29178 support for OCSP stapling is included.
29180 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
29181 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
29182 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
29183 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
29184 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
29186 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
29187 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
29188 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
29189 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
29190 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
29193 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
29194 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
29197 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
29198 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
29199 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
29200 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
29201 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
29202 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
29204 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
29205 not any of the chain from CA to it.
29207 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
29210 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
29211 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
29212 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
29214 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
29215 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
29216 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
29222 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECTclientTLS"
29223 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
29224 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
29225 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
29226 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
29227 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
29228 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
29229 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
29230 within the &(smtp)& transport.
29232 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
29233 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
29234 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
29235 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
29236 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
29237 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
29239 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
29240 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
29241 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
29242 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
29243 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
29246 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
29247 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
29248 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
29249 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
29250 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
29251 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
29252 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
29253 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
29254 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
29255 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
29258 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
29259 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
29260 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
29261 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
29263 &*Note*&: Do not use a certificate which has the OCSP-must-staple extension,
29264 for client use (they are usable for server use).
29265 As the TLS protocol has no means for the client to staple before TLS 1.3 it will result
29266 in failed connections.
29268 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
29269 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
29271 the system default set (depending on library version),
29273 or (depending on library version) a directory.
29274 The client verifies the server's certificate
29275 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
29276 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
29277 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
29278 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
29280 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
29281 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
29282 or need not succeed respectively.
29284 The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
29285 name checks are made on the server certificate.
29287 The match against this list is, as per other Exim usage, the
29288 IP for the host. That is most closely associated with the
29289 name on the DNS A (or AAAA) record for the host.
29290 However, the name that needs to be in the certificate
29291 is the one at the head of any CNAME chain leading to the A record.
29293 The option defaults to always checking.
29295 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
29296 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
29297 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
29299 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
29300 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
29301 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
29304 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
29305 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
29306 for OCSP to be relevant.
29309 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
29310 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
29311 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
29312 alternative hosts, if any.
29315 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
29316 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
29317 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
29321 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
29322 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
29323 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
29324 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
29325 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
29327 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
29328 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
29329 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
29330 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
29331 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
29332 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
29333 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
29334 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
29335 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
29336 outgoing connection.
29340 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
29341 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
29342 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
29343 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
29344 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
29345 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
29346 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
29347 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
29348 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
29349 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
29352 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
29353 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
29356 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
29357 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
29358 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
29359 be of limited use in that environment.
29361 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
29362 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
29363 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
29364 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
29365 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
29367 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
29368 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
29369 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
29370 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
29371 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
29374 If DAVE validated the connection attempt then the value of the &%tls_sni%& option
29375 is forced to the domain part of the recipient address.
29378 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
29379 received from a client.
29380 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
29382 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
29383 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
29384 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
29387 &%tls_certificate%&
29393 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
29398 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
29399 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
29400 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
29401 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
29402 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI has arrived, so
29403 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
29404 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
29406 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
29409 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
29410 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
29411 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
29412 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
29414 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
29415 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
29416 built, then you have SNI support).
29420 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
29422 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
29423 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
29424 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
29425 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
29426 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
29427 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
29428 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
29429 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
29430 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
29431 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
29433 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
29434 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
29435 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
29436 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
29437 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
29438 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
29439 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
29441 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
29442 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
29443 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
29444 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
29445 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
29446 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
29447 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
29448 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
29449 and delay other deliveries to that host.
29451 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
29452 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
29453 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
29454 information is recorded.
29456 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
29457 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
29458 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
29463 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
29464 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
29465 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
29466 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
29467 This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
29468 reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
29470 The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
29471 documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
29472 document is currently at
29474 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
29476 and their FAQ is at
29478 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
29481 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
29482 0-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
29484 More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
29485 published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
29486 Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
29487 &url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
29490 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
29491 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
29492 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
29493 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
29494 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
29495 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
29496 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
29497 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
29498 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
29499 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
29500 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
29501 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
29502 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
29504 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
29505 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
29506 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
29507 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
29511 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
29512 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
29513 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
29514 with OpenSSL, like this:
29515 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
29516 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
29518 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
29521 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
29522 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
29523 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
29524 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
29525 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
29526 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
29527 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
29529 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
29530 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
29531 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
29532 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
29533 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
29534 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
29536 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
29537 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
29538 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
29539 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
29540 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
29541 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
29542 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
29543 be a sensible resolution).
29545 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
29546 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
29547 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
29549 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
29550 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
29551 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
29552 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
29553 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
29554 signed with that self-signed certificate.
29556 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
29557 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
29558 Open-source PKI book, available online at
29559 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
29560 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
29561 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
29565 .section DANE "SECDANE"
29567 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
29568 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
29569 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
29570 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
29571 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
29572 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
29574 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
29575 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
29576 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
29578 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
29579 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
29581 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and communicate via side-channel) copies of server certificates
29582 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
29583 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
29585 DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
29586 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
29587 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
29589 2) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
29590 3) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
29592 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
29593 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
29594 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
29595 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
29597 A TLSA record consist of 4 fields, the "Certificate Usage", the
29598 "Selector", the "Matching type", and the "Certificate Association Data".
29599 For a detailed description of the TLSA record see
29600 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7671#page-5,RFC 7671).
29602 The TLSA record for the server may have "Certificate Usage" (1st) field of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
29603 These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
29604 The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
29605 (and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
29606 this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
29607 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
29609 A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
29610 attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
29611 does require careful arrangement.
29612 With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
29613 the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
29614 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
29615 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
29616 DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
29618 Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
29619 because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
29621 You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
29622 "MTA-STS", described below.
29624 When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
29625 outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
29626 connections to you.
29627 If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
29628 technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
29629 In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
29630 operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
29631 Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
29632 because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
29634 When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
29635 and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
29636 than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
29637 random serial numbers.
29638 The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
29639 If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
29640 requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
29641 CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
29643 The TLSA record should have a "Selector" (2nd) field of SPKI(1) and
29644 a "Matching Type" (3rd) field of SHA2-512(2).
29646 For the "Certificate Authority Data" (4th) field, commands like
29649 openssl x509 -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
29650 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
29655 are workable to create a hash of the certificate's public key.
29657 An example TLSA record for DANE-EE(3), SPKI(1), and SHA-512 (2) looks like
29660 _25._tcp.mail.example.com. TLSA 3 1 2 8BA8A336E...
29663 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
29664 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records.
29667 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
29669 The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
29670 issued using a strong hash algorithm.
29671 Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
29672 re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
29674 This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
29675 interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
29677 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
29678 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
29679 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
29682 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
29683 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
29687 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
29688 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
29689 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
29690 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
29691 control the OCSP request.
29693 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
29694 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
29697 For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
29698 and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
29699 The &"require"& variant will result in failure if the target host is not
29700 DNSSEC-secured. To get DNSSEC-secured hostname resolution, use
29701 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router or transport option.
29703 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
29705 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
29706 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
29707 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
29708 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
29710 If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
29711 prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
29712 back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
29713 This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
29714 crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
29715 which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
29716 limited to ciphersuite constraints.
29718 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
29722 tls_try_verify_hosts
29723 tls_verify_certificates
29725 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
29729 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
29730 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
29732 The router and transport option &%dnssec_request_domains%& must not be
29733 set to &"never"&, and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
29735 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
29737 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
29738 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
29739 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
29740 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
29742 .cindex DANE reporting
29743 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
29744 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
29745 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
29746 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
29747 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
29748 Section 4.3 of that document.
29750 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
29752 DANE is specified in published RFCs and decouples certificate authority trust
29753 selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
29754 to get through". There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS, which
29755 instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website. At the
29756 time this text was last updated, MTA-STS was still a draft, not yet an RFC.
29757 Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
29758 can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
29759 MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
29762 The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
29763 which is recognized by clients sending to you.
29764 That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
29766 The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
29767 &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
29768 renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
29769 records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
29770 information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
29771 domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
29772 incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
29776 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29777 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29779 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
29780 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
29781 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
29782 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
29783 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
29784 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
29785 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
29786 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
29787 one very small ACL:
29791 accept hosts = one.host.only
29793 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
29794 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
29796 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
29797 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
29798 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
29799 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
29800 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
29801 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
29802 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
29803 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
29806 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
29807 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
29808 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
29811 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
29812 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
29813 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
29814 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
29815 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
29816 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29817 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
29818 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
29819 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29820 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29821 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
29822 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
29823 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29824 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
29825 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
29826 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
29827 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29828 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29829 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
29830 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29833 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
29834 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
29835 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
29836 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
29837 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
29838 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
29839 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
29840 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
29841 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
29842 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
29843 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
29844 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
29845 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
29846 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
29847 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
29848 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
29849 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
29850 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
29851 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
29852 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
29855 For example, if you set
29857 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
29859 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
29860 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
29861 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
29862 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
29863 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
29864 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
29865 testing as possible at RCPT time.
29868 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
29869 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29870 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
29871 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
29872 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
29873 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
29874 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
29875 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
29876 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
29877 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
29878 in any of these ACLs.
29880 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
29881 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
29882 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
29883 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
29884 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
29885 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
29886 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
29887 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
29889 control = suppress_local_fixups
29891 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
29892 run, it is too late.
29894 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29895 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29897 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
29898 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
29899 temporary error for these kinds of message.
29902 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
29903 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29904 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
29905 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
29906 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
29907 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
29908 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
29909 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
29910 &%smtp_banner%& option.
29913 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
29914 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29915 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29916 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
29917 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
29918 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
29919 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
29920 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
29921 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
29923 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
29924 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
29925 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
29927 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
29928 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
29929 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
29930 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
29934 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
29935 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29936 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
29937 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
29938 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
29939 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
29940 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
29941 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
29942 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
29943 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
29945 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
29946 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
29947 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
29948 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
29949 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
29950 associated with the DATA command.
29952 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
29953 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
29954 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
29955 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
29956 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
29957 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
29958 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
29959 the data specified is received.
29961 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
29962 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
29963 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
29964 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
29965 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
29968 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
29969 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
29970 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
29971 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
29973 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
29974 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
29975 enabled (which is the default).
29977 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
29978 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
29979 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
29981 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29983 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29986 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
29987 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29988 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29990 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29993 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
29994 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29995 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
29996 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
29997 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
29998 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
29999 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
30002 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
30003 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
30004 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
30005 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
30006 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
30007 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
30008 for some or all recipients.
30010 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
30011 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
30012 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
30013 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
30014 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
30016 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
30017 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
30018 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
30020 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
30021 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
30023 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
30024 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
30025 the feature was not requested by the client.
30027 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
30028 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
30029 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
30030 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
30031 does not in fact control any access.
30032 For this reason, it may only accept
30033 or warn as its final result.
30035 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
30036 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
30037 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
30038 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
30040 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
30041 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
30043 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
30044 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
30047 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
30048 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
30049 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
30050 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
30051 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
30054 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
30055 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
30056 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
30057 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
30058 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
30059 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
30060 situation even worse.
30062 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
30063 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
30064 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
30067 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
30068 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
30069 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
30070 connection. The possible values are:
30072 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
30073 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
30074 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
30075 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
30076 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
30077 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
30078 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
30079 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
30080 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
30081 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
30083 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
30084 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
30085 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
30086 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
30087 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
30091 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
30092 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
30093 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
30094 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
30096 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
30097 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
30099 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
30100 providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
30101 an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
30102 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
30103 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
30105 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
30106 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
30107 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
30110 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
30111 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
30112 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
30113 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
30114 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
30115 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
30117 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
30118 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
30119 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
30121 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
30122 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
30123 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
30124 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
30126 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
30127 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
30128 matches the string.
30130 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
30131 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
30132 want to have something like
30134 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
30136 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
30137 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
30143 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
30144 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
30145 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
30146 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
30147 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
30148 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
30149 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
30150 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
30151 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
30153 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
30154 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
30155 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
30158 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
30159 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
30160 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
30161 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
30163 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
30164 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
30165 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
30166 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
30167 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
30168 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
30169 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
30171 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
30172 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
30175 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
30176 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
30177 recipients; it may create new recipients.
30181 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
30182 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
30183 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
30184 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
30185 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
30186 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
30188 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
30189 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
30190 used to accept or reject anything.
30192 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
30193 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
30194 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
30195 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
30197 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
30198 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
30199 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
30200 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
30201 configuration file.
30206 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
30207 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
30209 .vindex &$local_part$&
30210 .vindex &$sender_address$&
30211 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
30212 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
30213 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
30214 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
30215 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
30216 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
30217 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
30218 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
30220 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
30221 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
30222 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
30225 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
30226 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
30227 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
30228 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
30229 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
30232 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
30233 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
30234 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
30235 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
30236 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
30237 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
30238 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
30239 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
30245 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
30246 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
30247 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
30248 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
30249 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
30250 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
30251 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
30252 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
30253 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
30254 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
30255 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
30256 unencrypted connections.
30259 accept encrypted = *
30260 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
30262 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
30264 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
30265 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
30266 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
30267 option to do this.)
30271 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
30272 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
30273 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
30274 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
30275 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
30276 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
30277 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
30279 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
30280 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
30281 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
30284 deny dnslists = list1.example
30285 dnslists = list2.example
30287 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
30288 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
30289 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
30290 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
30291 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
30294 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
30295 The ACL verbs are as follows:
30298 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
30299 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
30300 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
30301 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
30302 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
30303 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
30304 check a RCPT command:
30306 accept domains = +local_domains
30310 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
30311 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
30312 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
30313 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
30316 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
30317 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
30318 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
30321 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
30322 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
30323 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
30324 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
30325 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
30326 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
30328 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
30329 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
30331 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
30332 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
30333 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
30335 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
30336 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
30337 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
30342 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
30343 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
30344 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
30345 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
30346 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
30347 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
30348 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
30352 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
30353 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
30354 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
30357 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30359 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
30363 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
30364 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
30365 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
30366 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
30367 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
30368 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
30369 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
30370 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
30371 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
30373 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
30374 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
30375 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
30379 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
30380 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
30381 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
30383 drop condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
30384 message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
30386 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
30387 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
30390 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
30391 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
30392 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
30393 example, when checking a RCPT command,
30395 require message = Sender did not verify
30398 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
30399 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
30400 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
30401 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
30404 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
30405 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
30406 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
30407 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
30408 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
30409 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
30410 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
30412 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
30413 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
30414 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
30415 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
30416 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
30418 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
30419 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
30420 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
30421 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
30422 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
30423 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
30427 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30428 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
30429 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
30430 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
30432 warn !verify = sender
30433 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
30437 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
30439 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
30440 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
30441 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
30442 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
30443 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
30447 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
30448 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
30449 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
30450 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
30451 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
30452 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
30453 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
30454 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
30455 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
30456 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
30458 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
30459 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
30460 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
30461 on the same SMTP connection.
30463 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
30464 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
30465 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
30468 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
30469 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
30470 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
30472 accept hosts = whatever
30473 set acl_m4 = some value
30474 accept authenticated = *
30475 set acl_c_auth = yes
30477 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
30478 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
30479 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
30481 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
30482 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
30483 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
30484 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
30485 error is generated.
30487 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
30488 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
30491 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
30492 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
30493 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
30494 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
30496 deny domains = *.dom.example
30497 !verify = recipient
30499 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
30500 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
30501 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
30502 two statements are equivalent:
30504 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
30505 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
30507 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
30508 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
30510 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
30511 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
30512 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
30514 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
30515 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
30516 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
30517 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
30519 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
30520 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
30521 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
30522 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
30523 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
30524 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
30525 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
30527 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
30528 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
30529 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
30530 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
30531 message is handled.
30533 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
30534 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
30535 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
30536 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
30538 require message = Can't verify sender
30540 message = Can't verify recipient
30542 message = This message cannot be used
30544 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
30545 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
30546 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
30547 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
30548 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
30549 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
30551 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
30552 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
30553 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
30554 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
30557 !senders = *@my.domain.example
30558 message = Invalid sender from client host
30560 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
30561 by which time Exim has set up the message.
30565 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
30566 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
30567 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
30570 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30571 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
30572 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
30573 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
30575 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30576 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
30577 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
30578 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
30579 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
30580 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
30581 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
30582 write rather ugly lines like this:
30584 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
30586 Instead, all you need is
30588 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
30591 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30592 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
30593 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
30594 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
30595 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
30596 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
30597 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
30598 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
30600 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
30601 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
30602 in several different ways. For example:
30604 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
30605 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
30606 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
30610 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
30612 accept ...some conditions
30615 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
30616 other words, when the conditions are all true.
30619 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
30621 accept ...some conditions...
30623 ...some more conditions...
30625 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
30626 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
30627 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
30631 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
30632 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
30635 warn ...some conditions...
30639 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
30640 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
30644 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
30645 &%require%& verb. For example:
30647 require control = no_multiline_responses
30651 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
30652 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
30654 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
30655 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
30656 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
30657 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
30658 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
30659 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
30661 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
30664 deny ...some conditions...
30667 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
30668 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
30671 ...some conditions...
30673 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
30674 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
30676 warn ...some conditions...
30682 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
30683 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
30684 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
30685 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
30686 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
30687 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
30688 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
30692 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
30693 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
30694 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
30695 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
30696 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
30697 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
30698 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
30701 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30702 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
30703 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
30704 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
30706 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
30707 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
30709 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
30712 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
30713 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
30715 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
30716 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
30717 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
30720 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
30721 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
30722 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
30723 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
30724 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
30725 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
30728 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30729 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
30730 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
30733 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
30734 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
30735 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
30736 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
30737 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
30738 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
30740 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
30741 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
30742 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
30743 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
30744 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
30745 logging rejections.
30748 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
30749 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
30750 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
30751 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
30752 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
30753 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
30754 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
30755 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
30757 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
30758 &` log_reject_target =`&
30760 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
30761 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
30765 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30766 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
30767 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
30768 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
30769 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
30770 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
30771 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
30774 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
30775 &` control = freeze`&
30776 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
30778 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
30779 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
30780 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
30783 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
30784 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
30788 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30789 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
30790 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
30791 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
30792 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
30793 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
30794 &%accept%& for details.)
30796 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
30797 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
30798 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
30799 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
30800 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
30802 require message = Host not recognized
30805 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
30808 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
30809 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
30810 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
30811 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
30812 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
30813 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
30814 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
30815 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
30816 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
30819 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
30820 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
30821 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
30823 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
30824 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
30826 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
30827 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
30828 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
30831 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
30832 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
30834 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
30835 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
30836 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
30839 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30840 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
30841 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
30843 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
30844 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
30845 However, the original message is available in the variable
30846 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
30847 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
30848 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
30849 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
30851 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
30852 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
30853 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
30854 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
30855 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
30856 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
30860 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30861 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
30862 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
30863 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
30865 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
30867 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
30868 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
30869 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
30870 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
30873 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30874 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
30875 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
30876 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
30879 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
30880 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
30881 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
30882 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
30885 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
30886 .cindex "UDP communications"
30887 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
30888 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
30889 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
30890 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
30891 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
30892 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
30893 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
30896 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
30897 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
30904 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
30905 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
30906 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
30909 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
30910 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
30911 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
30912 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
30913 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
30914 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
30915 not work without it. For example:
30917 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
30918 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
30920 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
30921 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
30922 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
30923 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
30924 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
30927 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
30928 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
30929 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
30930 .cindex "case of local parts"
30931 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
30932 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
30933 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
30934 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
30935 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
30936 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
30939 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
30940 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
30941 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
30942 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
30943 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
30945 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
30946 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
30949 warn control = caseful_local_part
30950 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
30952 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
30954 control = caselower_local_part
30956 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
30957 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
30960 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
30961 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
30962 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
30963 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
30965 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
30966 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
30967 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
30968 is used for all recipients of the message,
30969 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
30970 and data is copied from one to the other.
30972 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
30973 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
30974 If a recipient-verify callout
30976 connection is subsequently
30977 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
30978 any subsequent recipients and the data,
30979 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
30981 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
30982 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
30983 Note also that headers cannot be
30984 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
30985 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
30986 The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
30987 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
30988 this will affect the timestamp.
30990 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
30991 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
30992 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
30993 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
30996 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
30997 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
30998 before the entire message has been received from the source.
30999 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
31003 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
31004 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
31005 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
31006 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
31007 before the acceptance "<=" line.
31009 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
31011 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
31012 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
31013 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
31014 and does not queue the message.
31015 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
31017 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
31019 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
31022 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
31023 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
31024 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
31025 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
31026 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
31027 by default called &'debuglog'&.
31028 The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
31029 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
31030 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
31032 Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
31033 with the &'kill'& option.
31034 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
31038 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
31039 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
31040 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
31041 control = debug/kill
31045 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
31046 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
31047 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
31048 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
31049 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
31052 .vitem &*control&~=&~dmarc_disable_verify*&
31053 .cindex "disable DMARC verify"
31054 .cindex "DMARC" "disable verify"
31055 This control turns off DMARC verification processing entirely. For details on
31056 the operation and configuration of DMARC, see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
31059 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
31060 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
31061 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
31062 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
31063 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
31064 strings or to numeric value.
31065 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
31066 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
31067 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
31069 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
31070 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
31071 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
31072 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
31073 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
31076 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
31077 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
31078 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
31079 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
31080 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
31081 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
31082 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
31083 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
31085 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
31086 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
31087 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
31088 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
31089 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
31090 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
31094 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
31095 .cindex "fake defer"
31096 .cindex "defer, fake"
31097 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
31098 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
31099 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
31100 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
31101 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
31103 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
31104 .cindex "fake rejection"
31105 .cindex "rejection, fake"
31106 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
31107 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
31108 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
31109 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
31110 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
31111 the same SMTP connection.
31113 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
31114 message is supplied, the following is used:
31116 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
31117 550-kept for evaluation.
31118 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
31119 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
31121 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
31123 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
31124 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
31125 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
31126 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
31127 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
31128 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
31131 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
31132 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
31133 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
31134 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
31136 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
31137 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
31138 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
31139 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
31140 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
31141 disables such output flushing.
31143 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
31144 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
31145 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
31146 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
31147 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
31148 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
31150 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
31151 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
31152 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
31153 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
31154 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
31155 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
31156 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
31157 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
31158 to be useful in production.
31160 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
31161 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
31162 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
31163 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
31164 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
31166 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
31167 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
31168 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
31169 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
31170 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
31171 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
31174 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
31175 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
31176 verification failed"&) is sent.
31178 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
31182 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
31183 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
31185 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
31186 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
31187 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
31188 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
31189 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
31190 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
31191 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
31192 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
31195 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue/*&<&'options'&>* &&&
31196 &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
31197 .oindex "&%queue%&"
31198 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
31199 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
31200 .cindex queueing "forcing in ACL"
31201 .cindex "first pass routing"
31202 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
31203 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
31204 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
31206 If used with no options set,
31207 no immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
31208 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option or &'-odq'& command-line option.
31210 If the &'first_pass_route'& option is given then
31211 the behaviour is like the command-line &'-oqds'& option;
31212 a delivery process is started which stops short of making
31213 any SMTP delivery. The benefit is that the hints database will be updated for
31214 the message being waiting for a specific host, and a later queue run will be
31215 able to send all such messages on a single connection.
31217 The control only applies to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that
31218 may be received in the same SMTP connection.
31221 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
31222 .cindex "message" "submission"
31223 .cindex "submission mode"
31224 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
31225 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
31226 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
31227 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
31228 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
31229 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
31230 late (the message has already been created).
31232 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
31233 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
31234 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
31235 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
31236 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
31238 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
31239 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
31240 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
31241 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
31242 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
31245 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
31246 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
31248 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
31250 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
31253 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
31254 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
31255 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
31256 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
31259 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
31260 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
31262 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
31263 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message envelope addresses
31265 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
31269 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
31270 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
31273 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
31275 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
31276 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
31278 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
31280 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
31285 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
31286 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
31287 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
31288 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
31289 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
31290 to an incoming message, as in this example:
31292 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31293 dialup.mail-abuse.org
31294 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
31296 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
31297 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
31298 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
31299 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
31300 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
31303 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
31304 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
31306 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
31307 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
31308 contains one or more newlines that
31309 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
31310 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
31311 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
31313 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
31314 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
31315 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
31316 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
31317 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
31318 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
31319 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
31320 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
31321 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
31322 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
31323 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
31325 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
31326 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
31328 until they are added to the
31329 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
31330 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
31331 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
31332 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
31333 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
31334 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
31335 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
31337 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
31339 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
31340 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
31342 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
31343 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
31345 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
31346 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
31348 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
31349 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
31350 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
31351 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
31354 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
31355 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
31356 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
31357 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
31358 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
31359 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
31360 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
31363 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
31364 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
31365 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
31366 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
31367 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
31369 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
31370 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
31371 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
31372 to be a header name first.) For example:
31374 warn add_header = \
31375 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
31377 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
31378 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
31379 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
31380 up in reverse order.
31382 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
31383 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
31384 system filter or in a router or transport.
31388 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
31389 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
31390 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
31391 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
31392 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
31393 from an incoming message, as in this example:
31395 warn message = Remove internal headers
31396 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
31398 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
31399 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
31400 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
31401 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
31402 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
31403 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
31405 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
31406 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
31408 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
31409 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
31410 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
31411 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
31412 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
31414 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
31415 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
31416 warn message = Remove internal headers
31417 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
31419 Header names for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
31420 Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
31421 If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
31422 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
31423 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
31424 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
31425 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
31426 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
31427 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
31428 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
31429 would have been removed.
31431 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
31432 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
31433 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
31434 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
31435 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
31436 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
31437 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
31438 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
31439 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
31441 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
31442 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
31444 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
31445 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
31447 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
31448 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
31450 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
31451 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
31452 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
31453 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
31456 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
31457 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
31458 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
31463 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
31464 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
31465 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
31466 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
31467 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
31468 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31470 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
31471 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
31472 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
31473 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
31474 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
31475 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
31476 The conditions are as follows:
31480 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
31481 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
31482 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
31483 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
31484 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
31485 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
31486 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
31487 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
31488 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
31489 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
31490 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
31491 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
31493 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
31494 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
31495 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
31496 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
31497 The name and values are expanded separately.
31498 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
31499 will act as argument separators.
31501 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
31502 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
31503 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
31504 conditions are tested.
31506 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
31507 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
31508 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
31509 for different local users or different local domains.
31511 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
31512 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
31513 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
31514 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
31515 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
31516 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
31517 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
31522 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
31523 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
31524 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
31525 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
31526 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
31527 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
31528 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
31529 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
31530 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
31531 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
31532 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
31533 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
31536 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
31537 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
31538 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31539 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
31540 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
31541 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
31542 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
31543 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31545 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
31546 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
31547 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
31548 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
31549 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
31550 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
31551 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
31552 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
31553 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
31554 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
31556 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
31557 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
31558 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
31559 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
31560 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
31561 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
31562 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
31563 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
31564 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
31567 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
31568 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
31571 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
31572 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
31573 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
31574 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
31575 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
31576 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
31577 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
31583 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
31584 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
31585 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
31586 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
31587 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
31588 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
31589 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
31591 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
31593 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
31594 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
31595 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
31597 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
31598 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
31599 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
31600 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
31601 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
31602 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
31604 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
31605 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
31607 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
31608 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
31610 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
31611 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
31612 statement can then check the IP address.
31614 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
31615 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
31616 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
31617 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
31619 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
31620 message = $host_data
31622 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
31624 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
31625 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
31626 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
31627 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
31628 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
31629 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
31630 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
31631 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
31632 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
31633 the next &%local_parts%& test.
31635 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
31636 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
31637 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
31638 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
31639 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31640 content-scanning extension
31641 and only after a DATA command.
31642 It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
31643 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31645 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
31646 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
31647 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
31648 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31649 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
31650 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
31651 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
31654 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
31655 .cindex "rate limiting"
31656 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
31657 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
31659 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
31660 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
31661 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
31662 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
31663 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
31664 recipient address against a list of recipients.
31666 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
31667 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
31668 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
31669 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31670 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
31671 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
31672 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31674 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
31675 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
31676 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
31677 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
31678 .vindex "&$domain$&"
31679 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
31680 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
31681 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
31682 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
31683 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
31684 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
31685 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
31686 influence the sender checking.
31688 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
31689 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
31691 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
31692 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
31693 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
31694 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
31695 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
31696 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
31700 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
31701 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
31703 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
31704 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
31705 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
31706 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31707 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
31708 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31710 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
31711 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31712 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
31713 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
31714 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
31715 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
31716 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
31717 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
31718 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
31719 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
31721 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
31722 .cindex "CSA verification"
31723 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
31724 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
31725 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
31727 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
31728 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31729 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
31730 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
31731 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
31732 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31733 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31734 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
31735 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
31736 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
31738 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
31739 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
31740 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
31742 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
31743 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31744 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
31745 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
31746 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
31747 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
31748 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31749 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31750 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
31751 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
31752 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
31753 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
31754 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
31755 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
31756 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
31758 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
31759 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
31760 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
31761 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
31764 !verify = header_sender
31765 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
31768 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
31769 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31770 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
31771 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
31772 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
31773 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31774 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31775 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
31776 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
31777 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
31778 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
31779 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
31780 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
31783 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
31784 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
31788 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
31789 common as they used to be.
31791 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
31792 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31793 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
31794 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
31795 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
31796 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
31797 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
31798 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
31799 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
31800 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
31801 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
31802 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
31803 independently of this condition, and for detail of the verification.
31805 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
31806 option), this condition is always true.
31809 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind/*&<&'options'&>
31810 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
31811 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
31812 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
31813 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
31814 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
31815 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
31816 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
31817 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
31819 There is one possible option, &`case_insensitive`&. If this is present then
31820 local parts are checked case-insensitively.
31822 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
31823 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
31826 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
31827 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31828 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
31829 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
31830 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
31831 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
31832 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
31833 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
31834 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
31835 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
31836 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
31837 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
31838 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
31839 value for the child address.
31841 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
31842 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31843 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
31844 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
31845 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
31846 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
31847 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
31848 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
31849 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
31850 original IP address.
31852 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
31853 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
31855 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
31856 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
31858 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
31859 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31860 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
31861 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
31862 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
31863 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
31864 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
31865 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
31866 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
31868 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
31869 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
31870 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
31871 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
31872 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
31873 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
31874 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
31876 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
31877 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
31878 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
31880 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
31881 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31882 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
31883 verified as a sender.
31885 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
31886 (eg. is generated from the received message)
31887 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
31889 verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
31895 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
31896 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
31897 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
31898 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
31899 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
31900 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
31901 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
31902 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
31903 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
31904 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
31906 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
31907 dialups.mail-abuse.org
31909 the following records are looked up:
31911 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31912 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
31914 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
31915 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
31916 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
31917 use two separate conditions:
31919 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31920 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31922 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
31923 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
31924 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
31927 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
31928 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
31929 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
31930 following special items in the list:
31932 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
31933 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
31934 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
31936 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
31937 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
31938 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
31939 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
31941 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
31943 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
31944 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
31946 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31947 warn dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31948 message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
31950 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
31952 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
31953 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
31954 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
31955 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
31956 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
31957 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
31959 There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
31960 or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
31961 &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
31965 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
31966 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
31967 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
31968 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
31969 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
31971 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
31973 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
31974 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
31975 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
31976 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
31981 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
31982 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
31983 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
31984 addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
31985 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
31986 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
31987 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
31989 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31990 message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
31992 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
31993 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
31994 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
31995 up by this example is
31997 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
31999 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
32000 addresses. For example:
32002 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
32003 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
32005 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
32006 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
32011 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
32012 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
32013 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
32014 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
32015 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
32016 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
32017 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
32018 either to double the separators like this:
32020 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
32022 or to change the separator character, like this:
32024 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
32026 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
32027 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
32028 occurs. Consider this condition:
32030 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
32032 The DNS lookups that occur are:
32034 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
32035 a.domain.black.list.tld
32037 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
32038 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
32039 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
32040 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
32041 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
32042 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
32043 error for a previous item.
32045 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
32046 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
32048 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
32049 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
32051 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
32052 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
32054 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
32055 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
32056 $sender_address_domain} }} }
32057 message = The mail servers for the domain \
32058 $sender_address_domain \
32059 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
32062 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
32063 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
32064 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
32065 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
32067 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
32069 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
32070 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
32072 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
32073 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
32078 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
32079 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
32080 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
32081 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
32082 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
32083 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
32087 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
32089 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
32090 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
32091 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
32093 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
32094 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
32095 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
32098 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
32099 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
32100 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
32101 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
32102 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
32103 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
32104 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
32105 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
32106 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
32107 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
32108 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
32109 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
32110 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
32111 cases, for example:
32113 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
32115 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
32116 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
32117 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
32118 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
32120 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
32122 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
32123 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
32125 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
32126 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
32127 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
32128 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
32129 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
32132 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
32133 &-- even if these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
32134 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
32136 deny hosts = !+local_networks
32137 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
32139 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
32144 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
32145 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
32146 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
32147 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
32150 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
32152 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
32153 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
32154 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
32155 describes how multiple records are handled.
32157 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
32158 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
32159 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
32161 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
32163 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
32164 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
32165 first. For example:
32167 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
32168 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
32171 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
32172 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
32173 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
32174 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
32175 tested. For example:
32177 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
32179 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
32180 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
32181 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
32183 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
32185 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
32190 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
32191 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
32194 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
32196 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
32197 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
32199 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
32201 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
32202 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
32203 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
32204 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
32206 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
32207 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
32209 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
32210 previous example is precisely equivalent to
32212 deny dnslists = a.b.c
32213 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
32215 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
32216 Consider this example:
32218 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
32220 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
32223 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
32225 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
32227 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
32228 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
32229 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
32231 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
32236 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
32237 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
32238 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
32239 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
32240 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
32241 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
32243 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
32245 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
32246 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
32247 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
32248 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
32249 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
32250 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
32253 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
32254 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
32255 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
32257 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
32258 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
32261 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
32263 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
32264 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
32266 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
32268 for the condition to be true.
32271 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
32272 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
32274 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
32275 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
32277 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
32279 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
32280 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
32282 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
32283 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
32285 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
32287 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
32288 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
32290 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
32292 for the condition to be false.
32294 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
32295 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
32300 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
32301 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
32302 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
32303 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
32304 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
32305 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
32306 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
32307 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
32308 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
32311 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
32312 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
32313 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
32314 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
32315 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
32316 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
32317 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
32320 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
32321 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
32323 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
32324 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
32326 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
32327 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
32328 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
32329 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
32330 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
32331 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
32333 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
32334 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
32335 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
32338 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
32339 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
32340 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
32341 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
32343 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
32344 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
32345 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
32349 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
32350 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
32351 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
32352 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
32353 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
32354 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
32356 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
32357 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
32359 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
32360 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
32361 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
32363 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
32365 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
32366 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
32368 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
32369 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
32371 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
32372 dnslists = some.list.example
32375 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
32376 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
32377 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
32379 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
32382 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
32383 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
32384 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
32385 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
32386 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
32387 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
32388 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
32389 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
32390 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
32391 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
32393 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
32395 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
32396 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
32398 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
32399 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
32400 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
32403 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
32404 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
32405 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
32406 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
32407 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
32408 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
32409 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
32410 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
32411 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
32413 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
32414 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
32415 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
32416 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
32418 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
32419 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
32420 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
32421 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
32422 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
32423 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
32424 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
32425 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
32426 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
32427 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
32429 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
32430 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
32431 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
32434 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
32435 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
32436 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
32437 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
32438 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
32439 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
32441 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
32442 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
32443 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
32444 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
32445 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
32446 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
32447 the &%count=%& option.
32450 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
32451 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
32452 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
32453 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
32454 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
32456 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
32457 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
32458 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
32459 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
32461 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
32462 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
32463 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
32464 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
32465 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
32466 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
32467 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
32469 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
32470 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
32471 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
32472 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
32473 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
32474 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
32475 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
32477 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
32478 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
32479 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
32480 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
32483 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
32484 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
32485 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
32486 multiple different commands.
32488 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
32489 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
32490 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
32491 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
32492 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
32494 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
32497 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
32498 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
32499 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
32500 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
32501 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
32503 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
32504 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
32506 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
32507 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
32508 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
32509 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
32513 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
32514 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
32515 (max $sender_rate_limit)
32518 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
32519 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
32520 (max $sender_rate_limit)
32523 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
32524 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
32525 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
32526 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
32527 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
32528 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
32531 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
32532 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
32533 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
32534 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
32535 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
32538 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
32539 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
32540 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
32541 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
32542 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
32543 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
32546 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
32547 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
32548 client's average rate of successfully sent email,
32549 up to the given limit.
32550 This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
32551 consists of refusing the message, and
32552 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
32553 If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
32554 likely not what is wanted.
32556 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
32557 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
32558 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
32559 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
32560 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
32561 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
32562 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
32563 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
32565 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
32569 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
32570 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
32571 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
32572 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
32573 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
32574 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
32575 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
32576 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
32577 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
32579 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
32580 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
32581 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
32582 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
32583 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
32584 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
32586 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
32587 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
32590 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
32591 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
32592 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
32593 required increases with larger limits.
32595 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
32596 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
32597 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
32598 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
32599 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
32600 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
32601 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
32602 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
32603 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
32607 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
32608 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
32609 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
32610 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
32611 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
32612 message. For example:
32614 # Log all senders' rates
32615 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
32616 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
32618 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
32619 # at the decimal point.
32620 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
32621 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
32622 $sender_rate_limit }s
32624 # Keep authenticated users under control
32625 deny authenticated = *
32626 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
32628 # System-wide rate limit
32629 defer ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
32630 message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
32632 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
32633 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
32634 defer ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
32635 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
32636 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
32637 message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
32638 messages per $sender_rate_period
32640 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
32641 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
32642 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
32643 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
32644 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
32645 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
32646 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
32650 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
32651 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
32652 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
32653 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
32654 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
32655 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
32656 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
32657 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
32658 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
32660 verify = sender/callout
32661 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
32663 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
32664 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
32665 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
32666 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
32667 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
32668 The available options are as follows:
32671 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
32672 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
32673 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
32675 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
32676 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
32677 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
32678 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
32680 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
32681 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
32683 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
32684 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
32685 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
32686 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
32689 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
32690 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
32691 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
32692 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
32693 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
32694 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
32697 warn !verify = sender
32698 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
32700 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
32701 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
32702 verification failure.
32704 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
32705 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
32708 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
32709 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
32711 &%route%&: Routing failed.
32713 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
32714 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
32715 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
32717 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
32719 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
32722 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
32723 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
32725 The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
32726 address verification to:
32729 &%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
32735 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
32736 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
32737 .cindex "callout" "verification"
32738 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
32739 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
32740 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
32741 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
32742 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
32743 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
32744 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
32745 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
32746 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
32749 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
32750 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
32751 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
32752 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
32753 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
32754 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
32756 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
32757 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
32758 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
32759 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
32760 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
32762 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
32763 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
32764 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
32765 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
32766 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
32767 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
32768 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
32769 supplies a host list.
32770 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
32772 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
32773 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
32774 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
32775 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
32776 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
32777 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
32778 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
32780 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
32781 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
32782 following SMTP commands are sent:
32784 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
32786 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
32789 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
32792 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
32795 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
32796 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
32797 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
32798 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
32799 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
32800 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
32802 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
32803 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
32804 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
32805 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
32806 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
32808 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
32809 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
32810 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
32811 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
32812 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
32817 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
32818 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
32819 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
32820 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
32822 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
32824 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
32825 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
32826 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
32830 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
32831 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
32832 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
32835 verify = sender/callout=5s
32837 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
32838 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
32839 the &%connect%& parameter.
32842 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32843 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
32844 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
32845 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
32847 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
32849 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
32851 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
32852 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
32853 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
32854 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
32855 updated in this circumstance.
32857 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
32858 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
32859 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
32860 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
32861 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
32862 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
32865 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32866 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
32867 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
32868 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
32869 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
32870 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
32871 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
32872 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
32873 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
32874 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
32876 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
32878 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
32881 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32882 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
32883 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
32886 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
32888 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
32889 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
32890 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
32891 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
32892 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
32895 .vitem &*no_cache*&
32896 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
32897 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
32898 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
32900 .vitem &*postmaster*&
32901 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
32902 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
32903 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
32904 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
32905 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
32906 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
32907 made, until the cache record expires.
32909 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32910 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
32911 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
32914 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
32916 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
32917 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
32919 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
32921 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
32922 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
32923 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
32924 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
32928 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
32929 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
32930 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
32931 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
32932 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
32934 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
32936 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
32937 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
32938 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
32939 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
32940 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
32942 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
32943 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
32944 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32946 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
32948 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
32949 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
32950 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
32951 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
32952 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
32954 .vitem &*use_sender*&
32955 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32957 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
32959 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
32960 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
32961 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
32962 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
32963 usefulness of callout caching.
32966 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32968 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
32970 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
32971 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
32972 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
32973 when that is used for the connections.
32974 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
32975 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
32976 if the use_sender option is used,
32977 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
32978 and if no other callouts intervene.
32981 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
32982 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
32983 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
32984 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
32985 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
32986 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
32987 these circumstances.
32989 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
32990 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
32991 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
32992 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
32993 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
32994 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
32995 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
32997 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
32998 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
32999 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
33000 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
33005 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
33006 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
33007 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
33008 .cindex "caching" "callout"
33009 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
33010 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
33011 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
33012 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
33013 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
33014 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
33016 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
33017 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
33020 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
33021 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
33022 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
33024 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
33025 commands up to and including
33029 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
33030 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
33031 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
33032 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
33033 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
33034 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
33035 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
33037 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
33038 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
33039 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
33040 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
33041 will eventually be noticed.
33043 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
33044 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
33045 behaviour will be the same.
33049 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
33050 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
33051 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
33052 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
33053 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
33054 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
33057 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
33059 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
33060 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
33061 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
33062 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
33063 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
33064 550 Sender verification failed
33066 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
33067 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
33068 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
33069 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
33072 verify = sender/no_details
33075 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
33076 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
33077 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
33078 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
33079 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
33080 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
33081 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
33084 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
33085 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
33086 verification also fails.
33088 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
33089 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
33092 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
33093 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
33094 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
33097 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
33099 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
33100 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
33101 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
33102 verification to succeed.
33104 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
33105 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
33106 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
33107 option. For example:
33109 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
33111 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
33112 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
33114 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
33115 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
33116 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
33117 address and a report is output for each of them.
33121 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
33122 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
33123 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
33124 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
33125 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
33126 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
33127 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
33131 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
33132 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
33133 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
33134 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
33135 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
33136 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
33138 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
33139 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
33140 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
33141 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
33144 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
33146 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
33148 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
33149 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
33151 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
33152 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
33155 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
33156 use for the DNS query. The default is:
33158 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
33160 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
33161 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
33162 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
33163 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
33166 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
33168 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
33169 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
33170 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
33172 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
33173 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
33174 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
33175 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
33176 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
33177 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
33178 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
33179 of legitimate HELO domains.
33181 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
33182 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
33183 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
33184 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
33187 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
33189 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
33190 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
33191 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
33196 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
33197 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
33198 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
33199 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
33200 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
33201 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
33202 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
33203 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
33205 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
33206 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
33207 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
33208 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
33209 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
33210 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
33211 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
33212 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
33214 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
33215 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
33218 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
33219 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
33222 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
33223 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
33226 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
33228 recipients = +batv_senders
33229 message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
33231 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
33233 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
33234 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
33235 !condition = $prvscheck_result
33236 message = Invalid reverse path signature.
33238 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
33239 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
33240 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
33241 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
33242 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
33244 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
33245 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
33246 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
33247 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
33248 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
33249 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
33250 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
33252 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
33253 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
33254 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
33255 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
33259 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
33261 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
33262 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
33263 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
33266 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
33269 external_smtp_batv:
33271 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
33272 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
33273 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
33274 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
33277 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
33281 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
33282 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
33283 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
33284 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
33285 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
33286 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
33287 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
33288 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
33289 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
33290 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
33292 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
33293 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
33294 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
33295 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
33296 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
33297 same host is fulfilling both functions,
33299 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
33301 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
33302 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
33303 system to arbitrary domains.
33306 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
33307 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
33308 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
33309 example, suppose you want to do the following:
33312 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
33313 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
33314 &'my.dom2.example'&.
33316 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
33317 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
33319 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
33320 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
33324 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
33326 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
33327 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
33328 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
33330 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
33334 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
33335 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
33337 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
33338 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
33339 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
33340 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
33341 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
33342 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
33343 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
33347 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
33348 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
33349 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
33350 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
33351 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
33356 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33357 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33359 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
33360 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
33361 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
33362 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
33363 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
33364 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
33367 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
33368 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
33369 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
33370 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
33371 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
33373 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
33374 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
33375 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
33378 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
33379 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
33381 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
33382 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
33383 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
33385 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
33386 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
33388 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
33391 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
33394 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
33395 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
33396 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
33397 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
33398 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
33399 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
33401 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
33402 temporarily created in a file called:
33404 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
33406 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
33407 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
33408 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
33409 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
33410 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
33412 control = no_mbox_unspool
33414 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
33415 same directory by default.
33419 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
33420 .cindex "virus scanning"
33421 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
33422 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
33423 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
33424 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
33425 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
33426 in memory and thus are much faster.
33428 Since message data needs to have arrived,
33429 the condition may be only called in ACL defined by
33431 &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
33432 &%acl_smtp_mime%& or
33435 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
33436 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
33438 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
33439 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
33440 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
33441 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
33443 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
33445 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
33447 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
33449 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
33451 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
33452 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
33453 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
33457 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
33458 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
33459 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
33460 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
33461 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
33462 This scanner type takes one option,
33463 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
33464 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
33465 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
33466 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
33467 A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
33468 Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
33469 the daemon as options before the main scan command.
33471 .cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
33472 If &`pass_unscanned`&
33473 is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
33474 decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
33479 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
33480 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
33481 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
33483 If you omit the argument, the default path
33484 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
33486 If you use a remote host,
33487 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
33488 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
33489 For information about available commands and their options you may use
33491 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
33497 If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
33498 permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
33499 written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
33501 .vitem &%aveserver%&
33502 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
33503 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
33504 at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
33505 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
33508 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
33513 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
33514 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
33515 &url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
33516 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
33517 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
33519 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
33520 a UNIX socket specification,
33521 a TCP socket specification,
33522 or a (global) option.
33524 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
33525 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
33526 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
33527 and the second a port number,
33528 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
33529 These per-server options are supported:
33531 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
33534 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
33535 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
33537 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
33541 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
33542 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
33543 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
33544 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
33545 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
33547 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
33549 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
33550 to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
33551 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
33552 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
33554 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
33555 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
33556 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
33557 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
33558 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
33559 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
33560 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
33561 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
33562 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
33564 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
33565 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
33566 (Connection refused)
33569 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
33570 contributing the code for this scanner.
33573 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
33574 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
33575 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
33576 type takes 3 mandatory options:
33579 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
33580 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
33583 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
33584 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
33585 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
33586 the &"trigger"& expression.
33589 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
33590 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
33591 &"name"& expression.
33594 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
33596 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
33598 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
33599 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
33600 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
33601 configuration setting:
33603 av_scanner = cmdline:\
33604 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
33605 found in file:'(.+)'
33608 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
33609 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
33611 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
33612 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
33613 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
33614 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
33617 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
33618 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
33620 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
33621 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
33624 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
33625 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
33626 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
33630 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
33632 If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
33634 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
33635 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
33636 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
33637 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
33640 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
33642 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
33645 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
33646 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
33647 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
33649 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
33651 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
33652 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
33654 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
33655 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
33656 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
33657 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
33658 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
33661 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
33663 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
33666 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
33667 This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
33668 though some documentation was available in English.
33669 The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
33670 and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
33671 we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
33673 The only option for this scanner type is
33674 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
33675 provided that mksd has
33676 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
33678 av_scanner = mksd:2
33680 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
33683 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
33684 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
33685 running on the local machine.
33686 There are four options:
33687 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
33688 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
33689 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
33690 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
33691 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
33694 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
33696 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
33697 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
33698 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
33699 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
33700 specify an empty element to get this.
33703 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
33704 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
33705 You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
33706 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
33707 client communication. For example:
33709 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
33711 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
33715 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
33716 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
33719 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
33720 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
33721 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
33722 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
33723 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
33724 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
33727 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
33728 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
33729 The first element can then be one of
33732 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
33733 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
33736 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
33737 the condition fails immediately.
33739 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
33740 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
33741 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
33742 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
33743 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
33746 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
33747 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
33748 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
33750 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
33751 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
33754 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
33756 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
33758 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33759 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33760 is set to record the actual address used.
33762 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
33763 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
33764 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
33765 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
33768 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
33769 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
33771 Here is a very simple scanning example:
33774 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33776 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
33778 deny malware = */defer_ok
33779 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33781 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
33782 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
33784 av_scanner = $acl_m0
33786 in the main Exim configuration.
33788 deny set acl_m0 = sophie
33790 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33792 deny set acl_m0 = aveserver
33794 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33798 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
33799 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
33800 .cindex "spam scanning"
33801 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
33803 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
33804 score and a report for the message.
33805 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
33807 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
33808 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
33809 &url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
33811 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
33813 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
33815 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
33816 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
33819 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
33820 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
33821 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
33822 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
33823 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
33824 configuration as follows (example):
33826 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
33828 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
33829 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
33830 iptables firewall, consider setting
33831 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
33832 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
33833 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
33834 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
33838 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
33840 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
33842 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
33845 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
33846 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
33847 filename instead of an address/port pair:
33849 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
33851 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
33852 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
33853 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
33854 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
33856 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
33857 192.168.2.11 783 : \
33860 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
33861 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
33862 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
33865 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
33866 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
33867 and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
33868 take care to not double the separator.
33870 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
33871 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
33872 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
33873 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
33875 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
33877 The supported options are:
33879 pri=<priority> Selection priority
33880 weight=<value> Selection bias
33881 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
33882 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
33883 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
33884 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
33887 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
33888 higher values being tried first.
33889 The default priority is 1.
33891 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
33892 Within a priority set
33893 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
33894 The default value for selection bias is 1.
33896 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
33897 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
33898 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
33899 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
33901 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
33902 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
33904 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
33905 The default value is two minutes.
33907 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
33908 a failed connect is made.
33909 The default is to not retry.
33911 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
33912 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
33913 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
33916 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33917 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33918 is set to record the actual address used.
33920 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
33921 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
33924 message = This message was classified as SPAM
33926 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
33927 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
33928 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
33929 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
33930 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
33933 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
33934 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
33935 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
33936 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
33937 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
33939 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
33940 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
33942 or the use of PRDR,
33943 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
33944 are needed to use this feature.
33946 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
33947 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
33948 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
33951 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
33952 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
33953 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
33956 deny condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
33958 message = This message was classified as SPAM
33961 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
33962 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
33963 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
33964 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
33966 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
33967 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
33969 Except for &$spam_report$&,
33970 these variables are saved with the received message so are
33971 available for use at delivery time.
33974 .vitem &$spam_score$&
33975 The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
33976 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
33978 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
33979 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
33980 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
33981 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
33982 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
33984 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
33985 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
33986 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
33987 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
33988 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
33989 spam bar is 50 characters.
33991 .vitem &$spam_report$&
33992 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
33993 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
33994 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
33995 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
33996 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
33997 unencoded in headers.
33999 .vitem &$spam_action$&
34000 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
34001 spam score versus threshold.
34002 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
34006 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
34007 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
34008 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
34010 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
34011 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
34012 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
34013 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
34014 spam condition, like this:
34016 deny spam = joe/defer_ok
34017 message = This message was classified as SPAM
34019 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
34021 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
34024 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
34025 warn spam = nobody:true
34026 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
34027 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
34029 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
34030 # is over threshold
34032 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
34034 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
34035 deny spam = nobody:true
34036 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
34037 message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
34042 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
34043 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
34044 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
34045 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
34046 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
34047 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
34048 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
34049 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
34050 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
34051 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
34054 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
34055 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
34056 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
34057 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
34058 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
34059 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
34060 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
34062 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
34063 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
34064 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
34065 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
34066 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
34068 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
34069 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
34070 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
34071 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
34072 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
34075 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
34077 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
34081 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
34083 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
34084 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
34085 a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
34086 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
34088 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
34089 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
34090 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
34091 the full path and filename.
34093 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
34094 filename, and the default path is then used.
34096 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
34097 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
34098 a file with its original, proposed filename using
34100 decode = $mime_filename
34102 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
34103 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
34104 automatically unlinked.
34106 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
34107 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
34108 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
34109 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
34110 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
34112 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
34113 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
34114 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
34116 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
34117 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
34118 available in the MIME ACL:
34121 .vitem &$mime_anomaly_level$& &&&
34122 &$mime_anomaly_text$&
34123 .vindex &$mime_anomaly_level$&
34124 .vindex &$mime_anomaly_text$&
34125 If there are problems decoding, these variables contain information on
34126 the detected issue.
34128 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
34129 .vindex &$mime_boundary$&
34130 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$& below), it should
34131 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
34132 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
34133 contains the empty string.
34135 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
34136 .vindex &$mime_charset$&
34137 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
34138 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
34144 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
34145 case-insensitively.
34147 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
34148 .vindex &$mime_content_description$&
34149 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
34150 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
34151 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
34152 only used for display purposes.
34154 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
34155 .vindex &$mime_content_disposition$&
34156 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
34157 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
34159 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
34160 .vindex &$mime_content_id$&
34161 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
34162 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
34164 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
34165 .vindex &$mime_content_size$&
34166 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
34167 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
34168 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
34169 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
34171 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
34172 .vindex &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
34173 This variable contains the normalized content of the
34174 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
34175 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
34177 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
34178 .vindex &$mime_content_type$&
34179 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
34180 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
34181 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
34185 application/octet-stream
34189 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
34192 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
34193 .vindex &$mime_decoded_filename$&
34194 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
34195 successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
34196 containing the decoded data.
34201 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
34202 .vindex &$mime_filename$&
34203 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
34204 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
34205 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
34208 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
34210 found, this variable contains the empty string.
34212 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
34213 .vindex &$mime_is_coverletter$&
34214 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
34215 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
34216 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
34218 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
34219 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
34223 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
34226 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
34227 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
34230 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
34231 and the rest are attachments.
34234 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
34237 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
34238 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
34239 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
34241 deny !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
34242 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
34243 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
34244 message = HTML mail is not accepted here
34247 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
34248 .vindex &$mime_is_multipart$&
34249 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
34250 &"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
34251 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
34252 want to carry out specific actions on them.
34254 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
34255 .vindex &$mime_is_rfc822$&
34256 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
34257 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
34258 decoding is fully recursive.
34260 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
34261 .vindex &$mime_part_count$&
34262 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
34263 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
34264 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
34265 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
34266 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
34267 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
34272 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
34273 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
34274 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
34275 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
34276 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
34278 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
34279 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
34280 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
34281 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
34282 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
34284 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
34285 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
34286 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
34287 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
34288 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
34289 32K characters are checked.
34291 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
34292 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
34293 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
34294 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
34295 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
34297 deny regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
34298 message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
34300 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
34301 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
34302 matching regular expression.
34303 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
34304 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
34306 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
34314 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34315 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34317 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
34318 "Local scan function"
34319 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
34320 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
34321 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
34322 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
34323 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
34325 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
34326 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
34327 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
34328 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
34329 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
34331 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
34332 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
34333 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
34334 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
34336 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
34337 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
34338 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
34339 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
34341 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
34342 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
34343 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
34344 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
34345 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
34346 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
34347 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
34348 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
34349 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
34353 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
34354 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
34355 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
34356 function is before building Exim, by setting
34357 both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
34358 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
34359 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
34360 directory, so you might set
34362 HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
34363 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
34365 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&;
34367 the source file(s) for it should first #define LOCAL_SCAN
34368 and then #include "local_scan.h".
34371 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
34372 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
34373 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
34374 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
34375 _src/local_scan.c_.
34377 If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
34378 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
34380 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
34382 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
34387 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
34388 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
34389 .cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
34390 You must include this line near the start of your code:
34393 #include "local_scan.h"
34395 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
34396 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
34397 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
34398 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
34399 It also makes available the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
34400 strings and pointers to character strings:
34402 #define CS (char *)
34403 #define CCS (const char *)
34404 #define CSS (char **)
34405 #define US (unsigned char *)
34406 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
34407 #define USS (unsigned char **)
34409 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
34411 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
34413 The arguments are as follows:
34416 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
34417 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
34418 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
34420 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
34421 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
34422 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
34423 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
34424 case this changes in some future version.
34426 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
34427 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
34430 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
34433 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
34434 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
34435 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
34436 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
34437 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
34438 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
34440 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
34441 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
34442 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
34444 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
34445 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
34446 queued without immediate delivery.
34448 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
34449 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
34450 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
34451 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
34452 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
34455 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
34456 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
34457 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
34460 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
34461 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
34462 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
34463 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
34464 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
34465 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
34466 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
34468 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
34469 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
34470 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
34473 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
34474 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
34475 &%-oe%& command line options.
34479 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
34480 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
34481 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
34482 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
34483 want to do this, you must have the line
34485 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
34487 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
34488 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
34489 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
34492 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
34493 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
34494 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
34495 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
34496 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
34497 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
34499 static int my_integer_option = 42;
34500 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
34502 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
34503 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
34504 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
34507 int local_scan_options_count =
34508 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
34510 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
34511 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
34515 my_string = some string of text...
34517 The available types of option data are as follows:
34520 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
34521 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
34522 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
34523 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
34524 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
34525 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
34528 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
34529 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
34530 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
34531 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
34534 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
34535 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
34538 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
34539 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
34540 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
34541 printed with the suffix K or M.
34543 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
34544 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
34545 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
34546 always output in octal.
34548 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
34549 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
34550 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
34552 .vitem &*opt_time*&
34553 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
34554 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
34557 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
34558 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
34562 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
34563 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
34564 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
34565 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
34566 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
34567 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
34568 C variables are as follows:
34571 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
34572 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
34573 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
34575 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
34576 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
34577 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
34579 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
34580 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
34581 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
34582 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
34585 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
34586 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
34587 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
34590 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
34591 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
34595 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
34596 selected, you should use code like this:
34598 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
34599 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
34601 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
34602 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
34603 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
34605 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
34606 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
34609 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
34610 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
34612 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
34613 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
34615 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
34616 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
34617 &%-bh%& command line option.
34619 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
34620 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
34621 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
34623 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
34624 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
34625 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
34626 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
34628 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
34629 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
34630 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
34632 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
34633 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
34635 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
34636 The number of accepted recipients.
34638 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
34639 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
34640 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
34641 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
34642 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
34643 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
34644 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
34645 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
34646 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
34647 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
34648 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
34649 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
34651 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
34652 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
34654 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
34655 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
34656 locally-submitted messages.
34658 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
34659 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
34660 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
34662 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
34663 The name of the sending host, if known.
34665 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
34666 The port on the sending host.
34668 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
34669 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
34671 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
34672 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
34674 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
34675 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
34676 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
34680 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
34681 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
34682 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
34683 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
34688 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
34689 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
34691 .vitem &*int&~type*&
34692 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
34693 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
34694 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
34695 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
34696 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
34697 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
34699 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
34700 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
34703 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
34704 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
34705 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
34710 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
34711 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
34714 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
34715 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
34717 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
34718 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
34719 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
34720 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
34722 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
34723 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
34724 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
34725 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
34726 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
34727 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
34728 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
34729 is NULL for all recipients.
34734 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
34735 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
34736 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
34737 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
34741 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
34742 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
34744 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
34745 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
34746 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
34747 for the process in &%newumask%&.
34749 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
34750 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
34751 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
34752 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
34753 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
34755 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
34757 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
34758 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
34759 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
34760 return value is as follows:
34765 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
34771 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
34777 The process timed out.
34781 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
34784 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
34785 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
34786 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
34787 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
34788 forks a subprocess that is running
34790 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
34792 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
34793 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
34794 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
34795 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
34797 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
34798 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
34799 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
34800 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
34803 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
34804 *sender_authentication)*&
34805 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
34808 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
34810 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
34813 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
34814 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
34815 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
34816 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
34817 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
34819 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
34820 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
34823 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
34824 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
34825 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
34826 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
34827 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
34828 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
34829 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
34830 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
34832 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
34833 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
34834 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
34835 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
34836 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
34837 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
34839 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34840 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
34841 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
34842 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
34844 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
34845 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
34846 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
34847 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
34848 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
34849 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
34850 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
34851 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
34852 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
34853 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
34855 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
34856 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
34858 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
34859 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
34862 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
34863 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
34864 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
34865 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
34866 match the specification, the function does nothing.
34869 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34870 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
34871 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
34872 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
34873 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
34874 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
34876 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
34878 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
34879 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
34880 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
34881 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
34882 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
34885 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
34886 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
34887 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
34888 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
34889 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
34890 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
34891 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
34892 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
34894 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
34895 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
34896 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
34898 &`OK `& match succeeded
34899 &`FAIL `& match failed
34900 &`DEFER `& match deferred
34902 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
34903 inability to contact a database.
34905 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34907 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
34908 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
34909 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
34911 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34913 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
34914 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
34915 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
34917 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
34919 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
34922 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
34924 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
34925 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
34926 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
34927 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
34928 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
34929 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
34932 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
34934 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
34935 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
34936 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
34937 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
34938 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
34939 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
34942 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
34943 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
34944 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
34945 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
34947 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
34948 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
34949 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
34950 value afterwards. For example:
34952 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
34953 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
34954 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
34957 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
34958 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
34959 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
34960 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
34967 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
34968 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
34969 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
34970 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
34971 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
34972 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
34973 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
34974 binary string is returned with an error message.
34976 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
34977 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
34978 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
34980 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
34981 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
34982 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
34983 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
34984 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
34986 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
34987 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
34988 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
34990 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
34991 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
34992 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
34993 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
34997 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
34998 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
35001 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,BOOL,&~...)*&
35002 The arguments of this function are almost like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
35003 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
35004 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
35005 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
35006 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
35007 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
35008 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
35011 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
35012 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
35014 The second argument is used to request that the data be buffered
35015 (when TRUE) or flushed (along with any previously buffered, when FALSE).
35016 This is advisory only, but likely to save on system-calls and packets
35017 sent when a sequence of calls to the function are made.
35019 The argument was added in Exim version 4.90 - changing the API/ABI.
35020 Nobody noticed until 4.93 was imminent, at which point the
35021 ABI version number was incremented.
35023 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
35024 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
35025 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
35026 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
35027 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
35028 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
35029 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
35031 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
35032 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
35034 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
35035 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
35036 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
35037 multiple output lines.
35039 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
35041 guarantee a flush of
35042 pending output, and therefore does not test
35043 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
35044 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
35045 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
35046 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
35047 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
35051 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int,BOOL)*&
35052 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
35053 chunk of memory whose size is given by the first argument.
35054 The second argument should be given as TRUE if the memory will be used for
35055 data possibly coming from an attacker (eg. the message content),
35056 FALSE if it is locally-sourced.
35057 Exim bombs out if it ever
35058 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
35061 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int,BOOL)*&
35062 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
35063 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
35065 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
35068 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
35071 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
35072 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
35073 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
35074 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
35075 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
35076 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
35082 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
35083 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
35084 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
35085 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
35086 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
35087 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
35088 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
35091 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
35092 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
35093 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
35094 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
35096 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
35097 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
35099 store_pool = POOL_PERM
35101 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
35102 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
35103 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
35104 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
35106 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
35107 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
35108 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
35109 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
35116 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35117 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35119 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
35120 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
35121 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
35122 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
35123 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
35124 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
35125 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
35126 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
35128 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
35129 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
35130 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
35131 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
35132 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
35134 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
35135 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
35136 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
35137 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
35138 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
35139 prevent it happening on retries.
35141 .vindex "&$domain$&"
35142 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
35143 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
35144 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
35145 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
35146 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
35147 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
35148 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
35151 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
35152 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
35153 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
35154 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
35155 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
35156 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
35157 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
35159 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
35160 system_filter_user = exim
35162 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
35163 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
35164 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
35165 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
35166 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
35167 by the &%reply%& command.
35170 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
35171 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
35172 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
35173 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
35175 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
35176 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
35180 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
35181 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
35182 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
35183 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
35184 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
35185 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
35188 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
35189 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
35190 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
35191 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
35192 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
35193 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
35194 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
35196 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
35197 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
35198 succeed, it will not be tried again.
35199 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
35200 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
35202 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
35203 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
35204 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
35205 to which users' filter files can refer.
35209 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
35210 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
35211 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
35212 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
35213 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
35217 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
35218 .cindex "freezing messages"
35219 .cindex "message" "freezing"
35220 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
35221 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
35222 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
35223 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
35224 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
35225 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
35226 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
35227 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
35228 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
35230 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
35232 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
35234 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
35235 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
35236 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
35237 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
35238 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
35241 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
35242 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
35243 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
35244 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
35246 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
35247 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
35248 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
35249 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
35250 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
35251 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
35252 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
35253 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
35254 message. For example:
35256 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
35257 because it contains attachments that we are \
35258 not prepared to receive."
35261 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
35262 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
35263 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
35264 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
35265 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
35266 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
35269 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
35270 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
35272 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
35273 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
35274 generated by the filter.
35276 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
35278 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
35279 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
35285 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
35286 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
35291 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
35292 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
35293 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
35294 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
35295 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
35297 headers add <string>
35298 headers remove <string>
35300 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
35301 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
35302 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
35303 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
35304 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
35306 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
35307 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
35308 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
35311 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
35312 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
35315 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
35316 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
35317 space after input continuations is ignored.
35319 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
35320 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
35321 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
35322 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
35323 header with the same name, they are all removed.
35325 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
35326 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
35327 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
35328 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
35329 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
35330 used for all recipients of the message.
35332 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
35333 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
35334 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
35335 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
35336 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
35337 until the message is actually being written (see section
35338 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
35340 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
35341 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
35342 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
35343 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
35344 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
35345 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
35346 modified more than once.
35348 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
35349 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
35352 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
35353 headers remove "Subject"
35354 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
35355 headers remove "Old-Subject"
35360 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
35361 .cindex "envelope from"
35362 .cindex "envelope sender"
35363 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
35365 errors_to <some address>
35367 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
35368 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
35369 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
35372 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
35374 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
35375 address if its delivery failed.
35379 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
35380 .vindex "&$domain$&"
35381 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
35382 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
35383 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
35384 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
35385 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
35386 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
35387 which implements such a filter:
35392 domains = +local_domains
35393 file = /central/filters/$local_part_data
35398 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
35399 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
35400 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
35401 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
35403 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
35404 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
35405 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
35406 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
35408 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
35409 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
35410 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
35417 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35418 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35420 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
35421 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
35422 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
35423 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
35424 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
35425 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
35426 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
35427 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
35429 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
35430 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
35431 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
35432 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
35433 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
35435 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
35436 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
35437 loopback interface specially in any way.
35439 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
35440 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
35445 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
35446 .cindex "message" "submission"
35447 .cindex "submission mode"
35448 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
35449 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
35450 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
35451 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
35453 control = submission
35455 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
35456 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
35457 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
35458 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
35459 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
35460 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
35462 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
35463 control = submission
35465 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
35466 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
35467 is used to separate options. For example:
35469 control = submission/sender_retain
35471 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
35472 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
35473 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
35474 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
35475 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
35476 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
35477 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
35479 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
35480 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
35483 control = submission/domain=some.domain
35485 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
35486 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
35487 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
35488 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
35490 accept authenticated = *
35491 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
35492 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
35493 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
35495 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
35496 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
35497 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
35499 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
35501 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
35504 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
35506 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
35507 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
35508 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
35509 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
35511 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
35512 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
35513 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
35514 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
35515 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
35516 spoof another's address.
35518 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
35519 .cindex "line endings"
35520 .cindex "carriage return"
35522 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
35523 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
35524 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
35525 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
35526 use CRLF or just CR.
35528 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
35529 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
35530 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
35531 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
35532 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
35533 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
35534 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
35535 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
35539 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
35541 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
35544 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
35545 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
35548 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
35549 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
35550 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
35551 people trying to play silly games.
35553 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
35554 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
35562 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
35563 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
35564 .cindex "address" "qualification"
35565 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
35566 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
35567 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
35568 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
35569 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
35571 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
35572 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
35573 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
35574 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
35575 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
35577 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
35578 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
35579 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
35580 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
35581 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
35582 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
35583 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
35584 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
35589 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
35590 .cindex "&""From""& line"
35591 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
35592 .cindex "sender" "address"
35593 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
35594 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
35595 .cindex "envelope from"
35596 .cindex "envelope sender"
35597 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
35598 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
35599 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
35600 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
35602 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
35603 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
35605 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
35606 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
35607 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
35608 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
35609 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
35610 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
35611 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
35612 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
35613 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
35615 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
35616 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
35617 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
35618 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
35619 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
35620 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
35621 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
35623 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
35624 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
35625 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
35627 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
35628 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
35629 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
35630 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
35634 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
35635 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
35636 .cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
35637 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
35638 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
35639 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
35640 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
35641 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
35644 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
35645 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
35648 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
35649 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
35653 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
35654 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
35656 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
35657 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
35658 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
35660 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
35663 For a locally-submitted message,
35664 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
35665 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
35666 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
35667 included in log lines in this case.
35669 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
35670 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
35676 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
35677 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
35678 includes the header line:
35680 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
35683 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
35684 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
35685 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
35686 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
35687 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
35688 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
35691 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
35692 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
35693 .cindex "header lines" "Date:"
35694 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
35695 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
35696 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
35698 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
35699 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
35700 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
35701 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
35702 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
35703 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
35704 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
35705 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
35709 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
35710 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
35711 .cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
35712 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
35713 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
35714 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
35715 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
35716 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
35717 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
35721 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
35722 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
35723 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
35724 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
35725 .cindex "message" "submission"
35726 .cindex "submission mode"
35727 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
35728 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
35731 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
35732 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
35734 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
35735 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
35737 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
35738 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
35739 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
35741 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
35742 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
35744 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
35745 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
35749 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
35751 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
35752 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
35753 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
35754 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
35755 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
35756 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
35757 &%qualify_domain%&.
35759 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
35760 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
35761 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
35762 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
35765 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
35766 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
35767 .cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
35768 .cindex "message" "submission"
35769 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
35770 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
35771 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
35772 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
35773 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
35774 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
35775 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
35776 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
35777 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
35778 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
35781 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
35782 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
35783 .cindex "header lines" "Received:"
35784 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
35785 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
35786 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
35788 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
35789 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
35790 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
35791 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
35793 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
35794 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
35795 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
35798 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
35799 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
35800 .cindex "header lines" "References:"
35801 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
35802 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
35803 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
35804 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
35805 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
35806 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
35807 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
35808 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
35809 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
35813 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
35814 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
35815 .cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
35816 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
35817 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
35818 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
35819 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
35820 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
35821 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
35825 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
35826 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
35827 .cindex "message" "submission"
35828 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
35829 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
35830 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
35831 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
35832 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
35835 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
35836 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
35837 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
35838 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
35839 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
35840 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
35841 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
35842 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
35843 line is added to the message.
35845 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
35846 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
35847 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
35848 options true at the same time.
35850 .cindex "submission mode"
35851 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
35852 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
35853 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
35854 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
35856 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
35857 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
35858 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
35859 created as follows:
35862 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
35863 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
35864 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
35866 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
35867 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
35869 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
35870 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
35873 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
35874 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
35875 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
35876 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
35878 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
35879 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
35880 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
35881 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
35885 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
35886 "SECTheadersaddrem"
35887 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
35888 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
35889 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
35890 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
35891 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
35892 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
35893 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
35895 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
35896 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
35897 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
35898 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
35899 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
35900 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
35902 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
35903 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
35904 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
35906 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
35907 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
35908 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
35910 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
35911 X-added-second: another added header line
35913 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
35915 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
35916 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
35917 Each header-line is separately expanded.
35919 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
35920 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
35921 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
35922 not part of the names. For example:
35924 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
35927 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
35928 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
35929 Each item is separately expanded.
35930 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
35931 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
35932 will act as list separators.
35934 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
35935 items are expanded at routing time,
35936 and then associated with all addresses that are
35937 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
35938 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
35939 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
35941 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
35942 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
35943 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
35944 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
35946 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
35947 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
35948 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
35951 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
35952 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
35953 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
35954 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
35955 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
35956 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
35957 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
35959 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
35960 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
35961 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
35962 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
35964 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
35965 the following consequences:
35968 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
35969 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
35970 to it, at all times.
35972 Header lines that are added by a router's
35973 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
35974 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
35976 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
35977 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
35979 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
35980 a later router or by a transport.
35982 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
35983 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
35985 headers_remove = subject
35986 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
35990 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
35991 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
35997 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
35998 .cindex "address" "constructed"
35999 .cindex "constructed address"
36000 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
36003 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
36007 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
36009 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
36010 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
36011 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
36012 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
36013 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
36014 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
36015 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
36016 there is no password file entry.
36019 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
36020 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
36021 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
36022 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
36023 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
36024 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
36025 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
36026 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
36030 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
36031 .cindex "case of local parts"
36032 .cindex "local part" "case of"
36033 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
36034 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
36035 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
36036 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
36037 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
36038 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
36041 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
36042 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
36043 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
36044 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
36045 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
36049 domains = +local_domains
36050 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
36051 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
36054 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
36055 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
36056 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
36057 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
36058 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
36062 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
36063 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
36064 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
36065 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
36066 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
36067 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
36068 empty components for compatibility.
36072 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
36073 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
36074 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
36075 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
36076 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
36077 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
36079 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
36080 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
36081 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
36082 example, a header such as
36086 might get rewritten as
36088 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
36090 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
36091 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
36094 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
36095 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
36096 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
36097 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
36098 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
36099 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
36100 .ecindex IIDmesproc
36104 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36105 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36107 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
36108 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
36109 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
36110 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
36111 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
36112 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
36113 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
36116 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
36118 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
36120 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
36123 For mail delivery, the following are available:
36126 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
36128 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
36131 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
36134 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
36135 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
36138 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
36139 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
36140 used to contain the envelope information.
36144 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
36145 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
36146 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
36147 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
36148 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
36151 .cindex "SIZE" "option on MAIL command"
36152 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
36153 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
36154 processing is the same in both cases.
36156 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SIZE
36157 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
36158 extension is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
36159 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
36160 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
36161 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
36162 .cindex "transport" "filter"
36163 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
36164 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
36167 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
36168 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
36169 required for the transaction.
36171 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
36172 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
36173 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
36174 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
36175 is called for verification.
36177 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
36178 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
36179 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
36181 .cindex "carriage return"
36183 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
36184 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
36185 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
36188 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
36189 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
36190 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
36191 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
36192 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
36193 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
36194 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
36195 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
36196 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
36198 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
36199 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
36200 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
36201 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
36203 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
36204 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
36205 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
36206 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
36208 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
36209 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
36210 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
36211 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
36212 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
36213 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
36214 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
36215 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
36216 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
36217 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
36219 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
36220 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
36222 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
36223 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
36224 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
36225 square bracket of the IP address.
36230 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
36231 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
36232 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
36233 .cindex "host" "error"
36234 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
36235 message errors, and recipient errors.
36238 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
36239 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
36240 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
36243 Connection refused or timed out,
36245 Any error response code on connection,
36247 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
36249 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
36251 I/O errors at any time,
36253 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
36254 the &"."& at the end of the data.
36257 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
36258 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
36259 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
36260 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
36261 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
36262 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
36263 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
36264 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
36266 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
36267 .cindex "message" "error"
36268 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
36269 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
36270 message errors are:
36273 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
36276 Timeout after MAIL,
36278 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
36279 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
36280 connection at any other time.
36283 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
36284 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
36285 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
36286 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
36287 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
36288 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
36289 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
36290 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
36291 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
36292 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
36294 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
36295 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
36296 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
36299 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
36300 .cindex "recipient" "error"
36301 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
36302 recipient errors are:
36305 Any error response to RCPT,
36307 Timeout after RCPT.
36310 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
36311 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
36312 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
36313 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
36314 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
36315 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
36316 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
36317 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
36318 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
36319 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
36320 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
36321 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
36322 the retry clock is reset.
36324 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
36325 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
36326 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
36327 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
36328 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
36329 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
36330 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
36331 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
36332 recipient's retry time.
36335 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
36336 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
36337 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
36338 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
36339 until the next delivery attempt.
36341 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
36342 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
36343 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
36344 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
36345 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
36348 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
36349 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
36350 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
36351 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
36352 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
36353 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
36354 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
36356 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
36357 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
36358 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
36359 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
36360 then to be treated as a host error.
36362 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
36363 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
36364 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
36365 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
36366 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
36371 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
36372 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
36373 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
36376 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
36377 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
36378 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
36380 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
36382 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
36383 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
36384 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
36385 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
36386 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
36387 stream and exits with an error code.
36389 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
36390 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
36391 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
36392 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
36394 .cindex "carriage return"
36396 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
36397 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
36398 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
36400 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
36401 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
36402 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
36404 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
36405 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
36406 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
36407 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
36408 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
36409 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
36410 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
36411 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
36413 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
36414 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
36415 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
36416 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
36417 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
36418 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
36419 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
36420 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
36421 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
36423 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
36424 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
36425 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
36427 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
36428 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
36429 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
36430 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
36431 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
36433 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
36434 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
36435 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
36436 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
36437 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
36438 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
36439 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
36441 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
36442 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
36443 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
36444 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
36445 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
36447 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
36448 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
36449 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
36450 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
36451 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
36452 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
36453 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
36454 a delivery process.
36456 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
36457 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
36458 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
36459 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
36460 however, available with &'inetd'&.
36462 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
36463 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
36464 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
36465 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
36467 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
36468 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
36469 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
36473 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
36474 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
36475 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
36476 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
36477 the error response to the last command. The default value for
36478 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
36479 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
36480 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
36483 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
36484 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
36485 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
36486 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
36487 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
36488 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
36489 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
36490 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
36491 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
36492 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
36493 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
36497 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
36498 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
36499 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
36500 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
36501 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
36502 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
36503 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
36504 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
36506 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
36507 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
36508 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
36509 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
36510 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
36513 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
36514 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
36515 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
36517 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
36518 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
36519 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
36520 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
36521 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
36526 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
36527 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
36528 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
36529 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
36531 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
36532 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
36533 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
36534 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
36535 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
36536 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
36537 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
36538 SMTP response codes.
36540 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
36541 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
36542 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
36543 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
36544 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
36545 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
36546 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
36547 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
36552 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
36553 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
36554 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ETRN
36555 RFC 1985 describes an ESMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
36556 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
36557 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
36558 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
36559 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
36561 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
36562 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
36563 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
36564 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
36565 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
36566 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
36567 argument. For example,
36575 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
36576 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
36577 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
36578 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
36579 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
36581 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
36582 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
36583 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
36584 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
36585 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
36586 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
36587 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
36588 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
36590 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
36591 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
36592 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
36593 whatever the form of its argument. For
36596 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
36597 $sender_host_address
36599 .vindex "&$domain$&"
36600 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
36601 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
36602 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
36603 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
36604 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
36605 for it to change them before running the command.
36609 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
36610 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
36611 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
36612 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
36613 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
36614 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
36615 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
36616 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
36617 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
36618 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
36619 runs for RCPT commands:
36623 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
36627 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
36628 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
36629 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
36630 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
36631 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
36632 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
36633 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
36634 envelope along with the message.
36636 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
36637 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
36638 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
36639 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
36640 can be used to specify it.
36642 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
36643 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
36644 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
36645 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
36646 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
36649 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
36650 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
36651 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
36656 driver = manualroute
36657 transport = smtp_appendfile
36658 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
36662 driver = appendfile
36663 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
36668 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
36669 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
36670 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
36674 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
36675 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
36676 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
36677 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
36678 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
36679 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
36680 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
36681 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
36682 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
36683 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
36685 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
36686 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
36688 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
36689 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
36690 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
36691 make some use of automatically, for example:
36693 554 Unexpected end of file
36694 Transaction started in line 10
36695 Error detected in line 14
36697 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
36700 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
36701 The error message was:
36703 501 '>' missing at end of address
36705 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
36706 The error was detected in line 12.
36707 The SMTP command at fault was:
36709 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
36711 1 previous message was successfully processed.
36712 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
36714 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
36715 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
36717 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
36718 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
36722 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36723 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36725 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
36726 "Customizing messages"
36727 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
36728 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
36729 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
36730 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
36731 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
36733 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
36734 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
36735 option. Exim also adds the line
36737 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
36739 to all warning and bounce messages,
36742 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
36743 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
36744 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
36745 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
36746 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
36747 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
36748 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
36750 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
36751 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
36752 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
36753 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
36754 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
36757 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
36758 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
36759 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
36760 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
36761 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
36762 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
36763 option, rounded to a whole number.
36765 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
36768 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
36769 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
36771 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
36772 failing addresses with their error messages.
36774 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
36775 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
36777 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
36778 The fields exist for back-compatibility
36781 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
36782 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
36783 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
36785 Subject: Mail delivery failed
36786 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
36787 {: returning message to sender}}
36789 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
36791 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
36792 {that you sent }{sent by
36796 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
36797 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
36799 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
36801 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
36804 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
36806 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
36809 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
36810 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
36811 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
36812 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
36813 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
36817 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
36818 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
36820 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
36821 the delayed addresses.
36823 The third item then ends the message.
36826 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
36827 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
36829 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
36830 $warn_message_delay
36832 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
36834 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
36835 {that you sent }{sent by
36839 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
36840 more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
36842 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
36843 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
36844 The date of the message is: $h_date
36846 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
36848 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
36849 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
36850 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
36851 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
36852 the message will be returned to you.
36854 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
36855 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
36856 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
36857 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
36858 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
36859 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
36860 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
36861 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
36867 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36868 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36870 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
36871 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
36872 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
36876 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
36877 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
36878 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
36879 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
36880 routing explicitly:
36882 send_to_smart_host:
36883 driver = manualroute
36884 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
36885 transport = remote_smtp
36887 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
36888 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
36889 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
36890 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
36891 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
36896 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
36897 .cindex "mailing lists"
36898 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
36899 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
36900 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
36902 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
36903 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
36904 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
36905 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
36909 domains = lists.example
36910 file = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
36913 errors_to = ${quote_local_part:$local_part-request}@lists.example
36916 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
36917 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
36918 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
36919 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
36921 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
36922 expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
36925 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
36926 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
36927 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
36928 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
36929 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
36931 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
36932 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
36933 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
36934 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
36935 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
36936 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
36937 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
36938 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
36939 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
36943 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
36944 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
36945 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
36946 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
36947 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
36948 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
36949 addresses are not rigorously checked.
36951 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
36952 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
36953 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
36954 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
36955 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
36959 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
36960 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
36961 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
36962 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
36963 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
36964 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
36965 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
36966 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
36967 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
36968 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
36970 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
36971 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
36972 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
36973 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
36974 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
36975 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
36976 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
36977 pre-existing messages.
36979 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
36980 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
36981 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
36982 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
36983 one level of expansion anyway.
36987 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
36988 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
36989 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
36990 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
36991 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
36992 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
36994 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
36995 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
36999 domains = lists.example
37000 local_part_suffix = -request
37001 local_parts = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,filter=file {/usr/lists}}
37002 file = /usr/lists/${local_part_data}-request
37007 domains = lists.example
37008 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
37009 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
37010 file = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
37013 errors_to = ${quote_local_part:$local_part-request}@lists.example
37018 domains = lists.example
37020 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
37022 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
37023 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
37024 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
37027 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
37028 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
37029 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
37030 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
37031 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
37032 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
37033 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
37034 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
37035 &"unrouteable address"& error.
37037 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
37038 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
37039 the address, giving a suitable error message.
37044 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
37046 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
37047 .cindex "envelope from"
37048 .cindex "envelope sender"
37049 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
37050 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
37051 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
37052 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
37053 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
37054 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
37056 .oindex &%errors_to%&
37057 .oindex &%return_path%&
37058 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
37059 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
37060 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
37061 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
37062 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
37063 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
37064 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
37070 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
37071 {${quote_local_part:$1-request+$local_part=$domain}@your.dom.example}fail}
37073 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
37074 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
37075 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
37076 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
37077 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
37078 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
37079 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
37082 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
37084 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
37085 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
37086 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
37087 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
37088 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
37089 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
37091 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
37092 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
37093 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
37094 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
37098 domains = ! +local_domains
37100 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
37101 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
37104 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
37105 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
37106 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
37107 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
37110 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
37111 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
37112 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
37113 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
37114 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
37118 domains = ! +local_domains
37119 transport = remote_smtp
37121 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
37122 {${quote_local_part:$1-request+$local_part=$domain}@your.dom.example}fail}
37125 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
37126 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
37127 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
37128 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
37131 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
37132 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
37133 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
37134 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
37135 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
37136 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
37144 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
37145 .cindex "virtual domains"
37146 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
37147 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
37151 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
37152 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
37153 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
37155 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
37156 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
37157 have login accounts on that host.
37160 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
37161 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
37162 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
37163 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
37164 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
37165 to a router of this form:
37169 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
37170 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain_data}}
37174 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
37175 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
37176 domain that is being processed.
37177 The &(dsearch)& lookup used results in an untainted version of &$domain$&
37178 being placed into the &$domain_data$& variable.
37181 When the router runs, it looks up the local
37182 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
37183 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
37184 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
37186 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
37187 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
37188 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
37189 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
37191 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
37192 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
37193 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
37197 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
37198 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
37199 transport = my_mailboxes
37201 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
37202 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
37203 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
37204 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
37205 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
37209 driver = appendfile
37210 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part_data
37213 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
37214 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
37216 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
37217 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
37218 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
37219 information about the domains.
37223 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
37224 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
37225 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
37226 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
37227 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
37228 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
37229 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
37230 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
37231 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
37232 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
37233 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
37234 example, consider this router:
37239 file = $home/.forward
37240 local_part_suffix = -*
37241 local_part_suffix_optional
37244 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
37245 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
37246 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
37247 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
37249 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
37250 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
37253 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
37254 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
37255 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
37256 control over which suffixes are valid.
37258 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
37259 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
37265 local_part_suffix = -*
37266 local_part_suffix_optional
37267 file = ${lookup {.forward$local_part_suffix} dsearch,ret=full {$home} {$value}fail}
37270 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
37271 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
37272 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
37273 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
37274 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
37278 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
37279 .cindex "vacation processing"
37280 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
37281 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
37282 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
37283 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
37284 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
37287 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
37288 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
37289 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
37290 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
37292 spqr, vacation-spqr
37295 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
37296 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
37297 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
37298 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
37299 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
37303 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
37304 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
37308 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
37309 .cindex "message" "copying every"
37310 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
37311 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
37312 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
37313 each day's messages.
37315 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
37316 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
37317 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
37318 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
37322 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
37323 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
37324 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
37325 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
37326 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
37327 permanently connected.
37329 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
37330 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
37331 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
37334 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
37335 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
37336 host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
37337 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
37338 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
37339 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
37340 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
37341 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
37343 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
37344 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
37345 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
37346 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
37347 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
37348 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
37351 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
37352 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
37353 intermittent host. For example:
37355 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
37357 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
37358 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
37359 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
37360 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
37361 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
37362 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
37365 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
37366 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
37367 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
37368 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
37369 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
37370 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
37371 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
37375 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
37376 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
37377 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
37378 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
37379 delivered immediately.
37381 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
37382 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
37383 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
37384 .cindex "first pass routing"
37385 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
37386 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
37387 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
37388 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
37389 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
37390 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
37391 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
37392 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
37393 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
37394 single SMTP connection.
37398 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37399 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37401 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
37402 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
37403 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
37404 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
37405 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
37406 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
37407 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
37408 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
37409 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
37410 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
37413 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
37414 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
37415 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
37416 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
37417 email is not desirable.
37419 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
37420 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
37421 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
37422 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
37423 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
37424 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
37425 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
37427 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
37428 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
37429 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
37430 before sending a message to the smart host.
37432 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
37433 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
37434 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
37436 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
37437 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
37438 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
37439 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
37440 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
37441 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
37442 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
37444 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
37448 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
37449 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
37451 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
37452 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
37453 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
37454 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
37455 successful, a zero return code is given.
37457 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
37458 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
37459 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
37460 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
37461 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
37464 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
37465 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
37466 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
37468 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
37469 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
37470 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
37471 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
37472 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
37474 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
37475 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
37476 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
37478 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
37479 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
37480 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
37481 are ever generated.
37483 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
37485 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
37486 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
37487 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
37490 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
37491 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
37492 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
37493 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
37494 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
37495 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
37500 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37501 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37503 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
37504 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
37505 .cindex "log" "types of"
37506 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
37511 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
37512 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
37513 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
37514 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
37515 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
37516 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
37517 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
37518 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
37520 .cindex "reject log"
37521 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
37522 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
37523 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
37524 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
37525 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
37526 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
37527 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
37528 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
37529 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
37532 .cindex "panic log"
37533 .cindex "system log"
37534 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
37535 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
37536 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
37537 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
37538 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
37539 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
37540 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
37541 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
37542 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
37545 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
37546 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
37547 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
37549 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
37552 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
37553 ways of changing this:
37556 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
37561 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
37563 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
37566 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
37570 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
37571 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
37572 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
37573 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
37574 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
37575 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
37580 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
37581 .cindex "log" "destination"
37582 .cindex "log" "to file"
37583 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
37585 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
37586 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
37587 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
37588 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
37589 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
37590 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
37591 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
37593 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
37594 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
37595 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
37596 references to the host name:
37598 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
37600 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
37601 rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
37602 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
37603 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
37604 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
37607 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
37608 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
37609 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
37610 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
37611 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
37612 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
37613 implying the use of a default path.
37615 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
37616 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
37617 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
37618 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
37619 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
37620 equivalent to the setting:
37622 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
37624 If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
37625 or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
37626 that is where the logs are written.
37628 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
37629 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
37631 Here are some examples of possible settings:
37633 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
37634 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
37635 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
37636 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
37638 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
37643 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
37644 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
37645 .cindex "cycling logs"
37646 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
37647 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
37648 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
37649 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
37650 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
37651 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
37652 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
37654 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
37655 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
37656 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
37657 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
37658 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
37659 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
37660 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
37661 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
37662 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
37663 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
37664 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
37669 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
37670 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
37671 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
37672 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
37673 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
37674 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
37675 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
37676 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
37678 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
37679 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
37680 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
37681 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
37683 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
37684 examples of names generated by the above examples:
37686 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
37687 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
37688 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
37689 /var/log/exim/main.200212
37691 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
37692 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
37693 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
37694 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
37696 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
37697 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
37698 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
37699 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
37700 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
37701 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
37704 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
37705 /var/log/exim-panic.log
37706 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
37707 /var/log/exim/panic
37711 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
37712 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
37713 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
37714 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
37715 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
37716 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
37717 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
37718 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
37719 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
37720 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
37721 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
37722 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
37723 the time and host name to each line.
37724 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
37727 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
37729 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
37731 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
37734 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
37735 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
37736 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
37737 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
37739 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
37740 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
37741 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
37742 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
37743 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
37744 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
37745 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
37746 RFC 3164, you should set
37748 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
37750 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
37751 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
37753 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
37754 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
37755 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
37756 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
37757 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
37758 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
37759 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
37760 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
37761 name, and pid as added by syslog:
37763 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
37764 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
37765 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
37766 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
37769 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
37772 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
37773 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
37774 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
37775 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
37777 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
37778 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
37779 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
37780 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
37781 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
37782 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
37784 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
37785 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
37786 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
37789 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
37791 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
37792 without modification.
37794 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
37795 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
37796 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
37801 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
37802 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
37803 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
37804 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
37805 timestamp. The flags are:
37807 &`<=`& message arrival
37808 &`(=`& message fakereject
37809 &`=>`& normal message delivery
37810 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
37811 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
37812 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
37813 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
37814 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
37818 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
37819 .cindex "log" "reception line"
37820 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37821 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
37822 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
37824 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
37825 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
37826 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
37828 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
37829 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
37830 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
37834 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
37838 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
37839 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
37840 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
37841 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
37842 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
37843 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
37844 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
37845 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
37846 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
37847 name in parentheses.
37849 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
37850 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
37851 the log containing text like these examples:
37853 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
37854 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
37856 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
37859 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
37860 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
37863 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
37864 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
37865 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
37866 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
37867 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
37868 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
37869 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
37870 suite that was used.
37872 .cindex log protocol
37873 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
37874 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
37875 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
37876 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
37877 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
37878 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
37879 authenticator name.
37881 .cindex "size" "of message"
37882 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
37883 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
37884 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
37885 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
37888 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37889 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37893 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
37894 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
37895 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37896 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
37897 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
37898 to fit it on the page:
37900 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
37901 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
37902 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
37903 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
37904 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
37906 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
37907 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
37908 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
37909 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
37910 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
37912 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
37913 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
37914 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
37915 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
37917 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
37918 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
37920 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
37922 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
37923 parentheses afterwards.
37925 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
37926 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
37927 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
37928 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
37929 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
37930 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37931 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
37932 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
37933 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37934 TLS cipher information is still available.
37936 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
37937 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
37938 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
37939 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
37940 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
37942 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
37943 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
37945 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37946 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37949 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
37950 .cindex "discarded messages"
37951 .cindex "message" "discarded"
37952 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
37953 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
37954 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
37956 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
37957 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
37959 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
37960 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
37962 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
37963 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
37967 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
37968 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
37970 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
37971 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
37973 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
37974 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
37975 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
37977 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
37978 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
37980 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
37981 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
37982 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
37986 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
37987 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
37988 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
37989 following form is logged:
37991 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
37992 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
37994 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
37995 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
37997 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
37998 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
37999 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
38000 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
38001 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
38003 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
38004 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
38005 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
38006 flagged with &`**`&.
38010 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
38011 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
38012 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
38013 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
38014 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
38018 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
38021 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
38023 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
38024 at the end of its processing.
38029 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
38030 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
38031 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
38032 the following table:
38034 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
38035 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
38036 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
38037 &`CV `& certificate verification status
38038 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
38039 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
38040 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
38041 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
38042 &`DT `& on &`=>`&, &'=='& and &'**'& lines: time taken for, or to attempt, a delivery
38043 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
38044 &`H `& host name and IP address
38045 &`I `& local interface used
38046 &`id `& message id (from header) for incoming message
38047 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
38048 &`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
38049 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
38050 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
38051 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
38052 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
38053 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
38054 &`Q `& alternate queue name
38055 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
38056 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
38057 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
38058 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
38059 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
38060 &`S `& size of message in bytes
38061 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
38062 &`ST `& shadow transport name
38063 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
38064 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
38065 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
38066 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
38067 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
38071 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
38072 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
38073 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
38076 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
38077 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
38078 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
38079 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
38080 during the first delivery attempt.
38082 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
38083 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
38084 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
38086 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
38087 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
38088 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
38089 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
38090 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
38093 .cindex "error" "ignored"
38094 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
38097 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
38098 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
38100 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
38101 failed. The delivery was discarded.
38103 A delivery set up by a router configured with
38104 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
38105 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
38109 failed. The delivery was discarded.
38112 .cindex DKIM "log line"
38113 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
38114 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
38121 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
38122 .cindex "log" "selectors"
38123 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
38124 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
38125 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
38128 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
38130 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
38131 selection marked by asterisks:
38133 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
38134 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
38135 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
38136 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
38137 &` arguments `& command line arguments
38138 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
38139 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
38140 &` deliver_time `& time taken to attempt delivery
38141 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
38142 &`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
38143 &` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
38144 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
38145 &` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
38146 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
38147 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
38148 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
38149 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
38150 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
38151 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
38152 &` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
38153 &`*msg_id `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value
38154 &` msg_id_created `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value when one had to be added
38155 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
38156 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
38157 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
38158 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
38159 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
38160 &` pid `& Exim process id
38161 &` pipelining `& PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines
38162 &` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
38163 &` receive_time `& time taken to receive message
38164 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
38165 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
38166 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
38167 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
38168 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
38169 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
38170 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
38171 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
38172 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
38173 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
38174 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
38175 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
38176 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
38177 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
38178 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
38179 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
38180 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
38181 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
38182 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
38183 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
38184 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
38185 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
38187 &` all `& all of the above
38189 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
38190 section &<<SECID99>>&
38192 More details on each of these items follows:
38196 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
38197 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
38198 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
38199 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
38200 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
38201 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
38203 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
38204 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
38205 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
38206 this log selector is set.
38208 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
38209 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
38210 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
38211 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
38212 such users cannot access the log).
38214 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
38215 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
38216 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
38217 parentheses between them.
38219 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
38220 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
38221 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
38222 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
38223 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
38224 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
38225 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
38226 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
38227 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
38228 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
38229 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
38230 between the caller and Exim.
38232 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
38233 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
38234 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
38236 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
38237 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
38238 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
38239 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
38240 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
38241 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
38243 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
38244 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
38245 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
38246 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
38247 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
38249 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
38250 .cindex "size" "of message"
38251 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
38252 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
38254 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
38255 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
38256 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
38257 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
38259 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
38260 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
38261 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
38263 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
38264 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
38265 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
38266 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
38267 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
38270 .cindex dnssec logging
38271 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
38272 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
38273 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
38274 It does not cover helo-name verification.
38275 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
38277 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
38278 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
38279 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
38280 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
38281 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
38282 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
38284 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
38285 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
38286 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
38287 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
38288 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
38290 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
38291 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
38292 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
38293 client's ident port times out.
38295 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
38296 .cindex "log" "local interface"
38297 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
38298 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
38299 .cindex "interface" "logging"
38300 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
38301 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
38302 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
38303 added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
38304 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
38305 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
38307 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
38308 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
38309 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
38310 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
38311 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
38312 on a proxied connection
38313 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
38314 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
38316 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
38317 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
38318 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
38319 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
38320 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
38321 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
38322 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
38323 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
38324 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
38325 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
38326 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
38328 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
38329 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
38330 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
38332 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
38333 .cindex millisecond logging
38334 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
38335 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
38336 appended to the seconds value.
38338 .cindex "log" "message id"
38339 &%msg_id%&: The value of the Message-ID: header.
38341 &%msg_id_created%&: The value of the Message-ID: header, when one had to be created.
38342 This will be either because the message is a bounce, or was submitted locally
38343 (submission mode) without one.
38344 The field identifier will have an asterix appended: &"id*="&.
38346 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
38347 .cindex "log" "local interface"
38348 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
38349 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
38350 .cindex "interface" "logging"
38351 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
38352 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
38353 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
38354 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
38356 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
38357 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
38358 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
38359 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
38360 containing => tags) following the IP address.
38361 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
38362 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
38363 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
38364 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
38365 local port is a random ephemeral port.
38367 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
38368 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
38369 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
38370 immediately after the time and date.
38372 .cindex log pipelining
38373 .cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
38374 &%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
38375 log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
38376 The field is a single "L".
38378 On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
38379 the field has a minus appended.
38381 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
38382 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
38383 accept "L" fields have a period appended if the feature was
38384 offered but not used, or an asterisk appended if used.
38385 Delivery "L" fields have an asterisk appended if used.
38388 .cindex "log" "queue run"
38389 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
38390 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
38392 .cindex "log" "queue time"
38393 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
38394 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
38395 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
38396 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
38397 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
38398 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
38399 message has been successfully received.
38400 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
38401 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
38403 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
38404 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
38405 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
38406 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
38408 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
38409 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
38410 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
38411 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
38412 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
38414 .cindex "log" "recipients"
38415 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
38416 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
38417 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
38418 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
38420 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
38423 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
38424 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
38425 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
38426 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
38428 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
38429 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
38430 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
38431 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
38432 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
38434 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
38435 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
38436 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
38437 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
38440 .cindex "log" "return path"
38441 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
38442 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
38443 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
38444 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
38446 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
38447 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
38448 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
38449 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
38450 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
38452 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
38453 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
38454 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
38455 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
38458 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
38459 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
38462 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
38463 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
38464 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
38465 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
38467 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
38468 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
38470 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
38471 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
38472 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
38473 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
38474 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
38475 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
38478 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
38479 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
38480 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
38481 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
38482 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
38483 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
38484 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
38485 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
38486 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
38487 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
38489 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
38490 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
38491 reset if the daemon is restarted.
38492 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
38493 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
38494 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
38495 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
38496 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
38498 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
38499 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
38500 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
38501 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
38502 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
38503 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
38505 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
38506 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
38507 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
38508 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
38509 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
38510 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
38511 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
38512 already have their own log lines.
38514 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
38515 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
38516 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
38517 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
38518 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
38519 the same logging options.
38521 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
38522 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
38526 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
38527 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
38528 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
38529 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
38530 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
38532 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
38533 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
38534 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
38535 was accepted or used.
38537 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
38538 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
38539 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
38540 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
38541 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
38542 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
38543 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
38544 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
38546 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
38547 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
38548 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
38549 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
38550 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
38551 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
38552 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
38553 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
38554 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
38556 .cindex "log" "subject"
38557 .cindex "subject, logging"
38558 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
38559 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
38560 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
38561 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
38562 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
38564 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
38566 .cindex DANE logging
38567 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
38568 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
38570 using a CA trust anchor,
38571 &`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
38572 and &`CV=no`& if not.
38574 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
38575 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
38576 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
38577 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
38579 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
38580 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
38581 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
38582 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
38583 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
38585 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
38586 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
38587 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
38588 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
38589 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
38591 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
38592 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
38593 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
38597 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
38598 .cindex "message" "log file for"
38599 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
38600 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
38601 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
38602 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
38603 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
38604 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
38605 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
38606 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
38607 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
38608 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
38609 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
38611 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
38612 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
38613 &%message_logs%& option false.
38619 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38620 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38622 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
38623 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
38624 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
38625 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
38626 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
38628 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
38629 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
38630 "list what Exim processes are doing"
38631 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
38632 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
38633 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
38634 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
38636 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
38637 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
38638 "extract statistics from the log"
38639 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
38640 "check address acceptance from given IP"
38641 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
38642 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
38643 .irow &<<SECTdumpdb>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
38644 .irow &<<SECTtidydb>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
38645 .irow &<<SECTfixdb>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
38646 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
38649 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
38650 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
38651 &url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
38656 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
38657 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
38658 .cindex "process, querying"
38660 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
38661 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
38662 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
38663 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
38664 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
38665 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
38666 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
38667 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
38669 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
38670 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
38671 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
38674 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
38675 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
38676 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
38677 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
38678 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
38681 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
38682 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
38683 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
38684 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
38686 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
38688 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
38689 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
38690 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
38691 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
38692 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
38693 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
38695 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
38696 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
38700 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
38701 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
38702 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
38703 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
38707 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
38711 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
38712 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
38714 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
38715 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
38718 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
38719 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
38720 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
38724 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
38725 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
38726 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
38728 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
38729 Match against the size field.
38731 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
38732 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
38734 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
38735 Match messages that are older than the given time.
38738 Match only frozen messages.
38741 Match only non-frozen messages.
38743 .vitem &*-G*&&~<&'queuename'&>
38744 Match only messages in the given queue. Without this, the default queue is searched.
38747 The following options control the format of the output:
38751 Display only the count of matching messages.
38754 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
38758 Display message ids only.
38761 Brief format &-- one line per message.
38764 Display messages in reverse order.
38767 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
38770 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
38774 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
38775 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
38776 .cindex "queue" "summary"
38777 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
38778 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
38779 running a command such as
38781 exim -bp | exiqsumm
38783 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
38784 it, as in the following example:
38786 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
38788 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
38789 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
38790 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
38791 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
38793 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
38794 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
38795 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
38796 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
38797 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
38798 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
38801 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
38802 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
38803 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
38804 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
38805 level"& addresses).
38810 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
38812 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
38813 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
38814 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
38815 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
38816 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
38817 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
38818 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
38819 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
38820 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
38821 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
38823 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
38825 If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
38827 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
38828 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
38829 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
38831 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
38832 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
38833 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
38834 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
38835 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
38837 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
38838 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
38839 regular expression.
38841 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
38842 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
38844 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
38845 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
38849 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
38850 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
38851 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
38852 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
38853 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
38854 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
38857 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
38858 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
38859 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
38860 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
38861 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
38864 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
38865 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
38866 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
38867 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
38868 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
38869 the &%--help%& option.
38872 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
38873 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
38874 .cindex "cycling logs"
38875 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
38876 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
38877 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
38878 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
38879 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
38880 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
38881 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
38883 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
38884 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
38886 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
38887 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
38888 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
38892 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
38893 the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
38894 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
38895 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
38896 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
38897 logs are handled similarly.
38899 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
38900 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
38901 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
38902 any existing log files.
38904 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
38905 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
38906 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
38907 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
38908 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
38910 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
38912 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
38913 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
38917 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
38918 .cindex "statistics"
38919 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
38920 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
38921 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
38922 . --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
38923 . --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
38925 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
38926 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
38927 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
38928 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
38929 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
38931 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
38933 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
38934 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
38935 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
38936 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
38937 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
38938 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
38939 also produced per user.
38941 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
38942 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
38943 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
38944 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
38945 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
38947 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
38948 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
38949 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
38950 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
38951 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
38952 an entirely separate message.
38954 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
38955 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
38956 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
38957 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
38958 least one address that failed.
38960 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
38961 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
38962 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
38963 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
38964 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
38965 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
38966 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
38968 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
38969 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
38970 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
38972 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
38973 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
38974 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
38976 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
38979 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
38980 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
38981 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
38982 .cindex "checking access"
38983 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
38984 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
38985 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
38986 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
38987 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
38988 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
38990 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
38991 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
38993 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
38995 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
38996 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
38997 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
38998 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
39001 550 Relay not permitted
39003 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
39004 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
39005 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
39006 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
39009 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
39010 -f himself@there.example
39012 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
39013 mandatory arguments.
39015 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
39016 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
39017 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
39021 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
39022 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
39023 .cindex "building DBM files"
39024 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
39025 .cindex "lower casing"
39026 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
39027 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
39028 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
39029 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
39030 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
39031 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
39033 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
39034 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
39035 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
39036 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
39039 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
39040 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
39041 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
39045 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
39046 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
39047 filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
39048 create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
39050 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
39052 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
39053 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
39055 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
39056 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
39057 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
39058 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
39059 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
39060 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
39062 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
39063 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
39064 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
39065 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
39066 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
39067 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
39068 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
39074 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
39075 .cindex "retry" "times"
39076 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
39077 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
39078 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
39079 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
39080 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
39081 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
39082 output. For example:
39084 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
39085 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
39086 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
39087 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
39088 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
39089 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
39090 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
39091 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
39092 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
39093 past final cutoff time
39095 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
39096 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
39097 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
39098 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
39099 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
39100 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
39103 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
39104 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
39105 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
39106 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
39107 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
39108 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
39112 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
39113 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
39114 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
39115 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
39116 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
39117 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
39118 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
39121 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
39123 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
39126 &'callout'&: the callout cache
39128 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
39130 &'misc'&: other hints data
39133 The &'misc'& database is used for
39136 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
39138 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
39139 &(smtp)& transport)
39141 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
39147 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECTdumpdb"
39148 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
39149 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
39150 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
39151 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
39153 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
39155 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
39157 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
39158 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
39160 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
39161 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
39162 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
39163 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
39164 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
39165 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
39166 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
39167 and a textual description of the error.
39169 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
39170 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
39171 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
39174 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
39175 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
39176 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
39177 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
39178 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
39179 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
39184 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECTtidydb"
39185 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
39186 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
39187 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
39188 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
39189 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
39190 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
39191 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
39192 updated sufficiently often.
39194 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
39195 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
39196 the retry database:
39198 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
39200 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
39201 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
39202 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
39203 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
39204 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
39205 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
39206 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
39207 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
39208 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
39209 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
39210 whenever it removes information from the database.
39212 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
39213 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
39214 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
39215 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
39216 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
39218 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
39219 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
39220 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
39221 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
39222 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
39223 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
39224 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
39227 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
39228 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
39233 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECTfixdb"
39234 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
39235 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
39236 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
39237 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
39238 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
39239 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
39242 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
39243 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
39244 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
39245 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
39246 by new data, for example:
39250 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
39251 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
39252 used as optional separators.
39257 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
39258 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
39259 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
39260 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
39261 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
39262 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
39263 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
39264 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
39265 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
39266 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
39267 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
39268 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
39269 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
39273 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
39276 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
39279 .vitem &%-interval%&
39280 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
39281 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
39283 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
39284 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
39287 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
39290 Suppress verification output.
39292 .vitem &%-retries%&
39293 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
39294 the lock (default 10).
39296 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
39297 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
39298 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
39299 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
39302 .vitem &%-timeout%&
39303 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
39304 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
39305 default), a non-blocking call is used.
39308 Generate verbose output.
39311 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
39312 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
39313 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
39314 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
39315 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
39316 file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
39317 more than 30 minutes old.
39319 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
39320 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
39321 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
39322 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
39323 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
39324 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
39326 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
39327 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
39328 suppresses all output except error messages.
39332 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
39334 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
39336 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
39337 <&'some commands'&>
39340 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
39341 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
39344 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
39345 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
39347 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
39348 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
39352 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39353 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39355 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
39356 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
39357 .cindex "X-windows"
39358 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
39359 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
39360 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
39361 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
39362 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
39363 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
39364 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
39365 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
39369 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
39370 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
39371 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
39372 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
39373 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
39374 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
39375 parameters are for.
39377 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
39378 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
39379 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
39381 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
39383 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
39384 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
39385 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
39386 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
39387 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
39389 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
39390 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
39392 Eximon*background: gray94
39394 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
39395 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
39396 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
39397 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
39398 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
39399 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
39400 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
39403 Eximon*highlight: gray
39406 .cindex "admin user"
39407 In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
39408 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
39410 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
39411 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
39412 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
39413 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
39414 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
39416 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
39417 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
39418 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
39419 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
39420 different parts of the display.
39425 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
39426 .cindex "stripchart"
39427 The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
39428 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
39429 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
39430 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
39431 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
39432 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
39433 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
39434 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
39435 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
39437 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
39438 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
39439 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
39440 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
39442 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
39443 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
39444 to a single partition.
39446 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
39447 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
39448 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
39449 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
39450 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
39451 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
39452 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
39457 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
39458 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
39459 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
39460 .cindex "window size"
39461 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
39462 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
39463 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
39464 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
39465 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
39466 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
39468 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
39469 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
39470 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
39471 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
39473 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
39474 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
39475 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
39476 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
39477 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
39478 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
39480 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
39481 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
39482 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
39486 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
39487 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
39488 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
39489 the main log is maintained.
39490 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
39491 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
39492 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
39493 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
39494 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
39496 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
39497 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
39498 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
39499 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
39500 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
39501 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
39502 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
39503 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
39504 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
39505 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
39506 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
39508 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
39509 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
39510 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
39511 It cannot go further back up the log.
39513 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
39514 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
39515 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
39516 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
39517 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
39518 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
39520 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
39521 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
39522 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
39523 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
39524 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
39525 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
39527 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
39528 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
39529 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
39530 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
39531 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
39532 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
39533 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
39534 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
39535 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
39540 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
39541 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
39542 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
39543 are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
39544 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
39545 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
39546 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
39547 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
39548 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
39549 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
39551 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
39552 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
39553 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
39554 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
39555 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
39556 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
39557 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
39559 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
39560 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
39561 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
39562 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
39563 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
39564 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
39565 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
39567 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
39568 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
39569 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
39570 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
39572 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
39573 time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
39574 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
39575 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
39576 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
39577 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
39578 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
39581 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
39582 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
39584 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
39585 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
39586 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
39587 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
39588 display is updated.
39592 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
39593 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
39594 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
39595 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
39596 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
39599 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
39600 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
39601 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
39602 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
39603 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
39605 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
39607 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
39611 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
39612 in a new text window.
39614 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
39615 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
39616 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
39618 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
39619 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
39620 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
39621 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
39623 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
39624 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
39625 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
39626 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
39627 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
39629 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
39630 that the message be frozen.
39632 .cindex "thawing messages"
39633 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
39634 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
39635 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
39636 that the message be thawed.
39638 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
39639 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
39640 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
39641 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
39643 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
39644 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
39647 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
39648 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
39649 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
39650 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
39651 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
39652 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
39653 which case no action is taken.
39655 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
39656 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
39657 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
39658 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
39659 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
39660 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
39661 case no action is taken.
39663 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
39664 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
39666 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
39667 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
39668 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
39669 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
39670 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
39671 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
39672 the address is qualified with that domain.
39675 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
39676 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
39677 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
39678 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
39679 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
39680 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
39681 if no output is generated.
39683 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
39684 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
39685 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
39686 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
39688 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
39689 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
39690 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
39697 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39698 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39700 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
39701 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
39702 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
39703 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
39705 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
39706 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
39707 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
39708 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
39709 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
39710 its security as compared with other MTAs.
39712 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
39713 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
39714 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
39715 as soon as possible.
39718 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
39719 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
39720 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
39721 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
39722 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
39723 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
39726 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
39727 start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
39728 filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
39729 the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
39730 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
39731 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
39733 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
39734 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
39735 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
39736 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
39739 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
39740 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
39741 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
39742 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
39743 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
39744 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
39745 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
39746 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
39747 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
39751 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
39752 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
39753 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
39754 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
39755 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
39756 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
39757 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
39759 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
39762 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
39763 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
39764 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
39765 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
39766 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
39771 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
39773 .cindex "root privilege"
39774 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
39775 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
39776 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
39777 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
39778 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
39779 is required for two things:
39782 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
39783 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
39786 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
39787 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
39791 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
39792 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
39793 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
39794 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
39795 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
39796 group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
39797 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
39798 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
39800 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
39801 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
39802 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
39804 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
39805 uid and gid in the following cases:
39810 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
39811 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
39812 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
39813 the calling process.
39814 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
39815 option may not be used at all.
39816 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
39817 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
39818 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
39823 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
39824 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
39827 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
39828 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
39829 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
39830 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
39831 testing address verification
39834 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
39837 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
39838 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
39841 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
39844 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
39845 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
39846 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
39847 will be used during message reception.
39849 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
39850 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
39852 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
39853 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
39854 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
39855 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
39856 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
39857 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
39858 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
39859 generating bounce and warning messages.
39861 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
39862 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
39863 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
39864 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
39866 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
39867 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
39873 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
39874 .cindex "privilege, running without"
39875 .cindex "unprivileged running"
39876 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
39877 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
39878 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
39879 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
39880 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
39881 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
39882 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
39886 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
39887 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
39888 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
39889 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
39891 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
39892 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
39893 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
39894 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
39895 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
39897 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
39898 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
39899 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
39902 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
39903 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
39904 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
39906 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
39907 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
39908 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
39909 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
39910 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
39911 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
39912 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
39913 address this problem at this time.
39915 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
39916 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
39917 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
39918 be used in the most straightforward way.
39920 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
39921 number of restrictions on what you can do:
39924 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
39925 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
39926 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
39927 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
39928 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
39930 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
39931 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
39933 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
39934 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
39935 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
39936 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
39938 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
39939 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
39942 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
39943 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
39944 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
39946 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
39947 owned by the Exim user.
39949 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
39950 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
39951 mailboxes need to be created manually.
39956 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
39957 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
39958 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
39959 gives more security at essentially no cost.
39961 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
39962 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
39967 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
39968 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
39969 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
39973 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
39974 .cindex "security" "local commands"
39975 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
39976 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
39977 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
39978 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
39979 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
39982 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
39983 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
39984 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
39985 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
39986 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
39988 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
39989 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
39990 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
39991 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
39992 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
39993 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
39994 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
39996 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
39997 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
39998 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
40000 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
40001 taint checking might apply to their usage.
40003 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
40004 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
40005 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
40007 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
40008 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
40009 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
40011 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
40012 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
40013 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
40014 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
40020 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
40021 .cindex "security" "data sources"
40022 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
40023 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
40024 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
40025 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
40026 are some issues to be aware of:
40029 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
40031 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
40033 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
40034 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
40035 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
40036 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
40037 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
40038 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
40041 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
40042 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
40043 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
40045 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
40046 expected to yield one result.
40052 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
40053 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
40054 .cindex "IP source routing"
40055 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
40056 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
40057 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
40058 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
40062 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
40063 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
40064 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
40069 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
40070 .cindex "trusted users"
40071 .cindex "admin user"
40072 .cindex "privileged user"
40073 .cindex "user" "trusted"
40074 .cindex "user" "admin"
40075 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
40076 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
40077 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
40078 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
40079 permit a remote host to be specified.
40082 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
40083 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
40084 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
40085 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
40086 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
40087 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
40089 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
40090 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
40091 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
40092 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
40093 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
40095 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
40096 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
40097 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
40098 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
40099 includes the contents of files on the spool.
40103 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
40104 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
40105 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
40106 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
40107 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
40108 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
40110 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
40111 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
40112 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
40113 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
40114 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
40115 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
40118 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
40119 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
40120 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
40121 This affects most of the checking options,
40122 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
40125 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
40126 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
40127 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
40128 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
40129 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
40130 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
40134 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
40135 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
40136 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
40137 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
40138 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
40143 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
40144 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
40145 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
40146 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
40151 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
40152 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
40153 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
40154 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
40155 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
40159 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
40160 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
40161 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
40165 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
40166 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
40167 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
40168 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
40169 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
40170 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
40171 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
40173 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
40174 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
40179 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
40180 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
40181 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
40182 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
40186 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
40187 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
40188 enough to hold the result.
40189 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
40194 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40195 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40197 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
40198 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
40199 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
40200 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
40201 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
40202 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
40203 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
40204 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
40205 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
40206 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
40207 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
40208 themselves are recoverable.
40210 The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
40211 Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
40212 and should not be used as such.
40214 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
40215 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
40216 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
40219 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
40220 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
40221 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
40222 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
40223 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
40225 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
40226 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
40227 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
40228 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
40230 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
40232 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
40235 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
40237 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
40238 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
40239 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
40240 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
40241 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
40242 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
40243 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
40244 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
40247 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
40248 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
40249 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
40250 relics of crashes and can be removed.
40252 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
40253 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
40254 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
40255 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
40256 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
40257 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
40258 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
40259 normally the Exim user.
40261 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
40262 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
40263 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
40264 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
40265 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
40266 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
40267 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
40268 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
40270 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
40271 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
40272 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
40273 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
40275 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
40276 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
40279 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
40280 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
40281 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
40282 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
40283 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
40284 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
40285 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
40286 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
40287 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
40290 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
40291 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
40292 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
40293 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
40294 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
40295 character. It may contain internal newlines.
40297 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
40298 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
40299 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
40300 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
40301 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
40302 character. It may contain internal newlines.
40304 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
40305 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
40306 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
40308 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
40309 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
40310 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
40311 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
40312 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
40314 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
40315 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
40316 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
40317 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
40318 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
40320 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
40321 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
40322 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
40324 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
40325 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
40326 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
40328 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
40329 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
40330 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
40332 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
40333 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
40334 present if the number is greater than zero.
40336 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
40337 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
40338 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
40340 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
40341 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
40342 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
40344 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
40345 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
40348 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
40349 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
40350 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
40353 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
40354 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
40355 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
40356 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
40358 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
40359 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
40360 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
40362 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
40363 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
40364 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
40365 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
40366 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
40367 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
40369 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
40370 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
40371 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
40372 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
40373 supplied by the remote host, if any.
40375 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
40376 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
40377 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
40378 generated messages.
40381 The message is from a local sender.
40383 .vitem &%-localerror%&
40384 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
40386 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
40387 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
40388 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
40389 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
40391 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
40392 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
40393 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
40396 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
40397 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
40400 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
40401 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
40402 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
40404 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
40405 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
40406 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
40408 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
40409 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
40410 of &$spam_score_int$&.
40412 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
40413 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
40414 rather than Unix-format.
40415 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
40416 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
40418 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
40419 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
40420 certificate was verified by the server.
40422 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
40423 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
40424 name of the cipher suite that was used.
40426 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
40427 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
40428 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
40432 Any of the above may have an extra hyphen prepended, to indicate the the
40433 corresponding data is untrusted.
40435 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
40436 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
40437 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
40438 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
40439 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
40440 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
40441 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
40442 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
40443 addresses are complete.
40445 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
40446 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
40447 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
40448 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
40449 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
40450 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
40452 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
40453 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
40454 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
40456 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
40457 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
40458 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
40459 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
40463 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
40464 darcy@austen.fict.example
40466 alice@wonderland.fict.example
40468 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
40469 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
40470 line is of the following form:
40472 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
40473 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
40475 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
40476 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
40477 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
40478 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
40479 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
40480 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
40481 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
40482 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
40485 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
40486 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
40487 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
40488 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
40489 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
40493 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
40494 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
40495 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
40496 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
40497 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
40498 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
40499 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
40500 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
40501 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
40502 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
40505 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
40506 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
40507 typical set of headers:
40509 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
40510 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
40511 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
40512 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
40513 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
40514 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
40515 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
40516 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
40517 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
40518 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
40519 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
40521 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
40522 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
40523 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
40524 .ecindex IIDforspo1
40525 .ecindex IIDforspo2
40526 .ecindex IIDforspo3
40528 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
40529 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
40530 an ASCII newline character.
40531 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
40532 can have an alternate format.
40533 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
40534 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
40535 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
40536 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
40537 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
40538 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
40540 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40541 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40543 .chapter "DKIM, SPF and DMARC" "CHAPdkim" &&&
40544 "DKIM, SPF and DMARC Support"
40546 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
40549 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
40550 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
40551 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
40552 DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
40554 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
40555 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
40556 any original DKIM signature.
40558 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
40559 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
40561 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
40563 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
40564 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
40565 (including transport filters)
40566 except cutthrough delivery.
40568 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
40569 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
40570 different signature contexts.
40573 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
40574 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
40575 Exim's standard controls.
40577 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
40578 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
40580 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
40581 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
40582 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
40583 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
40585 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
40586 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
40587 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
40588 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
40591 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
40592 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
40593 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
40594 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
40598 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
40599 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
40601 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
40602 Note that RFC 8301 (which does not cover EC keys) says:
40604 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40606 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
40607 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
40610 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
40611 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
40612 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
40613 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
40614 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
40616 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
40617 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
40619 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
40620 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
40621 After expansion, this can be a list.
40622 Each element in turn,
40624 is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
40625 while expanding the remaining signing options.
40626 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
40627 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
40629 .option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
40630 This sets the key selector string.
40631 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
40632 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
40633 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
40634 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
40635 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
40636 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
40638 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
40639 This sets the private key to use.
40640 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
40641 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
40642 The result can either
40644 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
40646 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
40647 be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
40649 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
40652 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
40653 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
40657 To generate keys under OpenSSL:
40659 openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
40660 openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
40662 The result file from the first command should be retained, and
40663 this option set to use it.
40664 Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
40665 for the DNS TXT record.
40666 See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
40670 certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
40671 certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
40674 Note that RFC 8301 says:
40676 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
40677 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
40680 EC keys for DKIM are defined by RFC 8463.
40681 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
40682 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
40683 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
40684 for some transition period.
40685 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
40688 OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
40690 openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
40691 certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
40694 To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
40696 openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
40697 certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
40700 Exim also supports an alternate format
40701 of Ed25519 keys in DNS which was a candidate during development
40702 of the standard, but not adopted.
40703 A future release will probably drop that support.
40705 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
40706 Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
40708 &`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
40710 &`sha256`& &-- the default
40712 &`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
40715 Note that RFC 8301 says:
40717 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40720 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
40721 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
40722 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
40723 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
40724 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
40725 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
40727 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
40728 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
40729 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
40730 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
40731 only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
40733 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
40734 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
40735 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
40736 either &"1"& or &"true"&, Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
40737 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
40740 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
40741 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
40742 list of header names.
40743 Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
40744 in the message signature.
40745 When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
40746 whether or not each header is present in the message.
40747 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
40748 &"_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS"&
40750 and an oversigning variant is in &"_DKIM_OVERSIGN_HEADERS"&.
40753 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
40754 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
40755 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
40757 A name can be prefixed with either an &"="& or a &"+"& character.
40758 If an &"="& prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
40760 If a &"+"& prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
40761 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
40762 name will be appended.
40764 .option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
40765 This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
40766 If not set, no such information will be included.
40767 Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the current time
40769 (eg. 1209600 for two weeks);
40770 both creation (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included.
40772 RFC 6376 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
40775 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
40776 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
40778 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
40779 messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
40780 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
40781 Individual classes of signature algorithm can be ignored by changing
40782 the main options &%dkim_verify_hashes%& or &%dkim_verify_keytypes%&.
40783 The &%dkim_verify_minimal%& option can be set to cease verification
40784 processing for a message once the first passing signature is found.
40786 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
40787 Performing verification sets up information used by the
40788 &%authresults%& expansion item.
40790 For most purposes the default option settings suffice and the remainder
40791 of this section can be ignored.
40793 The results of verification are made available to the
40794 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which can examine and modify them.
40795 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
40796 By default, the ACL is called once for each
40797 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
40798 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
40799 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
40800 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
40802 To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
40803 a large number of expansion variables
40804 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
40805 runtime of the ACL.
40807 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
40808 more advanced policies. For that reason, the main option
40809 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and an expansion variable
40810 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
40812 The main option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
40813 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
40814 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
40815 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
40816 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
40817 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
40820 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
40822 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
40823 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
40824 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
40826 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
40828 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
40829 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
40830 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
40832 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
40835 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
40836 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
40838 Note that if the option is set using untrustworthy data
40839 (such as the From: header)
40840 care should be taken to force lowercase for domains
40841 and for the domain part if identities.
40842 The default setting can be regarded as trustworthy in this respect.
40844 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
40845 for each matching signature.
40848 Inside the DKIM ACL, the following expansion variables are
40849 available (from most to least important):
40853 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
40854 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
40855 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
40856 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
40858 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
40859 Within the DKIM ACL,
40860 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
40862 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
40863 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40865 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
40866 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
40868 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
40869 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
40871 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
40874 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40875 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
40876 hash-method or key-size:
40878 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
40879 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
40880 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
40881 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
40882 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
40883 set dkim_verify_status = fail
40884 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
40887 So long as a DKIM ACL is defined (it need do no more than accept),
40888 after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
40889 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
40890 This is maintained for the mime, prdr and data ACLs.
40892 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
40893 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
40894 "fail" or "invalid". One of
40896 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
40897 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
40899 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
40900 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
40902 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
40903 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
40904 means that the message body was modified in transit.
40906 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
40907 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
40908 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
40909 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
40912 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40914 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
40915 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
40916 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
40917 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40919 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
40920 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
40921 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
40922 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40924 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
40925 The key record selector string.
40927 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
40928 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
40929 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
40930 may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
40931 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
40934 Note that RFC 8301 says:
40936 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40938 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
40939 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
40942 To enforce this you must either have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
40943 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above,
40944 or have set the main option &%dkim_verify_hashes%& to exclude
40945 processing of such signatures.
40947 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
40948 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40950 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
40951 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40953 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
40954 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
40955 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
40956 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
40957 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
40958 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
40960 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
40961 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
40962 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
40963 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
40964 &*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
40965 is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
40966 A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
40967 shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
40969 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
40970 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
40971 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
40973 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
40974 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
40975 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
40976 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
40977 integer size comparisons against this value.
40978 Note that Exim does not check this value.
40980 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
40981 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
40983 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
40984 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
40986 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
40987 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
40989 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
40990 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40993 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
40994 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40997 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
40998 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
41000 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
41001 Number of bits in the key.
41003 Valid only once the key is loaded, which is at the time the header signature
41004 is verified, which is after the body hash is.
41007 Note that RFC 8301 says:
41009 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
41010 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
41013 This is enforced by the default setting for the &%dkim_verify_min_keysizes%&
41018 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
41021 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
41022 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
41023 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
41024 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
41025 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
41028 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
41029 warn sender_domains = gmail.com
41030 dkim_signers = gmail.com
41032 log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
41035 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
41036 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
41038 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
41039 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
41040 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
41041 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
41044 deny sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
41045 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
41046 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
41047 message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
41050 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
41051 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
41052 for more information of what they mean.
41058 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
41059 .cindex SPF verification
41061 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
41062 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
41063 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.open-spf.org), a static copy of
41064 the &url(http://openspf.org).
41065 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https, open-spf.org is told to be a
41066 . --- web-archive copy of the now dead openspf.org site
41067 . --- See https://www.mail-archive.com/mailop@mailop.org/msg08019.html for a
41070 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
41071 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
41073 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
41074 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
41075 &url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
41076 There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
41077 publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
41079 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
41080 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
41081 Performing verification sets up information used by the
41082 &%authresults%& expansion item.
41085 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
41086 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
41087 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
41088 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
41089 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
41093 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
41096 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
41097 domain in the envelope-from address.
41099 .vitem &%softfail%&
41100 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
41104 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
41107 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
41108 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
41109 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
41111 .vitem &%permerror%&
41112 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
41113 You may deny messages when this occurs.
41115 .vitem &%temperror%&
41116 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
41117 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
41120 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
41121 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
41122 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
41123 short-circuit fashion.
41128 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
41129 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
41130 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
41131 Please see http://www.open-spf.org/Why;\
41132 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
41133 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
41134 ip=$sender_host_address
41137 Note: The above mentioned URL may not be as helpful as expected. You are
41138 encouraged to replace the link with a link to a site with more
41141 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
41144 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
41146 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
41147 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
41148 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
41149 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
41150 it for logging purposes.
41152 .vitem &$spf_received$&
41153 .vindex &$spf_received$&
41154 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
41155 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
41156 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
41157 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
41159 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
41160 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
41162 .vitem &$spf_result$&
41163 .vindex &$spf_result$&
41164 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
41165 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
41168 .vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
41169 .vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
41170 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
41171 and required in order to obtain a result.
41173 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
41174 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
41175 .vindex &%spf_smtp_comment_template%&
41176 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
41177 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
41179 The string is generated by the SPF library from the template configured in the main config
41180 option &%spf_smtp_comment_template%&.
41185 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
41186 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
41187 .cindex SPF "best guess"
41188 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
41189 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
41190 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
41192 Refer to &url(http://www.open-spf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
41193 for a description of what it means.
41194 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https:
41196 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
41197 of the spf one. For example:
41200 deny spf_guess = fail
41201 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
41204 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
41205 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
41206 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
41209 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
41210 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
41212 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
41213 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
41214 &%spf_guess%& option.
41215 For example, the following:
41218 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
41221 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
41224 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
41226 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
41227 address as the key and an IP address
41232 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
41235 The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
41236 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
41242 .section DMARC SECDMARC
41243 .cindex DMARC verification
41245 DMARC combines feedback from SPF, DKIM, and header From: in order
41246 to attempt to provide better indicators of the authenticity of an
41247 email. This document does not explain the fundamentals; you
41248 should read and understand how it works by visiting the website at
41249 &url(http://www.dmarc.org/).
41251 If Exim is built with DMARC support,
41252 the libopendmarc library is used.
41254 For building Exim yourself, obtain the library from
41255 &url(http://sourceforge.net/projects/opendmarc/)
41256 to obtain a copy, or find it in your favorite package
41257 repository. You will need to attend to the local/Makefile feature
41258 SUPPORT_DMARC and the associated LDFLAGS addition.
41259 This description assumes
41260 that headers will be in /usr/local/include, and that the libraries
41261 are in /usr/local/lib.
41265 There are three main-configuration options:
41266 .cindex DMARC "configuration options"
41268 The &%dmarc_tld_file%& option
41269 .oindex &%dmarc_tld_file%&
41270 defines the location of a text file of valid
41271 top level domains the opendmarc library uses
41272 during domain parsing. Maintained by Mozilla,
41273 the most current version can be downloaded
41274 from a link at &url(https://publicsuffix.org/list/public_suffix_list.dat).
41275 See also the util/renew-opendmarc-tlds.sh script.
41277 The default for the option is unset.
41278 If not set, DMARC processing is disabled.
41282 The &%dmarc_history_file%& option, if set
41283 .oindex &%dmarc_history_file%&
41284 defines the location of a file to log results
41285 of dmarc verification on inbound emails. The
41286 contents are importable by the opendmarc tools
41287 which will manage the data, send out DMARC
41288 reports, and expire the data. Make sure the
41289 directory of this file is writable by the user
41291 The default is unset.
41293 The &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& option
41294 .oindex &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
41295 defines an alternate email address to use when sending a
41296 forensic report detailing alignment failures
41297 if a sender domain's dmarc record specifies it
41298 and you have configured Exim to send them.
41299 If set, this is expanded and used for the
41300 From: header line; the address is extracted
41301 from it and used for the envelope from.
41302 If not set (the default), the From: header is expanded from
41303 the dsn_from option, and <> is used for the
41306 . I wish we had subsections...
41308 .cindex DMARC controls
41309 By default, the DMARC processing will run for any remote,
41310 non-authenticated user. It makes sense to only verify DMARC
41311 status of messages coming from remote, untrusted sources. You can
41312 use standard conditions such as hosts, senders, etc, to decide that
41313 DMARC verification should *not* be performed for them and disable
41314 DMARC with an ACL control modifier:
41316 control = dmarc_disable_verify
41318 A DMARC record can also specify a "forensic address", which gives
41319 exim an email address to submit reports about failed alignment.
41320 Exim does not do this by default because in certain conditions it
41321 results in unintended information leakage (what lists a user might
41322 be subscribed to, etc). You must configure exim to submit forensic
41323 reports to the owner of the domain. If the DMARC record contains a
41324 forensic address and you specify the control statement below, then
41325 exim will send these forensic emails. It is also advised that you
41326 configure a &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& because the default sender address
41327 construction might be inadequate.
41329 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
41331 (AGAIN: You can choose not to send these forensic reports by simply
41332 not putting the dmarc_enable_forensic control line at any point in
41333 your exim config. If you don't tell exim to send them, it will not
41336 There are no options to either control. Both must appear before
41341 DMARC checks cam be run on incoming SMTP messages by using the
41342 &"dmarc_status"& ACL condition in the DATA ACL. You are required to
41343 call the &"spf"& condition first in the ACLs, then the &"dmarc_status"&
41344 condition. Putting this condition in the ACLs is required in order
41345 for a DMARC check to actually occur. All of the variables are set
41346 up before the DATA ACL, but there is no actual DMARC check that
41347 occurs until a &"dmarc_status"& condition is encountered in the ACLs.
41349 The &"dmarc_status"& condition takes a list of strings on its
41350 right-hand side. These strings describe recommended action based
41351 on the DMARC check. To understand what the policy recommendations
41352 mean, refer to the DMARC website above. Valid strings are:
41354 &'accept '& The DMARC check passed and the library recommends accepting the email.
41355 &'reject '& The DMARC check failed and the library recommends rejecting the email.
41356 &'quarantine '& The DMARC check failed and the library recommends keeping it for further inspection.
41357 &'none '& The DMARC check passed and the library recommends no specific action, neutral.
41358 &'norecord '& No policy section in the DMARC record for this sender domain.
41359 &'nofrom '& Unable to determine the domain of the sender.
41360 &'temperror '& Library error or dns error.
41361 &'off '& The DMARC check was disabled for this email.
41363 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert its
41364 meaning, for example "!accept" will match all results but
41365 "accept". The string list is evaluated left-to-right in a
41366 short-circuit fashion. When a string matches the outcome of the
41367 DMARC check, the condition succeeds. If none of the listed
41368 strings matches the outcome of the DMARC check, the condition
41371 Of course, you can also use any other lookup method that Exim
41372 supports, including LDAP, Postgres, MySQL, etc, as long as the
41373 result is a list of colon-separated strings.
41375 Performing the check sets up information used by the
41376 &%authresults%& expansion item.
41378 Several expansion variables are set before the DATA ACL is
41379 processed, and you can use them in this ACL. The following
41380 expansion variables are available:
41383 .vitem &$dmarc_status$&
41384 .vindex &$dmarc_status$&
41385 .cindex DMARC result
41386 A one word status indicating what the DMARC library
41387 thinks of the email. It is a combination of the results of
41388 DMARC record lookup and the SPF/DKIM/DMARC processing results
41389 (if a DMARC record was found). The actual policy declared
41390 in the DMARC record is in a separate expansion variable.
41392 .vitem &$dmarc_status_text$&
41393 .vindex &$dmarc_status_text$&
41394 Slightly longer, human readable status.
41396 .vitem &$dmarc_used_domain$&
41397 .vindex &$dmarc_used_domain$&
41398 The domain which DMARC used to look up the DMARC policy record.
41400 .vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
41401 .vindex &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
41402 The policy declared in the DMARC record. Valid values
41403 are "none", "reject" and "quarantine". It is blank when there
41404 is any error, including no DMARC record.
41409 By default, Exim's DMARC configuration is intended to be
41410 non-intrusive and conservative. To facilitate this, Exim will not
41411 create any type of logging files without explicit configuration by
41412 you, the admin. Nor will Exim send out any emails/reports about
41413 DMARC issues without explicit configuration by you, the admin (other
41414 than typical bounce messages that may come about due to ACL
41415 processing or failure delivery issues).
41417 In order to log statistics suitable to be imported by the opendmarc
41418 tools, you need to:
41420 Configure the global option &%dmarc_history_file%&
41422 Configure cron jobs to call the appropriate opendmarc history
41423 import scripts and truncating the dmarc_history_file
41426 In order to send forensic reports, you need to:
41428 Configure the global option &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
41430 Configure, somewhere before the DATA ACL, the control option to
41431 enable sending DMARC forensic reports
41439 warn domains = +local_domains
41440 hosts = +local_hosts
41441 control = dmarc_disable_verify
41443 warn !domains = +screwed_up_dmarc_records
41444 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
41446 warn condition = (lookup if destined to mailing list)
41447 set acl_m_mailing_list = 1
41450 warn dmarc_status = accept : none : off
41452 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: $dmarc_status $dmarc_used_domain
41454 warn dmarc_status = !accept
41456 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: '$dmarc_status' for $dmarc_used_domain
41458 warn dmarc_status = quarantine
41460 set $acl_m_quarantine = 1
41461 # Do something in a transport with this flag variable
41463 deny condition = ${if eq{$dmarc_domain_policy}{reject}}
41464 condition = ${if eq{$acl_m_mailing_list}{1}}
41465 message = Messages from $dmarc_used_domain break mailing lists
41467 deny dmarc_status = reject
41469 message = Message from $dmarc_used_domain failed sender's DMARC policy, REJECT
41471 warn add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
41478 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41479 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41481 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
41483 .cindex "proxy support"
41484 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
41486 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
41487 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
41490 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
41491 .cindex proxy inbound
41492 .cindex proxy "server side"
41493 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
41494 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
41496 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
41497 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
41498 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
41501 It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
41502 &url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
41504 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
41505 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
41506 to distribute load.
41507 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
41508 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
41509 There is no logging if a host passes or
41510 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
41511 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
41513 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
41514 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
41515 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
41516 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
41517 automatically determines which version is in use.
41519 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
41520 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
41521 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
41522 Exim and the proxy server.
41524 The following expansion variables are usable
41525 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
41528 &'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
41529 &'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
41530 &'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
41531 &'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
41532 &'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
41534 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
41535 there was a protocol error.
41536 The variables &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&
41537 will have values for the actual client system, not the proxy.
41539 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
41540 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
41541 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
41542 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
41543 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
41544 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
41545 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
41546 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
41547 A possible solution is:
41549 # Set max number of connections per host
41551 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
41552 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
41554 defer ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
41555 message = Too many connections from this IP right now
41560 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
41561 .cindex proxy outbound
41562 .cindex proxy "client side"
41563 .cindex proxy SOCKS
41564 .cindex SOCKS proxy
41565 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
41566 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
41567 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
41570 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
41571 on an smtp transport.
41572 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
41573 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
41574 Each proxy specifier is a list
41575 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
41576 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
41578 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
41579 The list of options is in the following table:
41581 &'auth '& authentication method
41582 &'name '& authentication username
41583 &'pass '& authentication password
41585 &'tmo '& connection timeout
41587 &'weight '& selection bias
41590 More details on each of these options follows:
41593 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
41594 .cindex proxy authentication
41595 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
41596 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
41597 for access to the proxy.
41598 Default is &"none"&.
41600 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
41603 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
41606 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
41609 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
41612 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
41613 higher values being tried first.
41614 The default priority is 1.
41616 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
41617 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
41618 weighted by this value.
41619 The default value for selection bias is 1.
41622 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
41623 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
41624 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
41626 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
41627 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
41628 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
41629 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
41631 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41632 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41634 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
41635 "Internationalisation""
41636 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
41639 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
41641 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
41642 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
41643 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
41645 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
41646 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
41647 requirement, upon libidn2.
41649 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
41650 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
41651 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SMTPUTF8
41652 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
41653 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
41654 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
41655 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
41657 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
41658 international handling for the message is enabled and
41659 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
41661 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
41662 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
41663 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
41664 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
41666 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
41667 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
41668 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
41669 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
41671 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
41672 components expanded to a-label form,
41673 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
41676 .cindex log protocol
41677 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
41678 .cindex i18n logging
41679 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
41680 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
41682 The following expansion operators can be used:
41684 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
41685 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
41686 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
41687 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
41690 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
41691 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
41693 may use the following modifier:
41695 control = utf8_downconvert
41696 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
41698 This sets a flag requiring that envelope addresses are converted to
41699 a-label form before smtp delivery.
41700 This is usually for use in a Message Submission Agent context,
41701 but could be used for any message.
41703 If a value is appended it may be:
41705 &`1 `& mandatory downconversion
41706 &`0 `& no downconversion
41707 &`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
41709 If no value is given, 1 is used.
41711 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
41712 is initially set to -1.
41714 The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
41715 If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
41716 or an empty string.
41717 If non-empty it overrides value previously set
41718 (due to mua_wrapper or by an ACL control).
41721 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
41722 Configurations supporting these should inspect
41723 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
41725 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
41726 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
41727 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
41729 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
41730 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
41734 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
41735 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
41736 the following expansion operator can be used:
41738 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
41741 The string is converted from the charset specified by
41742 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
41743 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
41745 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
41746 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
41747 (which has to be a single character)
41748 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
41749 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
41751 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
41752 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
41754 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
41755 by many other IMAP servers.
41759 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
41760 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
41761 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
41764 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
41765 must be representable in UTF-16.
41768 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41769 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41771 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
41775 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
41776 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
41777 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
41778 processing actions.
41780 Most installations will never need to use Events.
41781 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
41782 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
41784 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
41785 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
41786 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
41788 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
41789 An example might look like:
41790 .cindex logging custom
41792 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
41793 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
41794 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
41795 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
41796 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
41797 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
41798 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
41799 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
41800 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
41804 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
41805 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
41806 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
41809 The current list of events is:
41812 &`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
41813 &`msg:complete after main `& per message
41814 &`msg:defer after transport `& per message per delivery try
41815 &`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
41816 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
41817 &`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
41818 &`msg:host:defer after transport `& per host per delivery try; host errors
41819 &`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
41820 &`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
41821 &`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
41822 &`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
41823 &`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
41824 &`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
41825 &`smtp:ehlo after transport `& per connection
41827 New event types may be added in future.
41829 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
41830 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
41831 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
41833 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
41834 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
41835 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
41837 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
41838 should define the event action.
41840 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
41841 with the event type:
41843 &`dane:fail `& failure reason
41844 &`msg:defer `& error string
41845 &`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
41846 &`msg:fail:internal `& failure reason
41847 &`msg:fail:delivery `& smtp error message
41848 &`msg:host:defer `& error string
41849 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
41850 &`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
41851 &`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
41852 &`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
41853 &`smtp:ehlo `& smtp ehlo response
41856 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
41858 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
41859 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
41860 the course of its processing:
41862 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
41865 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
41866 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
41868 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
41869 a useful way of writing to the main log.
41871 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
41872 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
41873 following will be forced:
41875 &`tcp:connect `& do not connect
41876 &`tls:cert `& refuse verification
41877 &`smtp:connect `& close connection
41879 All other message types ignore the result string, and
41880 no other use is made of it.
41882 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
41883 then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
41886 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
41887 chain element received on the connection.
41888 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
41891 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41892 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41894 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
41895 "Adding drivers or lookups"
41896 .cindex "adding drivers"
41897 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
41898 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
41899 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
41900 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
41903 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
41904 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
41906 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
41908 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
41910 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
41911 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
41912 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
41914 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
41916 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
41919 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
41920 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
41922 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
41923 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
41924 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
41925 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
41926 simple form that most lookups have.
41928 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
41929 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
41930 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
41932 Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
41933 definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
41935 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
41938 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
41939 as for other drivers and lookups.
41942 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
41943 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
41944 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
41945 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
41946 searched using a binary chop procedure.
41948 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
41949 the interface that is expected.
41954 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41955 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41957 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41958 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
41959 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
41960 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
41962 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41967 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
41968 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
41972 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
41973 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
41974 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
41977 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41978 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////